Caf 4 BL ST 2022

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 294

CAF - 4

BUSINESS LAW

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN i


First edition published by
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of Pakistan
Chartered Accountants Avenue
Clifton
Karachi – 75600 Pakistan
Email: [email protected]
www.icap.org.pk

© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of Pakistan, September 2021

All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any
form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning or otherwise, without the prior
permission in writing of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Pakistan, or as expressly permitted by law, or under
the terms agreed with the appropriate reprographics rights organization.

You must not circulate this book in any other binding or cover and you must impose the same condition on any
acquirer.

Notice
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of Pakistan has made every effort to ensure that at the time of writing, the
contents of this study text are accurate, but neither the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Pakistan nor its directors
or employees shall be under any liability whatsoever for any inaccurate or misleading information this work could
contain.

ii THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


TABLE OF CONTENTS

CHAPTER PAGE

Chapter 1 Introduction to the legal system 1

Chapter 2 Offer, acceptance and revocation 19

Chapter 3 Validity of contracts and agreements 37

Chapter 4 Free consent and void agreements 57

Chapter 5 Contingent contracts 81

Chapter 6 Performance of contracts-I 91

Chapter 7 Performance of contracts-II 111

Chapter 8 Certain relations resembling those created by contract 129

Chapter 9 Consequences for breach of contract 139

Chapter 10 Appointment and authority of agents 151

Chapter 11 The nature of partnership 161

Chapter 12 Relations of partners to one another 179

Chapter 13 Relations of partners to third parties 197

Chapter 14 Negotiable instruments 221

Chapter 15 Provisions relating to cheques 245

Chapter 16 Anti-money laundering and electronic payments 259

Chapter 17 Data protection and electronic crimes 271

Chapter 18 Competition act and arbitration act 281

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN iii


iv THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN
CHAPTER 1

INTRODUCTION TO THE
LEGAL SYSTEM

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
The purpose of studying law in Chartered Accountancy is to be
aware of legal problems to seek legal assistance, to evaluate the
AT A GLANCE
financial implications of law and also to communicate with the
lawyers.
SPOTLIGHT
The sources of law in Pakistan are legislation, precedents,
1. Introduction to the Law and customs and agreement. Two major branches of law are civil law
its Types and criminal law.
The Constitution of Pakistan contains preamble, twelve parts,
2. The Process of the Legislation two hundred eighty articles and five schedules. Pakistan has a
as per the Constitution Federal Parliamentary System of government, with the
President as the Head of State and popularly elected Prime

SPOTLIGHT
3. Objective Based Q&A Minister as Head of Government.
STICKY NOTES The legislation may be made by Parliament (Act of Parliament
and Ordinance) or delegated legislation.
Act of Parliament is made by the National Assembly, the Senate
and the President. In case of Money Bills, the approval of the
Senate is not required.
The Ordinance is promulgated by the President when deemed
necessary by the President if the National Assembly and the
Senate are not in session.
In delegated legislation, power is delegated by the Parliament to

STICKY NOTES
a minister or public body to make subordinate legislation for
specified purposes only.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 1


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. INTRODUCTION TO THE LAW AND ITS TYPES


1.1 Definition of Law
Law means a set of rules or a system of rules of conduct designed and enforced by the state to control and regulate
the conduct of people.
Law is not stagnant. As circumstances and conditions in a society change, laws are also changed as per the
requirements of the society.
The word law may have different meaning for different situations. It is often preceded by an adjective to give it
a clearer meaning e.g. Civil Law, Criminal Law, Business Law etc.

1.2 Definition of Mercantile Law


AT A GLANCE

Business Law is the part of civil law which deals with the rights and obligations of persons dealing with each
other. It includes laws relating to contracts, partnership, sale of goods, negotiable instruments etc.

1.3 Why Chartered Accountants study law


The intention of studying law in Chartered Accountancy is not to become an expert lawyer dealing with complex
legal issues.
The objective of studying law in Chartered Accountancy is to be aware when legal problems arise, be able to
judge when outside assistance is required, evaluate the financial implications of law and also communicate with
the lawyers.

1.4 Where to apply law in practical life


SPOTLIGHT

A general knowledge of some important legal principles and how they apply to certain problems will help in
avoiding conflict with the people around us. Civil law involves the problems that impact on people’s everyday
life like debts, tenancy issues, sale of goods etc. One should know the law to which he is subject because generally
ignorance of law is neither excuse nor defence.

1.5 Sources of law in Pakistan


The law consists of rules that regulate the conduct of individuals, businesses, and other organizations within
society.
The legal system is derived from English common law (including doctrine of equity) and is based on the
Constitution of Pakistan 1973 as well as Islamic law (Sharia). Thus we can say that in Pakistan the main sources
STICKY NOTES

of law are following:

1.5.1 Legislation
It is the law created by the Parliament and other bodies to whom it has delegated authority. It includes the Act of
Parliament, the Ordinance promulgated by the President of Pakistan and the delegated legislations.

1.5.2 Precedent (case law)


Precedents are judgments or decisions of a superior court which are binding on the subordinate courts.

1.5.3 Customs
Certain customs, practices and beliefs are so vital and intrinsic part of a social and economic system that they are
treated as if they were laws e.g. Sharia laws.

1.5.4 Agreement
Parties in their agreement stipulate terms for themselves which constitute law for the contracting parties.

2 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

1.6 Civil law and criminal law


There are several branches of the law. Each deals with a different area of law and legal relationships. Two major
branches of the law are civil law and criminal law.

DIFFERENCE Civil Law Criminal Law

1. Definition and Civil law sets out the rights and duties Criminal law is concerned with conduct
explanation of persons as between themselves. The that is considered so undesirable that the
person whose rights have been State punishes persons who transgress.
affected can claim a remedy from the
Legal action may be brought by the State
wrongdoer.
against individuals who are accused of
A violation of the civil law is a tort (a being in breach of the criminal law. It is the

AT A GLANCE
wrongdoing), but is not a crime. responsibility of the State (and not private
individuals) to bring these legal actions, in
A civil case might therefore be
criminal trials.
identified as: Tanveer v Khatri where a
case is brought to the civil court by A criminal case might therefore be
Tanveer (the ‘plaintiff’) who is making identified as: State v Khatri where a case is
a claim against Khatri (the defendant). brought to the criminal court by the State
against Khatri (the “accused”).

2. Purpose The purpose is to provide a means The purpose is to regulate the society by
whereby an injured party can obtain the threat of punishment.
compensation.

SPOTLIGHT
3. Harm caused The claimant sues the defendant for The State (Government) prosecutes the
harm caused. accused (the defendant) whether or not
the harm was caused.

4. Burden of proof If the claimant can prove the wrong on If the state can prove the offence beyond
the balance of probabilities, his all reasonable doubt, the prosecution is
litigation is successful and the successful and the accused is found guilty
defendant is held liable. and convicted.

5. Remedy The civil court may order the The criminal court may sentence the
defendant to pay damages or it might defendant to a fine or it might impose
order some other remedy such as some other fine such as imprisonment or

STICKY NOTES
specific performance or injunction. death sentence.

 Example 01: Civil laws


 property disputes (Transfer of property Act)
 work-related disputes (employment law)
 accusations of negligence (negligent behaviour) (Tort)
 claims by consumers against manufacturers or service providers
 commercial disputes between business entities (commercial law)
 copyright disputes
 claims of defamation of character (Tort)
 disputes about an alleged breach of contract (Contract Act, 1872)

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 3


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 02: Criminal laws


 Pakistan Penal Code
 Anti-Money Laundering Act
 Prevention of Electronics Crimes Act

Application on business
Many of the legal aspects of commercial and business law are aspects of the civil law, but the criminal law may
also apply. For example, fraud and money laundering are criminal activities that may occur in business.
It is also important to remember that the same action may be in breach of the criminal law and also a tort in civil
law. In such a situation, the action may give rise to:

AT A GLANCE

criminal prosecution by the State; and


 civil action by a private person, claiming a remedy such as damages.
 Example 03:
Suppose that a train company operates a train service, and there is a major accident involving
loss of life and injury to passengers. The State may claim that the train company or its senior
managers are guilty of a breach of the criminal law and bring a case in the criminal court.
Individuals who have been injured in the crash and individuals who have lost a relative killed in
the crash may bring civil actions against the train company, demanding compensation.
Business managers must therefore be aware of both the criminal law and civil law implications
of their activities.
SPOTLIGHT

 Practice Question 01:


Distinguish between civil law and criminal law giving two examples of each.
 Solution:
Civil law regulates the disputes in respect of rights and obligations between persons dealing with
each other. The court does not punish the wrong doers but imposes a settlement, either by
awarding damages or granting injunctions or other orders.
Examples of civil laws are company law, rent law, commercial law, family laws and employment
law.
Criminal law is a body of law:
STICKY NOTES

 defining conduct prohibited by law against the community at large;


 regulating how suspects are investigated, charged and tried and;
 establishing punishments for convicted offenders / accused.
Criminal law deals with crimes such as murder, violence, terrorism, theft, robbery etc.

1.7 Basic structure of Constitution of Islamic Republic of Pakistan

Introduction
The Constitution of the Islamic Republic of Pakistan was approved by the Parliament on April 10, 1973 and
ratified on August 14, 1973. The Constitution is the supreme law and sets the governing principles of the country
and contains the articles covering fundamental rights, state's structure, political system, mandate of different
levels of government, mandate and separate powers of cabinets, judiciary etc. The Parliament cannot make any
laws which is against the Constitution.

4 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

The Constitution contains preamble, twelve parts, two hundred eighty articles and five schedules briefly
introduced as follows:

Preamble
It defines the objectives of the provisions of the Constitution. It identifies that the Muslims will be enabled to live
in accordance with the teachings of Quran and Sunnah while provisions be made for minorities to practice their
religion and culture. It also entails guarantee for fundamental rights, safeguarding depressed classes, securing
independence of judiciary, safeguarding sovereign rights.

Part I – Introductory [Articles 1–6]


It identifies the country as Islamic Republic of Pakistan divided into four territories and defined the religion of
the state. It also includes provisions such as elimination of all sorts of exploitation, rights of individuals to be

AT A GLANCE
dealt in accordance with the law, loyalty to the state and abiding by the Constitution and the defining high treason
along with its punishment.

Part II – Fundamental Rights and Principles of Policy [Articles 7–40]


It begins with the definition of the State and continues with detailing of the laws regarding fundamental right
and principles of policy. Fundamental rights include laws that deem void which are inconsistent with
fundamental rights, safeguards regarding arrest and detention; prohibition of slavery; child labour and all forms
of forced labour; right to enter lawful profession and trade; right to education and safeguard against
discrimination etc.
The second part contains policies such as discouraging prejudices and discrimination, providing free and
compulsory education and fostering goodwill and friendly relations among all nations etc.

SPOTLIGHT
Part III – The Federation of Pakistan [Articles 41–100]
It includes the eligibility of President of Pakistan, term of office, powers vested in the position, removal of the
President, job responsibilities and limitations such as exercising functions in accordance with the advice of the
Cabinet or Prime Minister.
This part also includes information about the composition, duration and meetings of the Parliament and Senate,
qualifications and disqualifications for membership of the Parliament, introduction and passing of Bills etc.

Part IV – Provinces [Articles 101-140A]


It includes entails composition and function of the provincial governments and governor. It also includes the
financial procedure such as Provincial Consolidated Fund and public account and procedure relating to annual

STICKY NOTES
budget statement and ordinances etc.

Part V – Relations between Federation and Provinces [Articles 141–159]


It includes distribution of legislative powers, administrative relations between Federation and Provinces such as
obligation of Federation and Provinces and inter-provincial trade etc. It also entails special provisions relating
to Council of common interests, National Economic Council, broadcasting and telecasting etc.

Part VI – Finance, Property, Contracts and Suits [Articles 160–174]


It includes distribution of revenues between the federation and the provinces and other financial provisions such
as exemption and imposition of certain taxes. It also entails borrowing by Federal and Provincial government;
appointment, powers and functions of Auditor General of Pakistan. This part also includes provisions regarding
property, contracts, liabilities and suits.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 5


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Part VII – The Judicature [Articles 175–212]


It encompasses establishments, jurisdictions and functions of courts (Supreme Court, High Courts and Federal
Shariat Court), appointment of judges and general provisions such as contempt of court, remuneration of judges,
Supreme Judicial Council etc.

Part VIII – Elections [Articles 213–226]


It includes the formation and duties of Chief Election Commissioner and Election Commissions along with
electoral laws and conduct of elections.

Part IX – Islamic Provisions [Articles 227–231]


It includes provisions relating to the Holy Quran and Sunnah along with composition and functions of the Islamic
Council.
AT A GLANCE

Part X – Emergency Provisions [Articles 232–237]


It includes proclamation of emergency on account of war or internal disturbance etc., power to suspend
fundamental rights during emergency period, revocation of proclamation etc.

Part XI – Amendment of Constitution [Articles 238–239]


It includes amendment of Constitution by Parliament through Constitution Amendment Bill.

Part XII – Miscellaneous [Articles 240–280]


It includes establishment and constitution of Public Service Commission, command and functions of Armed
Forces etc. Moreover, it comprises definition and administration of tribal areas; protection to President,
SPOTLIGHT

Governor, Minister; national language etc.

Schedules

First Schedule Laws exempted from the operation of Article 8(1), 8(2), 8(3b), and 8(4)
Second Schedule Election of President
Third Schedule Oaths of Office
Fourth Schedule Legislative Lists
Fifth Schedule Remuneration and Terms and Conditions of Service of Judges
STICKY NOTES

6 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

2. THE PROCESS OF LEGISLATION AS PER THE CONSTITUTION


2.1 Governing Structure [Article 50]
Pakistan has a Federal Parliamentary System of government, with the President as the Head of State and
popularly elected Prime Minister as Head of Government. The Federal Legislature is a bicameral Majlis-e-Shoora
(Parliament), composed of the President, National Assembly (Lower House) and Senate (Upper House).

The President [Article 41, 44, 46 and 48]


 The President of Pakistan is Pakistan’s Head of State and represent the unity of republic.
 The President must be a Muslim.
 The President is elected for a five-year term by Senate, National Assembly and members of Provincial

AT A GLANCE
Assemblies.
 The President is eligible for re-election, but no individual may hold the office for more than two
consecutive terms.
 The majority party in the National Assembly usually nominates and elects a person as the President.
 The Prime Minister shall keep the President informed on all matters of internal and foreign policy and
on all legislative proposals the Federal Government intends to bring before Majlis-e-Shoora
(Parliament).
 The President approves the statutes passed by the National Assembly and the Senate.
 The President acts on and in accordance with the advice of the cabinet or the Prime Minister.

Prime Minister [Article 90 and 91]

SPOTLIGHT
 The Prime Minister must be nominated and elected by a majority of members in the National Assembly.
That individual is then appointed as Prime Minister by the President.
 The Prime Minister is assisted by the Federal Cabinet. A council of ministers whose members are
appointed by the President on the advice of the Prime Minister.
 Federal Ministers are supported by secretaries and other government officers appointed in each
department for ensuring that policies formulated by the government are acted upon.

Senate [Article 59, 60 and 49]


 The Senate is a permanent legislative body with equal representation from each of the four Provinces
with representatives elected by the members of their respective Provincial Assemblies. There are also

STICKY NOTES
representatives from Islamabad Capital Territory.
 Members are elected for a period of six years. Half the members retire after three years and are replaced
by the equal number of newly elected senators.
 Senate is a permanent institution. The election of all members is not held at the same time and so it
continues to be present on a permanent basis.
 The members elect from themselves a chairman and a Deputy Chairman.
 The Chairman of the Senate under the constitution is next in line to act as President if the office becomes
vacant and until such time a new President can be formally elected.
 The role of the Senate is to promote national cohesion and harmony and to alleviate fears of the smaller
provinces regarding domination by any one province because of its majority, in the National Assembly.
 All statutes passed by the National Assembly are also approved by the Senate with the exception of
Money Bills.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 7


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

National Assembly [Article 51, 52 and 53]


 The seats for the National Assembly are determined on the basis of population of provinces.
 The members on general seats are elected for a period of five years on the basis of direct votes by the
voters registered. There are also reserved seats for women and non-Muslims.
 The members elect from themselves Speaker, Deputy Speaker and Prime Minister.
 The most important function of the National Assembly is law making and formulation of policies.

2.2 Process of Legislation

2.2.1 Act of Parliament


The Bill in respect of any matter, other than money bill, may originate in either House (i.e. the National Assembly
AT A GLANCE

or the Senate).

Scenario 1: The Bill passed without amendment [Article 70]


 A Bill is originated and passed in either the National Assembly or the Senate.
 The Bill is transmitted to the other House and passed by the other House without any amendment.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

Scenario 2: The Bill passed with amendment [Article 70]


 A Bill is originated and passed in either the National Assembly or the Senate.
 The Bill is transmitted to the other House and passed by the other House with amendment.

SPOTLIGHT

The Bill is sent back to the House in which it was originated and that House passes the Bill with those
amendments.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

Scenario 3: The Bill is rejected or not passed by the other House [Article 70]
 A Bill is originated and passed in either the National Assembly or the Senate.
 The Bill is transmitted to the other House and is either rejected or not passed within 90 days by that
other House.
 The Bill at the request of the House in which it was originated shall be considered in the joint sitting of
both the Houses.
STICKY NOTES

 The Bill is passed by the votes of the majority of the members present and voting in the joint sitting.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

Scenario 4: The Bill with amendment is not passed [Article 70]


 A Bill is originated and passed in either the National Assembly or the Senate.
 The Bill is transmitted to the other House and passed by the other House with amendment.
 The Bill is sent back to the House in which it was originated and is not passed by that House with such
amendment.
 The Bill at the request of the House in which it was originated shall be considered in the joint sitting of
both the Houses.
 The Bill is passed by the votes of the majority of the members present and voting in the joint sitting.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

8 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

Scenario 5: The Money Bill [Article 73]


 A Money Bill (relating to finance or tax etc.) is originated in the National Assembly.
 A copy of the Bill is sent to the Senate for recommendations.
 The National Assembly passes the Bill with or without incorporating the recommendations of the Senate.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

The Power of the President [Article 75]


The President shall assent to the Bill within ten days or return it to the Parliament for reconsideration (in case
of a Bill other than Money Bill) of any provision or any amendment therein.

Scenario 6: The President returns the Bill for reconsideration [Article 75]

AT A GLANCE
 The Bill is returned by the President for reconsideration by the Parliament in joint sitting.
 It is again passed with or without amendment by the Parliament by the votes of the majority of the
members of both Houses present and voting.
 The Bill is presented to the President for assent.

Lapse of the Bill [Article 76]


A Bill shall lapse on dissolution of the National Assembly if:
 It is pending in or passed by the National Assembly; and
 It is pending in the Senate.
A Bill shall not lapse on dissolution of the National Assembly if:

SPOTLIGHT
 It is pending in the Senate; and
 It has not been passed by the National Assembly.

2.2.2 Power of President to Promulgate Ordinances [Article 89]


The President if deems necessary to take immediate action, he has power to make an Ordinance when the Senate
or the National Assembly are not in session.
Such Ordinance promulgated thus, shall have the same force and effect as an Act of the Parliament.
The Ordinance shall stand repealed after one hundred and twenty days if it is not presented or passed
 by the National Assembly in case of Money Bill and

STICKY NOTES
 by both the Houses if it is other than Money Bill.
However, National Assembly may extend any Ordinance for another period of one hundred and twenty days by
passing a resolution. If National Assembly, before expiration of above one hundred and twenty days, passes a
resolution disapproving any Ordinance, it shall expire on the day of passing of such resolution.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 9


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

The chart below shows the process of legislation

Process of Legislation

When National When National Assembly is


Assembly is in session not in session

President
Money Bills All other Bills
AT A GLANCE

National
National Ordinance
Assembly Senate
Assembly

President
SPOTLIGHT

Sent for reconsideration to


Parliament (joint sitting of National
Assembly and Senate)
Assent Reject /
Amend

Act / Law

2.3 Delegated Legislation


STICKY NOTES

In Delegated Legislation power is given to an Executive (a minister or public body to make subordinate or
delegated legislation for specified purposes only) e.g. local authorities are given statutory powers to make bye-
laws which apply within a specific locality.

Control over delegated legislation


Parliament has some control over delegated legislation by restriction and defining the power to make rules.
Rules made under delegated power to move legislation may be challenged in the courts on the grounds that it is
ultra vires. In other words, it exceeds the prescribed limits or has been made without due compliance. If the
objection is valid the court declares it void.

Advantages of delegated legislation


Time: Parliament does not have time to examine matters in detail
Expert opinion: Much of the content of delegated legislation is technical and is better worked out in consultation
with professional, commercial or industrial groups outside Parliament.

10 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

Flexible: Delegated legislation is more flexible than an Act of Parliament. It is far simpler to amend a piece of
delegated legislation than to amend an Act of Parliament.

Disadvantages of delegated legislation


The main criticism of delegated legislation is that it takes law making away from the democratically elected
members. Power to make law is given to unelected civil servants and experts working under the supervision of
a government minister.
Because delegated legislation can be produced in large amounts the volume of such law making becomes
unmanageable and it is impossible to keep up-to-date.
 Practice Question 02:
Briefly describe the process of legislation in case of a Money Bill when:

AT A GLANCE
 National assembly is in session
 National assembly is not in session
 Solution:
Legislation in case of a Money Bill when National assembly is in session:
A Money Bill shall originate in the National Assembly and after it has been passed by the
Assembly it shall, without being transmitted to the Senate, be presented to the President for
assent.
Legislation in case of a Money Bill when National assembly is not in session:
When National assembly is not in session and President deems necessary to take immediate

SPOTLIGHT
action, he has the power to issue an Ordinance.
Such Ordinance promulgated thus, shall have the same force and effect as an Act of the
parliament.
However, the Ordinance shall stand repealed after 120 days if it is not presented or passed by
the National assembly.
 Practice Question 03:
How is a law promulgated when national assembly is not in session? Is such law in any way
different from an Act of parliament? What is its tenure?
 Solution:

STICKY NOTES
If the President deems necessary to take an immediate action, he has the power to promulgate
an Ordinance if the Senate and National Assembly are not in session. Such Ordinances have the
same force and effect as an Act of the Parliament. The Ordinance stands repealed after one
hundred twenty days if it is not passed by the National Assembly or by National Assembly and
Senate both as the case may be. However, National Assembly may extend it for another period of
one hundred twenty days. Thereafter it will stand repealed.
 Practice Question 04:
Specify Pakistan’s system of government and identify Senate’s role in the legislation process.
 Solution:
System of government:
Pakistan has a Federal Parliamentary System of government, with the President as the Head of
State and Prime Minister as Head of Government. The Federal Legislature is a bicameral Majlis-
e-Shoora(Parliament), composed of the President, National Assembly (Lower House) and Senate
(Upper House).

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 11


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Role of Senate:
The role of the Senate is to approve all statutes passed by the National Assembly with the
exception of Money Bills.
 Practice Question 05:
Briefly describe how delegated legislation takes place and also describe how control is exercised
over delegated legislation.
 Solution:
In delegated legislation power is given to an executive (a minister or public body to make
subordinate or delegated legislation) for specified purpose only. For example, local authorities
are given statutory powers to make bye-laws which apply within a specific locality.
AT A GLANCE

Control over delegated legislation is exercised in following ways:


i. Parliament exercises control over delegated legislation by restricting or defining power
to make rules
ii. Rules made under delegated power to move legislation may be challenged in the courts
on the grounds of being ultra vires (exceeding the authority).
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

12 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. The President is the head of the state and he is elected for a five-year term by
(a) Senate and National Assembly
(b) National Assembly and the members of Provincial Assemblies
(c) Senate and the members of Provincial Assemblies
(d) Senate, National Assembly and the members of Provincial Assemblies

02. In a criminal case, what is the normal burden of proof place upon the prosecution?
(a) Beyond any doubt

AT A GLANCE
(b) Beyond all reasonable doubt
(c) Beyond any reasonable doubt
(d) Balance of probabilities

03. In a civil case of Talal vs Kashif where a case is brought to the civil court by Mr. Talal who is filing a suit
against Mr. Kashif. State the legal position
(a) Mr. Talal is plaintiff and Mr. Kashif is the defendant
(b) Mr. Talal is defendant and Mr. Kashif is the plaintiff
(c) Mr. Talal is accused and Mr. Kashif is the complainant

SPOTLIGHT
(d) Mr. Talal is complainant and Mr. Kashif is the accused

04. The criminal law aims to:


(a) Compensate injured parties
(b) Recover property which has been taken from the true owner
(c) Enforce legal obligations
(d) Penalize wrongdoers

STICKY NOTES
05. Those rules and principles that govern and regulate social conduct and observance of which can be
enforced in courts of law, is known as:
(a) Law
(b) Rules
(c) Policies
(d) Customs

06. Property disputes, work related disputes, copyright disputes and claims by consumer against
manufacturer are examples of
(a) Administrative law
(b) Labour law
(c) Constitutional law
(d) Civil law

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 13


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

07. Person found guilty of a crime is the


(a) Plaintiff
(b) Respondent
(c) Convict
(d) Defendant

08. Pakistan has a Federal Parliamentary system of government. The federal legislature is a bicameral
Majlis e Shoora (Parliament), composed of
(a) President, Governor and Prime Minister
(b) President, National Assembly and Provincial Assembly
AT A GLANCE

(c) President, National Assembly and Senate


(d) President, Prime Minister and National Assembly

09. The Prime Minister is assisted by a Federal Cabinet. A council of ministers whose members are
appointed by the President on the advice of the
(a) Chief Justice
(b) Governor
(c) Attorney General
(d) Prime Minister
SPOTLIGHT

10. If the Ordinance is not presented or passed by the National Assembly in case of money bill and by both
houses if it is other than money bill, it shall stand repealed after
(a) One hundred and twenty days
(b) Ninety days
(c) Sixty days
(d) One hundred days

11. All statutes passed by the National Assembly are also approved by the Senate before proceeding to the
STICKY NOTES

President for his assent with the exception of


(a) Treasury bill
(b) Money bill
(c) Social security bill
(d) Industrial relation bill

12. The Senate is the permanent legislative body with equal representation from each of the four Provinces
with representative elected by the members of their respective
(a) Chief Minister
(b) Governor
(c) High Court
(d) Provincial Assembly

14 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

13. A money bill shall originate in the National Assembly after it has been passed by the National Assembly
it shall (without being transmitted to the Senate) be presented to the
(a) President of Pakistan
(b) Chief Justice of Pakistan
(c) Chief of the Army Staff
(d) Governor of the Province

14. The President my return a Bill for reconsideration by:


(a) The National Assembly only

AT A GLANCE
(b) The Senate only
(c) The National Assembly and the Senate, independently
(d) The National Assembly and the Senate, in Joint Sitting

15. Which of the following is not an advantage of having delegated legislations?


(a) Flexibility with which law is made
(b) Involvement of experts in law making
(c) Time saving of the parliament
(d) Bulk and extensive volume

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 15


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (d) President is elected for a five year term by Senate, National Assembly and members of
Provincial Assembly.

02. (b) In criminal case, the guilt of an accused person needs to be proved beyond all reasonable doubt.

03. (a) In a civil case the one who is filing a suit is known as plaintiff and against whom the case is filed
is known as defendant.

04. (d) The criminal law is not to compensate injured parties but to punish and penalize the
wrongdoers.
AT A GLANCE

05. (a) Law is a set of rules and system of rules designed and enforced by the state to control the
conduct of people.

06. (d) The civil law primarily deals with disputes between individuals and organizations.

07. (c) When an accused found guilty of a crime he is known as a convicted person.

08. (c) President is the head of state, National Assembly is the lower house and Senate is the upper
house.

09. (d) Prime Minister is the head of the Government.


SPOTLIGHT

10. (a) One hundred and twenty days.

11. (b) A Money Bill shall originate in National Assembly then directly be presented to the President
for assent.

12. (d) The Provincial Assemblies are responsible for electing the senators from their respective
provinces.

13. (a) The President has got the powers to sign any piece of legislation.

14. (d) The National Assembly and the Senate, in Joint Sitting
STICKY NOTES

15. (d) Bulk and extensive volume makes it unmanageable and therefore, is one of the disadvantages
of delegated legislation.

16 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM

STICKY NOTES

Civil law and criminal laws are distinguished on following points:


1. Application (definition) 4. Burden of proof
2. Purpose 5. Remedy
3. Whether or not harm was caused

The process of leglislation includes various scenarios:

AT A GLANCE
1. The Bill is passed without amendment
2. The Bill is passed with amendment
3. The Bill is rejected or not passed by the other House
4. The Bill with amendment is not passed
5. The Money Bill
6. The President returns the Bill for reconsideration
7. The Ordinance promulgated by the President.

SPOTLIGHT
In delegated legislation, the Parliament delegates its power to make law to
Executive/experts. This has following advantages and disadvantages:
Advantages Disadvantages
1. Time saving 1. Undemocratic
2. Experts’ input 2. Bulk volume
3. Flexible procedures

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 17


CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION TO THE LEGAL SYSTEM CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

18 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 2

OFFER, ACCEPTANCE
AND REVOCATION

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
A contract is an agreement between two or more parties which
the law will enforce. An agreement comes into existence by the
AT A GLANCE
process of offer by one party and its unqualified acceptance by
the other party.
SPOTLIGHT
An agreement may be made by express words spoken or
1. Introduction to Contract written, or it may be implied when it is inferred from the
conduct of the parties or form the circumstances.
2. Communication, Acceptance
and Revocation of proposals An agreement may be a social agreement or a legal agreement.
A social agreement does not have legal consequences i.e. in case
3. Objective Based Q&A
of breach the parties cannot enforce a right in court of law. A
legal agreement has legal consequences and parties can enforce

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES
it in court of law for remedies in case of its breach.
An offer is an undertaking by the offer or to be contractually
bound in the event of proper acceptance of the offer by the
offeree. An offer may be terminated before its acceptance.
The communication of a proposal (offer) is complete when it
comes to the knowledge of the person to whom it is made.
The communication of an acceptance is complete:
a) as against the proposer, when it is put in a course of
transmission to him, so as to be out of the power of the
acceptor.

STICKY NOTES
b) as against the acceptor, when it comes to the knowledge
of the proposer.
The communication of a revocation is complete:
a) as against the person making it, when it is put in a
course of transmission to the person to whom it is
made, so as to be out of the power of the person who
makes it.
b) as against the person to whom it is made, when it comes
to his knowledge.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 19


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. INTRODUCTION TO CONTRACT
1.1 Short title, extent and commencement [Section 1]
The law governing contracts between persons is the Contract Act, 1872. It extends to the whole of Pakistan and
it is applicable since the first day of September 1872.

1.2 Definitions and basic concept

1.2.1 Definition: Proposal [Section 2(a)]


When one person signifies to another his willingness to do or to abstain from doing anything, with a view to
obtaining the assent of that other to such act or abstinence, he is said to make a “proposal”.
AT A GLANCE

Proposal is also called an “offer”.


 Example 01:
Adeel offers to buy bike from Babar for Rs. 50,000. Here Adeel has made a proposal to Babar in
order to obtain assent of Babar to buy his bike.

1.2.2 Definition: Promise [Section 2(b)]


When the person to whom the proposal is made signifies his assent to it, the proposal is said to be accepted. A
proposal, when accepted becomes a “promise”.
SPOTLIGHT

Proposal Acceptance Promise

 Example 02:
Adeel offers to buy bike from Babar for Rs. 50,000 to which Babar responds positively. Here Adeel
has made an offer and Babar has accepted it.
STICKY NOTES

1.2.3 Definition: Promisor and Promisee [Section 2(c)]


The person making the proposal is called the “promisor” and the person accepting the proposal is called the
“promisee”.
 Example 03:
Adeel offers to buy bike from Babar for Rs. 50,000 to which Babar responds positively. Here Adeel
has made an offer and Babar has accepted it. Adeel is promisor and Babar is promisee.
Promisor is also called “offeror” and promisee is also called “offeree”.

20 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

1.2.4 Definition: Agreement [Section 2(e)]


Every promise and every set of promises forming the consideration for each other is an “agreement”.

Promise(s) Consideration Agreement

 Example 04:

AT A GLANCE
Adeel offers to buy computer from Babar for Rs. 50,000 to which Babar responds positively. Here
Adeel’s promise to pay Rs. 50,000 is the consideration for Babar’s promise and Babar’s promise
to sell the computer is the consideration for Adeel’s promise.

1.2.5 Definition: Contract [Section 2(h)]


An agreement enforceable by law is a “contract”.

Agreement Enforceability Contract

SPOTLIGHT
1.2.6 Enforceability
Every contract is an agreement, but every agreement is not always a contract. An agreement creating a legal
obligation is said to be enforceable by law. The parties to an agreement must be bound to perform their promises
and in case of default by either of them, must intend to sue. For an agreement to be enforceable by law there
should be legal obligation instead of social, moral or religious obligation.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 05:
Adeel offers to sell his furniture to Babar for Rs. 50,000. Babar accepts this offer. In this
agreement if there is default by either party, an action for breach of contract can be enforced
through a court of law provided all the essential elements of a valid contract are present in this
agreement.
In case of social or domestic agreements, the usual presumption is that the parties do not intend to create legal
relationship but in commercial or business agreements, the usual presumption is that the parties intend to create
legal relationship unless otherwise agreed upon.
 Example 06:
Adeel invited Babar on a dinner at his home. Babar accepted the invitation. It is a social
agreement. If Adeel fails to serve dinner to Babar then Babar cannot go to court for enforcing the
agreement and similarly if Babar did not turn up then Adeel cannot go to court for enforcing the
agreement.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 21


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.3 Promises, express and implied [Section 9]


If the proposal or acceptance of any promise is made in words, the promise is said to be express.
If the proposal or acceptance is made otherwise than in words, the promise is said to be implied.
 Example 07:
Adeel offers (on telephone) to sell his car to Babar for certain sum and Babar in reply informs
Adeel that he accepts the offer, there is an express contract.
 Example 08:
Abid a shoe shiner starts polishing the shoes of Sajid in his presence, and Sajid allows him to do
so, there is an implied contract.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

22 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

2. COMMUNICATION, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION OF PROPOSALS


2.1 Proposal/Offer

2.1.1 Definition: proposal [Section 2(a)]


When one person signifies to another his willingness to do or to abstain from doing anything, with a view to
obtaining the assent of that other to such act or abstinence, he is said to make a “proposal”.
Proposal is also called an “offer”.
 Example 09:
Adeel offers to buy bike from Babar for Rs. 50,000. Here Adeel has made a proposal to Babar in
order to obtain assent of Babar to buy his bike.

AT A GLANCE
Additional points
The following points are important:
 A person cannot make offer to himself.
 A valid offer is one which is certain and definite.
 An offer may be subject to condition. When there are special terms and conditions in an offer, these must
be specifically communicated to other party.
 An offer is different from an invitation of an offer. The intention in invitation of an offer is to circulate
information of his readiness to do the transaction. Such intentions are not offers and do not tantamount
to promise on acceptance.

SPOTLIGHT
 Example 10:
Salman purchased a horse from Irfan and promised to buy another, if the first one proves lucky.
Salman refused to buy the second horse. Irfan could not enforce the agreement, it being loose and
vague.
 Example 11:
Adeel asks Mohsin to send the reply of his offer by email but Mohsin sends reply by letter. Adeel
may reject such acceptance.
 Example 12:
Iqbal displays goods for an auction sale. It is not an offer. Offer will come from buyer in form of

STICKY NOTES
bid.
 Example 13:
Goods were displayed in a departmental store for sale and self-service system was there. One
customer selected an item. Here the display of goods is an invitation to offer and selection by the
customer is an offer to buy.
2.1.2 Communication [Section 3]

The communication of proposals is deemed to be made by any act or omission of the party proposing by
which he intends to communicate such proposal or which has the effect of communicating it. It means that
an offer can be made by words spoken or written or through conduct of the person.

 Example 14:
A shoe shiner starts shinning one’s shoes, without being asked to do so, in such circumstances
that any reasonable man could guess that he expects to be paid for this, this is an offer
communicated impliedly.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 23


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 15:
Mohsin says to Noor that he is willing to sell his motor cycle to him for Rs. 20,000. This is an offer
communicated expressly.

2.1.3 Communication when Complete [Section 4]


The communication of a proposal is complete when it comes to the knowledge of the person to whom it is made.
 Example 16:
Azam proposes, by letter, to sell a house to Babar at a certain price. The communication of the
proposal is complete when Babar receives the letter.

2.1.4 Revocation of proposal [Section 5]


AT A GLANCE

A proposal may be revoked at any time before the communication of its acceptance is complete as against the
proposer, but not afterwards.
 Example 17:
Adeel proposes, by a letter sent by a post, to sell his house to Jazib. Jazib intends to accept the
offer but has not posted the letter of acceptance yet. Adeel may revoke his offer.
 Example 18:
Adeel proposes, by a letter sent by a post, to sell his house to Jazib. Jazib has posted the letter of
acceptance. Adeel cannot revoke his offer.

2.1.5 Manner of revocation of proposal [Section 6]


SPOTLIGHT

A proposal may be revoked in following ways:


a) by the communication of notice of revocation by the proposer to the other party;
b) by the lapse of the time prescribed in such proposal for its acceptance, or, if no time is so prescribed, by
the lapse of a reasonable time, without communication of the acceptance;
c) by the failure of the acceptor to fulfil a condition precedent to acceptance; or
d) by the death or insanity of the proposer, if the fact of his death or insanity comes to the knowledge of the
acceptor before acceptance.
 Example 19:
STICKY NOTES

Azam, at an auction gives the highest bid to buy Babar’s goods. He withdraws the bid before the
fall of hammer. The offer is revoked and cannot be accepted.
 Example 20:
Ameer offers to sell his cycle to Ghalib and keeps the offer open for ten days. Ghalib does not
accept the offer in the ten days. The offer is lapsed.
 Example 21:
Maria applied for shares of a company in June but allotment was made in November. Maria
refused to accept the shares. It was held that Maria could refuse to take shares because the offer
had lapsed after the expiry of a reasonable time.
 Example 22:
Jazib offers to sell his scooter to Babar, for Rs. 40,000 if Babar joins the ABC Club within a week.
Babar did not join the Club within a week, the offer stands terminated.

24 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

 Example 23:
Zain offered Dawood his car for Rs. 3 million on 15th January. Zain died on 18th January. Dawood
accepted Zain’s offer on 20 th January when he became aware of his death. The offer cannot be
accepted as it has been terminated.
 Example 24:
Zain offered Dawood his car for Rs. 3 million on 15th January. Zain died on 18th January. Dawood
accepted Zain’s offer on 20th January in ignorance of the fact of Zain’s death. There is contract
between Zain and Dawood and Zain’s legal representative are liable to perform it.

Additional points
The following points are also relevant:

AT A GLANCE
 An offer is also terminated by non-acceptance or rejection by offeree.
 An offer is also terminated by counter offer. A counter offer is an offer by offeree in response to the
original offer.
 An offer once accepted becomes a contract and cannot be revoked.
 Example 25:
Ameer offers to sell his cycle to Ghalib and keeps the offer open for ten days. Ghalib refuses after
three days. The offer terminates although the period of ten days has not yet expired.
 Example 26:
Wajid offered to sell a farm to Hamid for Rs. 1,000. Hamid offered Rs. 950. Wajid refused the offer.
Subsequently Hamid offered Rs. 1,000. Held, there was no contract as Hamid by offering Rs. 950

SPOTLIGHT
had rejected the original offer.

2.2 Acceptance

2.2.1 Definition: acceptance [Section 2(b)]


When the person to whom the proposal is made signifies his assent to it, the proposal is said to be accepted.
Therefore, the act of signifying the assent to a proposal is “acceptance”.
 Example 27:
Adeel offers to buy bike from Babar for Rs. 50,000 to which Babar responds positively. Here Adeel
has made an offer and Babar has accepted it.

STICKY NOTES
2.2.2 Communication [Section 3]
The communication of acceptance of proposals is deemed to be made by any act or omission of the party
accepting by which he intends to communicate such acceptance or which has the effect of communicating it.
Note: A proposal is not considered accepted if the offeree remains silent. It cannot be in the form of negative
confirmation i.e. if it is not accepted within a specific time then it will be presumed to have been accepted.
 Example 28:
Azam wrote to Babar to sell his book adding that if he did not reply within 5 days, the offer would
be considered accepted. Babar did not reply and a week has passed. There is no contract as
silence cannot be considered as acceptance.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 25


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2.2.3 Communication when Complete [Section 4]


The communication of an acceptance is complete:
a) as against the proposer, when it is put in a course of transmission to him, so as to be out of the power of
the acceptor.
b) as against the acceptor, when it comes to the knowledge of the proposer.
 Example 29:
Adeel offers, by letter, to sell a van to Kashif for Rs. 100,000. The letter reaches Kashif on 8th
March. Kashif accepts by a letter sent by post on 9th March. The letter reaches Adeel on 11th
March. The communication of the acceptance is complete:
 As against Adeel when the letter is posted i.e. on 9th March
AT A GLANCE

 As against Kashif when the letter is received by Adeel i.e. on 11th March.

2.2.4 Conditions for valid acceptance [Section 7]


A valid acceptance:
a) must be absolute and unqualified (unconditional); and
b) must be expressed in the manner prescribed in the proposal; or
c) must be expressed in some usual and reasonable manner if the proposal did not prescribe any manner.
 Example 30:
Laila offered to Maria her scooter for cash of Rs. 40,000. Maria accepted the offer and tendered
SPOTLIGHT

Rs. 39,000 cash down, promising to pay Rs. 1,000 by the evening. There is no contract, as the
acceptance was not absolute and unqualified.
 Example 31:
Azam makes an offer to Babar and asks him to accept the offer by telegram. Babar sends his
acceptance by post. It is not a valid acceptance as acceptance was not made in prescribed manner.
 Example 32:
Azam was expecting reply by email but did not prescribe any method of communication of
acceptance and Babar sends acceptance by letter being customary practice in their trade. The
acceptance is valid.
STICKY NOTES

If the proposal prescribes a manner in which it is to be accepted, and the acceptance is not made in such manner:
a) the proposer may, within a reasonable time after the acceptance is communicated to him, insist that his
proposal shall be accepted in the prescribed manner, and not otherwise;
b) but if he fails to do so, he is deemed to accept the acceptance.
 Example 33:
Azam makes an offer to Babar and asks him to accept the offer by post only. Babar texted him his
acceptance in SMS. Azam responded to that he will only consider his acceptance when he will
receive the letter of acceptance. Babar did not send any letter. There is no contract between them.
 Example 34:
Azam makes an offer to Babar and asks him to accept the offer by post only. Babar sent him his
acceptance by Fax under acknowledgement. Azam did not insist on a letter to be sent. Babar did
not send any letter. There is a contract between Azam and Babar.

26 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

Additional points
The following points are also relevant:
 The offeree must be aware of the proposal, otherwise the acceptance is not valid.
 An offer cannot be accepted after it has been rejected earlier.
 An offer cannot be accepted if it has been terminated earlier.
 Example 35:
Azam offered a reward for anyone who finds his lost dog. Babar, in ignorance of the offer, finds
and returns the dog. Babar cannot claim the reward.
 Example 36:
Azam offers to sell 10 bags of rice to Babar for Rs. 2,000. Before its acceptance, a law banned the

AT A GLANCE
sale of rice. The offer terminates and cannot be accepted.

2.2.5 Acceptance by performing conditions or receiving consideration [Section 8]


Performance of the conditions of a proposal, or the acceptance of any consideration for a reciprocal promise
which may be offered with a proposal, is an acceptance of the proposal.
 Example 37:
Kamran offered Jameel 50 Laptops for Rs. 78,000 each and said that if you agree, you will have
to deposit 10% by tomorrow in my bank account. Jameel deposited 10% amount in Kamran’s
bank account the next day but did not communicate otherwise. This is valid acceptance by Jameel.

2.2.6 Revocation of acceptance [Section 5]

SPOTLIGHT
An acceptance may be revoked at any time before the communication of its acceptance is complete as against the
acceptor, but not afterwards.
 Example 38:
Adeel offers, by letter, to sell a van to Kashif for Rs. 100,000. The letter reaches Kashif on 8th
March. Kashif accepts by a letter sent by post on 9th March. Next day, Kashif thought that the deal
is not good and called Adeel to revoke his offer. Adeel had already received the letter of
acceptance. Kashif cannot revoke his offer.
 Example 39:
Adeel offers, by letter, to sell a van to Kashif for Rs. 100,000. The letter reaches Kashif on 8th

STICKY NOTES
March. Kashif accepts by a letter sent by post on 9th March. Next day, Kashif thought that the deal
is not good and called Adeel to revoke his offer. Adeel had not received the letter of acceptance
yet. Kashif can revoke his offer.

2.3 Revocation

2.3.1 Meaning and time limit [Section 5]


Revocation means the act of taking back, withdrawing or cancelling. An offer or acceptance may be revoked
subject to following time limits:
a) A proposal may be revoked at any time before the communication of its acceptance is complete as
against the proposer, but not afterwards.
b) An acceptance may be revoked at any time before the communication of its acceptance is complete as
against the acceptor, but not afterwards.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 27


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 40:
Adeel offers by letter to sell his house to Kashif. Kashif accepts the offer by a letter posted on 4th
May. The letter reaches Adeel on 6th May.
 Adeel may revoke his offer before Kashif posts his letter of acceptance, i.e. 4th May but
not afterwards.
 Kashif may revoke his acceptance before the letter of acceptance reaches Adeel, i.e. 6th
May but not afterwards.

2.3.2 Communication [Section 3]


The communication of revocation of proposals and acceptances is deemed to be made by any act or omission of
the party revoking by which he intends to communicate such revocation or which has the effect of
AT A GLANCE

communicating it.

2.3.3 Communication when Complete [Section 4]


The communication of a revocation is complete:
a) as against the person making it, when it is put in a course of transmission to the person to whom it is
made, so as to be out of the power of the person who makes it.
b) as against the person to whom it is made, when it comes to his knowledge.
 Example 41:
Talal offered by a letter on October 1st, to sell goods to Bilal in Multan. Bilal received the offer
on 11th October and gave his acceptance. On 18th October Talal wrote a letter revoking his offer.
SPOTLIGHT

The letter was received by Bilal on 20th October. Held, the revocation was of no effect until it
reached Bilal. A contract was made on 11th October when Bilal accepted the offer.
 Practice Question 01:
Murad offered his car to Sanum for Rs. 400,000. Sanum accepted the offer and enclosed a pay
order of Rs. 150,000 with a promise to pay the balance in monthly instalments of Rs. 62,500 each.
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 explain whether it is a valid contract.
 Solution:
An acceptance should be unconditional assent by the offeree to all the terms of the offer. In this
case, since the offer has been accepted with a variation it would be regarded as a qualified
STICKY NOTES

acceptance. Therefore, a contract between Murad and Sanum has not been formed.
However, if Murad accepts the counter offer made by Sanum then it would be a binding contract.
 Practice Question 02:
Batool offered to sell her flat to Saqib for Rs. 4,200,000. Saqib accepted the offer and sent a cheque
of Rs. 1,500,000 with a stipulation to pay the balance in 24 equal monthly instalments of Rs.
112,500 each. Explain whether it is a valid contract.
 Solution:
An acceptance should be unconditional assent by the offeree to all the terms of the offer. In this
case, since the offer has been accepted with a variation it would be regarded as a qualified
acceptance. Therefore, a contract between Batool and Saqib has not been formed.
However, if Batool accepts the counter offer made by Saqib then it would be a binding contract.

28 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

 Practice Question 03:


Bader, who is the owner of Mashoor Associates, sent one of his employees Aftab in search of his
pet horse which had been missing for 5 days. Bader advertised a reward of Rs. 20,000 in a
newspaper for anyone who finds his missing horse. Aftab, unaware of the newspaper
advertisement, traced the horse. Subsequently, on knowing about the reward Aftab claimed it
from Bader.
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 identify the type of offer which was made by
Bader. Also state whether Aftab would be able to claim the amount of reward under the
circumstances.
 Solution:
It is the case of a general offer as it was made to the public. A contract is made with the person

AT A GLANCE
who having the knowledge of the offer comes forward and acts according to the conditions of the
offer.
However, under the given circumstances, Aftab cannot claim the amount of reward from Bader
as there was lack of communication of the offer and Aftab did not know about the reward when
he found the missing horse. Aftab could have accepted the offer only when he knew about it
because an offer accepted without its knowledge does not confer any legal rights.
 Practice Question 04:
On 3 September 2018 Saleem offered, by a letter, to sell his laptop to Ghazi for Rs. 50,000. Ghazi
received the letter on 5 September 2018. On 6 September 2018 Ghazi posted the letter of
acceptance to Saleem. The letter reached Saleem on 8 September 2018. Saleem wrote a letter of
revocation of his offer and posted it to Ghazi on 5 September 2018. The letter reached Ghazi on

SPOTLIGHT
7 September 2018.
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 briefly describe when the communication of the
offer and acceptance and the revocation of the offer was completed as against Saleem and Ghazi
under the above circumstances and whether a binding contract was created between Saleem and
Ghazi.
 Solution:
Communication of offer was completed on 5 September 2018 i.e. when it came to the knowledge
of Ghazi. Communication of acceptance was completed as against Saleem when the letter was
posted i.e. on 6 September 2018 and as against Ghazi it was completed when the letter of
acceptance reached Saleem i.e. on 8 September 2018. The communication of revocation of offer

STICKY NOTES
was completed as against Saleem on 5 September 2018 i.e. when the letter of revocation was
posted, and as against Ghazi on 7 September 2018, when the letter of revocation was received by
him.
Since Ghazi had posted his letter of acceptance on 6 September 2018 and revocation of offer was
communicated to him on 7 September 2018, his acceptance was valid Saleem cannot revoke his
offer after 6 September 2018, when the communication of acceptance was completed as against
him. Therefore, a binding contract had been created between Saleem and Ghazi.
 Practice Question 05:
Ahmed being interested in purchasing Adil’s DHA property sent him this letter on 01 March 2019,
“I have heard that you are selling your DHA property. I am very much interested in purchasing it.
Will you please consider selling the same to me? What is the highest price you have been offered
so far?” Adil replied, “The highest quote for the property till now is Rs. 35 million.” Ahmed replied,
“I agree to buy your DHA property for Rs. 36 million.” Subsequently, Adil received an offer from
Hamid quoting Rs. 38 million for the said property. What will be Adil’s liability towards Ahmed
if he wishes to make the sale to Hamid?

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 29


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
The first letter from Ahmed and Adil’s response on it were merely ‘asking for information’ and
‘providing information’ respectively and not offer and acceptance. The second letter from Ahmed
sent as a reply to Adil was itself an offer and not the acceptance of an offer. Since this offer had
not been accepted by Adil, there is no binding contract between the parties. Accordingly, there is
no liability if Adil sells his bungalow to Hamid.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

30 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Lawful offer is
(a) Promise
(b) Legal relation
(c) Proposal
(d) Presentation

02. Which of the following result/results in an offer?


(a) A declaration of intention

AT A GLANCE
(b) An invitation to offer
(c) An advertisement offering reward to anyone who finds the lost dog of the advertiser
(d) An offer made in a joke

03. A letter of acceptance, for a lawful and legal matter, sufficiently stamped and duly addressed is put into
course of transmission. There is
(a) A valid contract as against the acceptor
(b) A contract voidable at the option of offeror
(c) No contract at all

SPOTLIGHT
(d) A valid contract as against the proposer

04. An offer is not different from


(a) Advertisement
(b) Price list
(c) Proposal for doing or not doing something
(d) Display of the goods

STICKY NOTES
05. A makes an offer to B on 10th by a letter which reaches B on 12th. B posts letter of acceptance on 14th
which reaches A on 16th. The communication of acceptance is complete as against A on
(a) 12th
(b) 14th
(c) 16th
(d) 10th

06. Offer is simply a


(a) Mere expression of willingness to do or not to do some thing
(b) Intention to create legal relationship
(c) Intention to get assent of other party for offered act or abstinence
(d) All of the above

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 31


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

07. An offer cannot be made


(a) By the words of mouth
(b) By the conduct of party
(c) By the circumstances
(d) To the offeror himself

08. An offer is said to be revoked


(a) By non-fulfilment of condition precedent to acceptance
(b) Acceptance is not in prescribed mode, but offeror does not object to it.
AT A GLANCE

(c) Acceptance is not given within reasonable period of time, but offeror does not object
(d) Misunderstanding has arisen between offeror and offeree

09. Acceptance must be given in:


(a) Usual manner
(b) Prescribed manner
(c) Any manner suitable to the offeree
(d) More effective manner
SPOTLIGHT

10. Which of the following statements is true


(a) A proposal may be revoked at any time before the communication of its acceptance is complete as
against the offeree.
(b) Acceptance may be revoked at any time, before the communication of acceptance is complete as
against the acceptor
(c) An offer initially rejected may subsequently be accepted
(d) Letter of offer may be sent after letter of acceptance

11. A person cannot make an offer


STICKY NOTES

(a) To a person of sound mind


(b) To his friend
(c) To himself
(d) To the citizen of a foreign country

12. An offer gets legal consequences


(a) As soon as it is made
(b) As soon as it is communicated
(c) As soon as it is revoked
(d) As soon as it is accepted

32 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

13. Implied acceptance is inferred


(a) From the silence of offeree
(b) From the conduct of the offeree
(c) From the written statement of the offeree
(d) From the oral statement of the offeree

14. Abdullah offered by letter to sell Karim his motorbike for Rs. 5,000. Karim wrote back saying he accepted
the offer and would pay in two instalments at the end of the two following months. Is there a contract?
(a) No, because Karim is trying to amend the contractual terms. Abdullah can be assumed to revoke
the offer

AT A GLANCE
(b) Yes, there has been as offer and acceptance and a binding contract applies
(c) No, Karim’s response constitutes a counteroffer and is effectively a rejection of Abdullah’s offer
(d) Yes, Karim’s response is merely a clarification of contractual terms.

15. The Law of Contract is


(a) Law of agreements
(b) Law of agreements which creates legal obligation
(c) Law of all agreements
(d)

SPOTLIGHT
Law of personal and social agreement

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 33


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (c) An offer is a proposal by one person to another for entering into a legally binding agreement
with him

02. (c) An advertisement offering reward to anyone who finds the lost dog of the advertiser is an offer.

03. (d) A valid contract as against the proposer, as the communication is complete as against the
proposer.

04. (c) An offer is a proposal for doing or not doing something.

05. (b) 14th because the communication of acceptance as against offeror is complete when the offeree
AT A GLANCE

posts letter of acceptance.

06. (c) Intention to get assent of other party for offered act or abstinence.

07. (d) For a valid offer there is needs to be two persons. A person cannot make an offer to himself

08. (a) By non-fulfilment of condition precedent to acceptance because it is necessary on the part of
offeree to fulfil the condition precedent to acceptance

09. (b) Prescribed manner because an offer come to an end if it is not accepted according to the
prescribed manner (if any)
SPOTLIGHT

10. (b) Acceptance may be revoked at any time, before the communication of acceptance is complete
as against the acceptor

11. (c) To himself because for a valid offer there needs to be two persons at least.

12. (d) Offer has no legal consequence or value unless it is accepted

13. (b) The implied acceptance may be complete when it is communicated to the offeror through
conduct of the offeree.

14. (c) No, Karim’s response constitutes a counteroffer and is effectively a rejection of Abdullah’s offer.
STICKY NOTES

This is also known as bargaining

15. (b) The contract law deals with agreements having legal consequences.

34 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION

STICKY NOTES

Proposal + Acceptance = Promise


Promise + Consideration = Agreement
Agreement + Enforceability = Contract
A proposal or acceptance may be express (words spoken or written) or implied
(inferred from conduct of parties or circumstances)

AT A GLANCE
Definitions to remember
1. When one person signifies to another his willingness to do or to abstain from
doing anything, with a view to obtaining the assent of that other to such act or
abs tinence, he is said to make a “proposal”.
2. When the person to whom the proposal is made signifies his assent thereto, the
proposal is said to be accepted. A proposal, when accepted becomes a
“promise”.
3. The person making the proposal is called the “promisor,” and the person
accepting the proposal is called the “promisee”
4. Every promise and every set of promises, forming the consideration for each

SPOTLIGHT
other, is an “agreement”.
5. An agreement enforceable by law is a “contract”.

Revocation of proposal
A proposal may be revoked in following ways:
a) by the communication of notice of revocation by the proposer to the other
party;

STICKY NOTES
b) by the lapse of the time prescribed in such proposal for its acceptance, or, if
no time is so prescribed, by the lapse of a reasonable time, without
communication of the acceptance;
c) by the failure of the acceptor to fulfil a condition precedent to acceptance; or
d) by the death or insanity of the proposer, if the fact of his death or insanity
comes to the knowledge of the acceptor before acceptance.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 35


CHAPTER 2: OFFER, ACCEPTANCE AND REVOCATION CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Conditions of valid acceptance


A valid acceptance:
a) must be absolute and unqualified (unconditional); and
b) must be expressed in the manner prescribed in the proposal; or
c) must be expressed in some usual and reasonable manner if the proposal did not
prescribe any manner.

Communication
AT A GLANCE

The communication of a proposal (offer) is complete when it comes to the knowledge


of the person to whom it is made.
The communication of an acceptance is complete:
a) as against the proposer, when it is put in a course of transmission to him, so as
to be out of the power of the acceptor.
b) as against the acceptor, when it comes to the knowledge of the proposer.
The communication of a revocation is complete:
a) as against the person making it, when it is put in a course of transmission to
the person to whom it is made, so as to be out of the power of the person who
makes it.
SPOTLIGHT

b) as against the person to whom it is made, when it comes to his knowledge.


STICKY NOTES

36 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 3

VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS
AND AGREEMENTS

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
Void agreement is an agreement not enforceable by law at all,
AT A GLANCE while a void contract is a contract which was enforceable at the
time of formation but ceases to be enforceable for some reason
SPOTLIGHT subsequently.
Voidable contract is a contract voidable at the option of
1. Validity of Contracts and aggrieved party and not at the option of defaulting party.
Agreements
All agreements are contracts if they are made by the free
2. Consideration and Object consent of parties competent to contract, for a lawful
consideration and with a lawful object, and are not hereby
expressly declared to be void.
3. Objective Based Q&A

SPOTLIGHT
Every person is competent to contract who is of the age of
STICKY NOTES majority according to the law to which he is subject, and who is
of sound mind, and is not disqualified from contracting by any
law to which he is subject.
Consideration means something in return. It is the price for
which the promise of the other is bought. It must result in a
benefit to the promisor and/or detriment to the promisee or
both. An agreement without consideration is void with few
exceptions.
The consideration or object of an agreement is unlawful, if:
 it is forbidden by law; or

STICKY NOTES
 is of such a nature that, if permitted, it would defeat the
provisions of any law; or
 is fraudulent; or
 involves or implies injury to the person or property of
another;
 or the Court regards it as immoral, or opposed to public
policy.
Every agreement of which the object or consideration is
unlawful is void.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 37


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS


1.1 Definitions

1.1.1 Valid contract [Section 2(h)]


An agreement enforceable by law is a contract.
 Example 01:
Amjad agrees with Habib to sell his Suzuki Mehran 2008 model to Habib for Rs. 450,000. If Amjad
refuses to deliver car, Habib may sue Amjad. If Habib refuses to pay for car, Amjad may sue Habib.
It is a valid contract.
AT A GLANCE

1.1.2 Voidable contract [Section 2(i)]


An agreement which is enforceable by law at the option of one or more of the parties thereto, but not at the option
of the other or others, is a voidable contract.
The contract is voidable at the option of aggrieved party and not at the option of defaulting party.
 Example 02:
Azam threatens to kill Babar if he does not sell his BMW for Rs 1 million to Azam. Babar
contracted to sell his BMW to Azam and receives the payments. Here, Babar’s consent has been
obtained by coercion. Hence, this contract is voidable at the option of Babar but Azam has no
right to insist that contract shall be performed.

1.1.3 Void contract [Section 2(j)]


SPOTLIGHT

A contract which ceases to be enforceable by law becomes void when it ceases to be enforceable.
Notice that void contract was valid contract at the time of formation but subsequently it ceases to be enforceable.
 Example 03:
A music hall was rented out for a series of concerts. The hall caught fire before the date of first
concert. The contract was valid at the time of its formation but became void when hall caught fire
and it became impossible to perform it.

1.1.4 Void agreement [Section 2(g)]


An agreement not enforceable by law is said to be void.
STICKY NOTES

Notice that a void agreement is void ab initio i.e. void from the beginning.
 Example 04:
Maria (a minor) borrowed Rs. 100,000 from Laila and executed mortgage of her property in
favour of the lender. This is a void agreement because Maria is not competent to contract and
Laila cannot legally enforce this agreement against Maria.

1.2 What agreements are contracts?


1.2.1 Essentials of a valid contract [Section 10]
An agreement is a contact if it meets the following conditions:
a) The agreement is made by the free consent of the parties.
b) The parties making the agreement are competent to contract.
c) The agreement is made for a lawful consideration.
d) The agreement is made with a lawful object.
e) The agreement is not expressly declared to be void by law.

38 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

 Example 05:
Adeel beats Babar and compels him to sell his bike for Rs. 20,000. Here, Babar’s consent is not
free as it has been obtained by coercion. It is a voidable contract and not a valid contract unless
Babar decides to insist on its performance.
 Example 06:
Maria (a minor) borrowed Rs. 100,000 from Laila and executed mortgage of her property in
favour of the lender. This is not a valid contract because Maria is not competent to contract.
 Example 07:
Adeel offers to buy computer from Babar for Rs. 50,000 to which Babar responds positively. Here
Adeel’s promise to pay Rs. 50,000 is the consideration for Babar’s promise and Babar’s promise
to sell the computer is the consideration for Adeel’s promise.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 08:
Abid, Bakar and Farhan enter into an agreement of the division among them of gains acquired,
or be acquired, by them by fraud. The agreement is void, as its object is unlawful.
 Example 09:
Arslan promises to pay Rs 10,000 to Habib if it rained today, and Habib promises to pay Rs 1,000
to Arslan if it did not. The agreement is void because the happening and non-happening is
dependent on future uncertain event (wager) and wagering agreements are expressly declared
to be void under the provision of Contract Act, 1872.
An oral contract is also a valid contract except in certain cases when any special law requires
certain contract to be made in writing or in the presence of witness or for registration of

SPOTLIGHT
documents relating to that contract.
 Example 10:
An oral agreement for arbitration about present disputes is unenforceable because the law
requires that such arbitration agreement must be in writing.
 Example 11:
Adeel verbally promises to sell his book to Babar for Rs. 1,000/-. It is a valid contract because the
law does not require it to be in writing.

1.2.2 Competent to contract [Section 11]

STICKY NOTES
Every person is competent to contract:
a) who is of the age of majority according to the law to which he is subject; and
b) who is of sound mind; and
c) who is not disqualified from contracting by any law to which he is subject.

1.2.3 Age of Majority


According to the Majority Act, 1875, the age of majority of a person domiciled in Pakistan is 18 years, except in
cases where a guardian of a minor is appointed by the court, in which case the age of majority extends to 21
years.
An agreement with a minor is void ab initio.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 39


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 12:
Dawood, a minor mortgaged his house in favour of Mohsin to secure a loan of Rs. 20,000. Dawood
received the amount. Mohsin filed a suit for recovery of money and sale of mortgaged property
in case of default. Held that the agreement with minor was void so Mohsin cannot recover the
money or sell the minor’s mortgaged property.

Additional points
The following additional points are relevant:
a) The rule of estoppel does not apply to minor. It means if minor represents fraudulently or otherwise that
he is of the age of majority and induces another to enter into a contract with him, even then, he will not
be liable.
AT A GLANCE

b) It is necessary that the minor must be competent to contract at the time of entering in the contract.
Therefore, an agreement with a minor cannot be ratified subsequently after he attains majority.
Ratification is approving or accepting something which has happened already.
c) A minor cannot be declared insolvent because he is incompetent to contract.
d) If a minor enters into an agreement jointly with a major person then such agreement can be enforced
against the major person who has jointly promised to perform.
 Example 13:
Momin, a minor fraudulently shows that he is of full age and contracts with Noor to sell his house.
Momin refuses to perform the contract on the ground that he is a minor. Noor cannot sue Momin.
 Example 14:
SPOTLIGHT

Maria, a minor borrowed some money and wrote a pro-note for it. On attaining majority, Maria
wrote a second pro-note to settle the first note. It was held that the second pro-note is also void.
 Example 15:
Maryam, a minor buys medicines from Zain. Maryam has no property. Maryam cannot be held
liable for payment. She cannot be declared insolvent.
 Example 16:
Hussain (aged 16) and Burhan (aged 26) jointly agree to pay certain amount and executed a bond.
The court held that only Burhan is liable.
STICKY NOTES

1.2.4 Sound mind for the purpose of contracting [Section 12]


A person is said to be of sound mind for the purpose of making a contract if, at the time when he makes it, he is
capable of understanding it and of forming a rational judgment as to its effect upon his interests.
 Example 17:
The examples of persons having an unsound mind include:
 specific persons/idiots (permanent insanity with no interval of saneness)
 lunatics (mental strain or disease with possibly some intervals of sanity)
 drunken persons (the excessive use of certain substances may cause temporary
impotence of mind).
A person who is usually of unsound mind, but occasionally of sound mind, may make a contract when he is of
sound mind.
A person who is usually of sound mind, but occasionally of unsound mind, may not make a Contract when he is
of unsound mind.

40 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

 Example 18:
Salim agreed to sell property worth Rs.25 million for Rs.12 million. His mother proved that he
was an idiot by birth. The agreement was held to be void.
 Example 19:
A patient in a lunatic asylum who is at intervals of sound mind may contract during those
intervals.
 Example 20:
A sane man who is so delirious from fever or who is so drunk that he cannot understand the
terms of a contract or form a rational judgment as to its effect on his interest cannot enter into
contract while such delirium or drunkenness lasts.

AT A GLANCE
1.2.5 Disqualified from contracting by law
There are some disqualifications imposed on certain persons under certain legislation in respect of their capacity
to contract which include:
a) A citizen of foreign country while Pakistan is at war with that country.
b) Foreign sovereigns and ambassadors have immunity unless they choose to submit themselves to the
jurisdictions of our courts. They have a right to enter into a contract but can claim the privilege of not
being sued.
c) A convict while under imprisonment is incapable of contracting but this disability comes to an end after
the expiry of the sentence or when he is on parole.
d) A person declared as insolvent cannot enter into a contract as his property is dealt with by official

SPOTLIGHT
assignee or official receiver.
 Example 21:
Imran agrees to buy goods from Narendra, a citizen of a country at war with Pakistan. The
agreement is void.
 Example 22:
Emily, a diplomat got a house on rent from Momin on behalf of the country to which she belongs.
Momin sued for recovery of arrears of rent. It was held that no action can be brought against
Emily.
 Example 23:

STICKY NOTES
Wajid, during imprisonment enters into an agreement with Sajid to sell his land. The agreement
is void.
 Example 24:
Sajid, an insolvent, promises to sell his car to Babar. The agreement is void. The property will be
dealt by official assignee.
 Practice Question 01:
Shoaib, aged 15, is the son of a billionaire businessman, Ijaz Munsif. Last month Shoaib drove his
father’s 2018 Model BMW to a vintage car exhibition arranged by Volkswagon Club of Pakistan.
At the exhibition he saw a vintage Mercedes-Benz and entered into a contract with the seller for
the purchase of the car. The seller, knowing Ijaz Munsif’s status, delivered the car to Shoaib at his
house. The seller requested for payment for the car but Shoaib refused to pay. The seller is now
requesting for full payment by Ijaz Munsif. Discuss whether the seller would succeed in
recovering the payment from Shoaib or Ijaz Munsif.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 41


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
Shoaib, being a minor, lacks the capacity to enter into a legally binding contract with the seller.
Therefore, Shoaib is not bound by the contract and the contract is void ab-initio. A minor can only
be bound by a contract, if he has been supplied with necessaries suited to his condition in life.
His liability in such a case would be limited to the extent of his property, if any. In this case, the
vintage car cannot be regarded as a necessary good. Therefore, the seller cannot enforce payment
for the vintage car against Shoaib.
The seller can only claim for the return of his car through an order of restitution. Similarly, Ijaz
Munsif cannot be held liable for the price of the car which his son Shoaib bought. He would have
been held liable if his son had either entered into a contract jointly with him or the contract was
for the supply of necessaries to Shoaib.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

42 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

2. CONSIDERATION AND OBJECT


2.1 Definition [Section 2(d)]
When, at the desire of the promisor, the promisee or any other person has done or abstained from doing, or does
or abstains from doing, or promises to do or to abstain from doing, something, such act or abstinence or promise
is called a “consideration” for the promise.gg
The analysis of above definition can be described in following points:
a) The consideration may be:
 an act (i.e. doing something);
 an abstinence or forbearance; or

AT A GLANCE
 a promise (for act or abstinence in future).
b) The consideration must be at the desire of promisor.
c) The consideration may be from promisee or any other person.
d) The consideration may be past, present, or future.
 Example 25:
Azam promises Babar to guarantee payment of price of the goods which Babar sells on credit to
Misbah. Here selling of goods by Babar to Misbah on credit is consideration for Azam’s promise.
 Example 26:
Adeel asks Habib not to sue Arslan for a year for his debts and promises in case of default of

SPOTLIGHT
Arslan, Adeel would be liable. Here Habib not filing a suit for a year is abstinence, which is a
sufficient consideration for Adeel.
 Example 27:
Ameer promises to deliver iPhone to Burhan and Burhan promises to pay Rs. 85,000 on delivery.
Here the consideration for Ameer will be Rs. 85,000 on delivery and consideration for Burhan
will be delivery of goods.
 Example 28:
Adeel saves Arslan’s goods from fire without being asked to do so. Adeel cannot demand payment
for his services as consideration was not moved at the desire of the promisor.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 29:
Arif transferred certain property to his daughter Humera with a direction that Humera should
pay Noman annuity. On the same day Humera executed a deed in writing in favour of Noman and
agreed thereby to pay the annuity. Later, Humera refused to pay the annuity on the plea that no
consideration had moved from Noman. Here Noman is entitled to maintain suit because a
consideration not necessarily move from the promisee, it may move from any other person (by
Arif in this case).
 Example 30:
Akram renders some service to Wasim in the month of August. In September Wasim promises to
compensate Akram an amount of Rs. 10,000 for the services he rendered to him. Past services
amount to past consideration. Akram can recover Rs. 10,000 from Wasim.
 Example 31:
Waqar sells his car for Rs. 1 million and delivers the car at the time of payment. Here the
consideration is moving simultaneously with the promise and is called present consideration.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 43


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 32:
Akhtar promises to deliver certain goods to Shoaib after 5 days and Shoaib promises to pay after
5 days from the date of delivery. Consideration in this case is future consideration.

Additional points
The following additional points are relevant:
a) The consideration must be something which the promisor is not already bound to do because a promise
to do what a promisor is already bound to do adds nothing to the existing obligation.
b) The consideration must be real and not illusory.
 Example 33:
AT A GLANCE

Hamid was summoned to give evidence in a court where Sajid was in litigation. Sajid promised
to pay certain amount to Hamid for giving the evidence. Later, Sajid refused to pay. Hamid sued
and failed. Held, the consideration was not valid as it was Hamid’s duty to give evidence.
 Example 34:
Azam promises to put life into Babar’s dead wife and Babar promises to pay Rs. 1 million. This
agreement is void because consideration is impossible to perform and not real.
 Example 35:
Azam engages Babar to work as an accountant in his office and promises to pay him Rs. 75,000
per month. This is a real consideration for both the parties.

2.2 Agreements without consideration [Section 25]


SPOTLIGHT

2.2.1 Basic Rule


An agreement without consideration is void with certain exceptions.
 Example 36:
Adnan promises, for no consideration, to give to Behzad Rs. 5 million. This is a void agreement.

2.2.2 Exception: Natural love and affection


An agreement without consideration shall not be void if:
a) it is expressed in writing and registered under the relevant law; and
STICKY NOTES

b) it is made on account of natural love and affection between parties standing in a near relation to each
other.
 Example 37:
Azam, for natural love and affection; promises to give his son, Babar, Rs. 10,000. Azam puts his
promise to Babar into writing and registers it. This is a valid contract.

2.2.3 Exception: Promise to compensate past voluntary services


An agreement without consideration shall not be void if it is a promise to compensate, wholly or in part, a person
who has already voluntarily done something for the promisor, or something which the promisor was legally
compellable to do.
 Example 38:
Ameer finds Bushra's purse and gives it to her. Bushra promises to give Ameer Rs.5,000. Now
this promise of Bushra is a contract.

44 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

 Example 39:
Azam supports Babar’s infant son. Babar promises to pay Azam’s expenses in so doing. This is a
contract.

2.2.4 Exception: Time barred debt


An agreement without consideration shall not be void if:
a) it is a promise, made in writing and signed by the debtor or his agent; and
b) it relates to a payment (wholly or in part) of time barred debt.
A time barred debt is debt which a creditor cannot enforce payment of due to law of limitation.
 Example 40:

AT A GLANCE
Arif transferred some property to Haseeb by a duly written and registered deed as a gift. This is
a valid contract even though no consideration was given by Haseeb.

2.2.5 Exception: Completed gifts


Gift is the transfer of certain existing movable or immovable property made voluntarily and without
consideration by one person (i.e. donor) to another person (i.e. donee) and accepted by or on behalf of the donee.
Any completed gift actually made between donor and donee is valid, although without consideration. A gift is
executed in writing through a deed duly registered.
 Example 41:
Arif transferred some property to Haseeb by a duly written and registered deed as a gift. This is
a valid contract even though no consideration was given by Haseeb.

SPOTLIGHT
2.3 Adequacy of Consideration [Section 25]
An agreement to which the consent of the promisor is freely given is not void merely because the consideration
is inadequate; but the inadequacy of the consideration may be taken into account by the Court in determining
the question whether the consent of the promisor was freely given.
 Example 42:
Azam agrees to sell a horse worth Rs. 100,000 for Rs. 1,000. Later, Azam denies that his consent
to the agreement was freely given. The inadequacy of consideration is a fact which the Court
should take into account in considering whether or not Azam’s consent was freely given.
 Example 43:

STICKY NOTES
Adeel, with his free consent, agrees to sell his car worth Rs. 3 million for Rs. 1 million to Saima.
The contract is valid.

2.4 Circumstances where object or consideration is unlawful [Section 23]


Every agreement of which the object or consideration is unlawful is void.
The consideration or object of an agreement is lawful, unless
a) it is forbidden by law; or
b) is of such a nature that, if permitted, it would defeat the provisions of any law; or
c) is fraudulent; or
d) involves or implies injury to the person or property of another; or
e) the Court regards it as immoral, or opposed to public policy.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 45


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 44:
Abid, Sajid and Amjad agreed to divide the cash obtained by tax refund on the basis of fake
documents. Held, the object was unlawful and agreement is void.
 Example 45:
Qadir fails to pay his loan and his house is auctioned for recovery. According to law, the defaulter
(Qadir) is prohibited to bid so he appoints an agent to bid for him and later transfer the house.
The agreement is void as the transaction, in fact, is a purchase by the defaulter, and would so
defeat the object of the law.
 Example 46:
Abid, Sajid and Amjad enter into an agreement of the division among them of gains acquired by
them by fraud. The agreement is void, as its object is unlawful.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 47:
Abid promised to pay Rs.100,000 to Sajid on agreeing to publish a defamatory article against
Arslan. It was held that Sajid could not recover the amount because the agreement was void as it
involves injury to a person.
 Example 48:
Abid, who is guardian of Tanveer, promises to exercise his influence, as such, with Tanveer in
favour of Farhan, and Farhan promises to pay Rs 1,000 to Abid. The agreement is void because it
is immoral.
 Example 49:
SPOTLIGHT

A married woman was given money to obtain divorce from her husband and then marry the
lender. Later, the woman refused to take divorce. The agreement is void, though the taking such
divorce may not be punishable under the law.
 Example 50:
Anjum, who knows that Kanwar has stolen goods amounting to Rs.500,000, receives Rs.100,000
from Kanwar in consideration of not exposing him. This agreement is illegal being opposed to
public policy.

2.5 Where object or consideration is partly unlawful [Section 24]


The agreement is void:
STICKY NOTES

a) if any part of a single consideration for one or more objects, is unlawful; or


b) if any one or any part of any one of several considerations for a single object, is unlawful.
 Example 51:
Azam promises to superintend, on behalf of Babar, a legal manufacture of indigo, and an illegal
traffic in other articles. Babar promises to pay to Azam a salary of Rs. 30,000 a month. The whole
agreement is unlawful and void because it cannot be ascertained as to what was due on account
of legal manufacture and what was due on account of illegal trafficking.
 Practice Question 02:
Mohsin promised Ahsan that he will pay his university fee. Later Mohsin suffered losses in his
business and refused to pay the fee. Mohsin is of the view that since the agreement was without
consideration, it does not constitute a valid contract. However, Ahsan believes that the
agreement is enforceable under law as it meets certain other conditions. You are required to
narrate the conditions which Ahsan may be referring to.

46 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

 Solution:
The conditions under which the said contract is enforceable are:
 Mohsin and Ahsan stand in near relation to one another.
 The agreement is out of natural love and affection.
 The said contract is in writing.
 Practice Question 03:
Mrs. Ikram was searching for a house for her family in city’s posh locality. Her grandfather
Nadeem had promised to pay her Rs. 1.0 million by way of a gift for the purchase of the house.
After finalizing the deal with one of the estate brokers, Mrs. Ikram asked Nadeem to pay her Rs.
1.0 million as promised. Nadeem, however, refused to pay the amount. Mrs. Ikram filed a suit
against her grandfather Nadeem for the enforcement of the promise made by him. Advise under

AT A GLANCE
what circumstances Mrs. Ikram would be able to recover the amount from Nadeem.
 Solution:
An agreement made without consideration is void. However, Mrs. Ikram may claim the amount
of Rs. 1.0 million from her grandfather Nadeem, by proving either gift or love and affection.
In case of a gift it needs to be completed. The rule ‘No consideration no contract’ does not apply
to completed gifts.
An agreement made on account of natural love and affection without consideration will be valid
if it is expressed in writing, registered under the law, made on account of natural love and
affection, and between parties standing in a near relation to each other.
However, in the given scenario, Nadeem only made a promise to pay Rs. 1.0 million by way of a

SPOTLIGHT
gift and did not actually pay the amount. Similarly, the promise was not made in writing and was
not registered, therefore, the promise cannot be enforced in both of the above circumstances and
Mrs. Ikram cannot recover anything from her grandfather Nadeem.
 Practice Question 04:
Muneer wanted to complete his bachelor’s degree from Europe. His paternal uncle Furqan Butt
had promised him to pay Rs. 2 million by way of a gift, at the time of his admission to a college in
Europe. After getting admission to one of the renowned colleges in Europe, Muneer asked Furqan
Butt to pay him Rs. 2 million as promised. However, Furqan Butt refused to pay the amount and
Muneer filed a suit against Furqan Butt for the enforcement of his promise. Discuss the
circumstances in which Muneer may be able to recover the amount from Furqan Butt.

STICKY NOTES
 Solution:
An agreement made without consideration is void. However, Muneer may claim the amount of
Rs. 2 million from his uncle Furqan Butt, by proving either of the following two conditions.
i. gift
ii. love and affection
Completed gift:
In case of a gift it needs to be completed. The rule ‘No consideration no contract’ does not apply
to completed gifts.
Love and affection:
An agreement made on account of natural love and affection without consideration will be valid
if it is:
 expressed in writing,
 registered under the law,

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 47


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 made on account of natural love and affection, and


 between parties standing in a near relation to each other.
However, in the given scenario, Furqan Butt only made a promise to pay Rs. 2 million by way of
a gift and did not actually pay the amount. Similarly, the promise was not made in writing and
was not registered, therefore, the promise cannot be enforced in both of the above circumstances
and Muneer cannot recover anything from his uncle Furqan Butt.
 Practice Question 05:
Asif stole cash and merchandise from the ABC Store. Basit, the owner of store, initiated legal
proceedings against him. Asif contacted Basit with an offer to return the stolen cash and
merchandise if Basit withdraws the suit. Basit accepted the offer. Is it a valid agreement? Discuss.
 Solution:
AT A GLANCE

No, the agreement is void as its object is unlawful and constitutes stifling the criminal
prosecution.
 Practice Question 06:
Naeem was a treasury manager in Raheel Associates (RA). Naeem robbed Rs. 100,000 cash from
the business. Raheel, the owner of the business, instituted legal proceedings against Naeem.
Naeem agreed to return the cash and Raheel agreed to withdraw the proceedings against him.
Naeem fulfilled his part of the promise.
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 explain whether Raheel is bound to withdraw the
proceedings against Naeem.
 Solution:
SPOTLIGHT

The agreement between Naeem and Raheel is void as its object is unlawful and constitute stifling
the criminal prosecution. Raheel, therefore, is not bound to fulfil his part of the promise.
STICKY NOTES

48 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Voidable contract is voidable at the option of
(a) Both parties of contract
(b) One party of the contract
(c) None of the parties of the contract
(d) Aggrieved party of a contract

02. Which of the following statement is true


(a) Void agreement and void contract are one and same
(b) Void agreement creates legal rights and obligation between parties

AT A GLANCE
(c) Void contracts remain valid until they cease to be enforceable
(d) Any transaction based on void contract will also be void

03. Void agreement can be enforced


(a) By one of the parties
(b) By aggrieved party
(c) By none of the parties
(d) By the party entitled to do so

04. An agreement to be enforced in the court must have

SPOTLIGHT
(a) Legal enforceability
(b) Mutual and free consent between the parties
(c) Lawful consideration
(d) All of the above

05. An agreement is a voidable contract when it is


(a) Enforceable if certain conditions are fulfilled
(b) Enforceable by law at the option of the aggrieved party
(c) Enforceable by both the parties

STICKY NOTES
(d) Not enforceable at all

06. A Contract
(a) May be void as originally entered into
(b) May become void subsequent to its formation
(c) Cannot become void subsequent to its formation under any circumstances
(d) May become void at the will of a party to the contract

07. An agreement by an idiot is:


(a) Voidable
(b) Enforceable
(c) Invalid
(d) Void ab-initio

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 49


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

08. An agreement made with a minor is:


(a) Void
(b) Void ab-initio
(c) Voidable
(d) Unenforceable

09. A person is said to be of sound mind if


(a) He is mentally fit for making decisions
(b) He is capable of understanding contract and forming rational judgement about it
(c) He has been declared as of a sound mind by the Doctor
AT A GLANCE

(d) He can make contract and can obtain benefit

10. Contractual capacity of the person is affected by


(a) His age
(b) His soundness of mind
(c) By law to which he is subject
(d) By all above factors

11. A person is usually of unsound mind, but occasionally of sound mind


(a) He may enter into a contract when he is of sound mind
SPOTLIGHT

(b) He may not make a contract even when he is of sound mind


(c) He cannot enter into a contract at all
(d) None of the above

12. Any lawful act will constitute consideration if it is done


(a) At the desire of promisee
(b) Voluntarily
(c) At the desire of promisor
(d) At the desire of third party
STICKY NOTES

13. Consideration in order to be legally valid


(a) Must be adequate
(b) Need not be adequate
(c) Must be equal in terms of value
(d) Must be in-equal to promise

14. Agreements made on account of natural love and affection without consideration will be valid if it fulfils
following conditions
(a) Expressed in writing
(b) Registered under the law
(c) Between parties standing in a near relation to each other
(d) All of the above

50 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

15. Consideration which is moved simultaneously with the promise is known as


(a) Present consideration
(b) Past consideration
(c) Future consideration
(d) Instant consideration

16. Which of the following statement is true


(a) Consideration must always be given by the promisee
(b) Consideration must be given by third party on behalf of promisee
(c) Consideration must be given by the agent of promisee

AT A GLANCE
(d) Consideration may be given by promisee or any other person on his behalf

17. Agreement made without consideration is


(a) Void
(b) Unlawful
(c) Unenforceable
(d) Voidable

18. Akram makes an agreement for buying raw material from Bilal on 1st January. The raw material is to be
supplied by Bilal on 20th January and Payment is to be made by Akram on 15th March. What is the legal
status of this contract?

SPOTLIGHT
(a) This contract is not valid as consideration has not been supplied
(b) This contract is valid and the consideration is present consideration
(c) This contract is not valid because past consideration is not recognized by law
(d) This contract is valid and the consideration is future consideration

19. A promise to compensate, wholly or in part, a person who has voluntarily done something for the
promisor is
(a) Enforceable
(b) Not enforceable

STICKY NOTES
(c) Void
(d) Voidable

20. It is necessary that in a valid contract


(a) Consideration must be lawful
(b) Object must be lawful
(c) Both of these must be lawful
(d) Anyone of these may be lawful

21. An agreement is immoral if


(a) Court regards it immoral
(b) People thinks it immoral
(c) Society does not recognize it as moral
(d) It is below the standard of moral

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 51


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

22. Every contract is made for a lawful object or lawful purpose. The object of a contract is form on the basis
of promises made by the parties. The contract to be legally valid must contain lawful object which
includes
(a) If it is not forbidden by law
(b) If it is not defeating the provisions of any law
(c) If it is not fraudulent
(d) All of the above

23. Mr. A, in consideration of Rs. 100,000/- from Mr. B agrees to publish defamatory material against Mr. T,
a famous lawyer, in order to damage his goodwill and reputation. This agreement is void because
(a) It is fraudulent
AT A GLANCE

(b) It is immoral and against public policy


(c) It involves an injury to a person
(d) It defeats the provision of any law

24. Mr. P had advanced money to Mrs. D, a married woman, to enable her to obtain divorce from her husband.
Mrs. D agreed that as soon as she gets divorced she will marry Mr. P. What is the legal status of this
agreement?
(a) This agreement is valid as marriage is a lawful contract
(b) This agreement is valid as this is made with the free consent of the parties.
(c) This agreement is void because it is a marriage brokerage agreement and is opposed to public
SPOTLIGHT

policy.
(d) This agreement is void on account of undue influence.
STICKY NOTES

52 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

ANSWERS
01. (d) Only the injured party has an option to set aside the contract in case of voidable contract

02. (c) Void contract is a perfectly valid contract at the time of formation of a contract

03. (c) By none of the parties because void agreement is void ab-initio i.e. void from the beginning

04. (d) Legal enforceability along with mutual and free consent between the parties and lawful
consideration is must for an agreement to be enforced

05. (b) Enforceable by law at the option of the aggrieved party

AT A GLANCE
06. (b) A contract may become void subsequent to its formation because a contract can never be void
from the time of its formation

07. (d) An idiot is person of unsound mind and is not competent to enter into a contract.

08. (b) An agreement with a minor is void ab initio as minor is not competent to contract.

09. (b) He is capable of understanding contract and forming rational judgement about it.

10. (d) His age, soundness of mind and qualification by law is compulsory for him to have contractual
capacity.

SPOTLIGHT
11. (a) He may enter into a contract when he is of sound mind because when he is of sound mind, he
is capable to enter into a contract according to the law

12. (c) Any act or promise will be valid consideration if such act has been done at the request of the
promisor.

13. (b) There is no requirement for the adequacy of consideration, but it should have some monetary
value.

14. (d) An agreement made on account of natural love and affection will be valid if it is expressed in
writing, registered and it is made between the parties in a near relation

STICKY NOTES
15. (a) If the two acts of making promise and getting consideration are done simultaneously, the
consideration is known as Present consideration

16. (d) Consideration may be given by promisee or any other person on his behalf. Under the law it is
not important that who has given a consideration.

17. (a) An agreement without consideration is void

18. (d) This contract is valid as consideration is future consideration.

19. (a) Promise made without consideration is valid if the person who is to be compensated has done
something voluntarily

20. (c) The object and consideration of an agreement both must be lawful

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 53


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

21. (a) When the object or consideration of an agreement is considered as immoral in the opinion of
the court such agreement will be void.

22. (d) An agreement is lawful when it is not forbidden by law, it is not fraudulent, and it is not the
defeating the provisions of any law.

23. (c) Publishing any defamatory material involves damaging the goodwill and reputation of a person
which is void.

24. (c) Breaking a marriage of another is void being opposed to public policy.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

54 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS

STICKY NOTES

Important definitions
1. An agreement enforceable by law is a “contract”.
2. An agreement which is enforceable by law at the option of one or more of the
parties thereto, but not at the option of the other or others, is a “voidable
contract”.
3. A “void contract” is a contract which ceases to be enforceable by law
becomes void when it ceases to be enforceable.
4. An agreement not enforceable by law is said to be void.

AT A GLANCE
5. When, at the desire of the promisor, the promisee or any other person has
done or abstained from doing, or does or abstains from doing, or promises
to do or to abstain from doing, something, such act or abstinence or promise
is called a “consideration” for the promise.

Essentials of a valid contract


An agreement is a contact if it meets the following conditions:
a) The agreement is made by the free consent of the parties.

SPOTLIGHT
b) The parties making the agreement are competent to contract.
c) The agreement is made for a lawful consideration.
d) The agreement is made with a lawful object.
e) The agreement is not expressly declared to be void by law.

Competent to contract
Every person is competent to contract:

STICKY NOTES
a) who is of the age of majority according to the law to which he is subject; and
b) who is of sound mind; and
c) who is not disqualified from contracting by any law to which he is subject.

Exceptions to agreement witout consideration is void.


a) natural love and affection
b) promise to compensate past volunatry services
c) Time barred debt
d) Complted gift

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 55


CHAPTER 3: VALIDITY OF CONTRACTS AND AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Circumstances where object or consideration is unlawful


Every agreement of which the object or consideration is unlawful is void.
The consideration or object of an agreement is lawful, unless
a) it is forbidden by law; or
b) is of such a nature that, if permitted, it would defeat the provisions of
any law; or
c) is fraudulent; or
d) involves or implies injury to the person or property of another; or
e) the Court regards it as immoral, or opposed to public policy.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

56 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 4

FREE CONSENT AND


VOID AGREEMENTS

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER: All agreements are contracts if they are made by the free
consent of the parties among other conditions. Two or persons
AT A GLANCE are said to consent when the agree upon the same thing in the
same sense.
SPOTLIGHT
Consent is said to be free when it is not caused by coercion,
1. Consent: Coercion and Undue undue influence, fraud, misrepresentation or mistake subject to
Influence provisions of the Contract Act.
When consent of an agreement is caused by coercion, fraud,
2. Consent: Fraud and misrepresentation, or undue influence, the agreement is a
Misrepresentation contract voidable at the option of the party whose consent was
so caused. An agreement is void where both parties are under

SPOTLIGHT
3. Consent: Mistake mistakes as to matter of fact.
4. Expressly declared Void A void agreement is one which is not enforceable by law. The
Agreements following agreements have been expressly declared to be void:
i. Agreement in restraint of marriage
5. Objective Based Q&A
ii. Agreement in restraint of trade
STICKY NOTES iii. Agreement in restraint of legal proceedings
iv. Uncertain agreements
v. Wagering agreements (also collateral agreements to
wagering agreement).

STICKY NOTES
There are certain exception to above void agreements as well.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 57


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. CONSENT: COERCION AND UNDUE INFLUENCE


1.1 Introduction

1.1.1 Consent [Section 13]


Two or more persons are said to consent when they agree upon the same thing in the same sense.
The effect of absence of consent is that the agreement is not valid and is not enforceable by law.
 Example 01:
Azam has one Alto and one Coure. He wants to sell Coure. Babar does not know that Azam has
two cars. Babar offers to buy Azam’s Alto for Rs. 400,000. Azam accepts the offer thinking it to be
an offer for his Coure. Here, there is no identity of minds in respect of the subject matter. Hence,
AT A GLANCE

there is no consent at all and hence there is no agreement.

1.1.2 Free consent [Section 14]


Consent is said to be free when it is not caused by:
a) Coercion; or
b) Undue influence; or
c) Fraud; or
d) Misrepresentation; or
e) Mistake (with certain exceptions).
Consent is said to be so caused when it would not have been given without the existence of such coercion, undue
SPOTLIGHT

influence, fraud, misrepresentation, or mistake.

1.2 Coercion

1.2.1 Definition [Section 15]


“Coercion” is the committing, or threatening to commit, any act forbidden by the Pakistan Penal Code or the
unlawful detaining, or threatening to detain, any property, to the prejudice of any person whatever, with the
intention of causing any person to enter into an agreement.
The analysis of the above definition reveals that coercion may be compelling a person to enter into a contract
under pressure or a threat.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 02:
Azam beats Babar and compels him to sell his bike for Rs. 20,000. Here, Babar’s consent has been
obtained by coercion because beating someone is an offence under the Pakistan Penal Code.
 Example 03:
The government threatens to seize the property of Azam to recover the fine due from Babar, the
son of Azam. Azam paid the fine. Held that fine was recovered by coercion.
It is immaterial whether the Pakistan Penal Code is or is not in force in the place where the coercion is employed.
If the suit is filed in Pakistan, the provisions of Pakistan Penal Code shall apply.
 Example 04:
Ameer, on board an English ship causes Faqeer to enter into an agreement by an act amounting
to criminal intimidation under the Pakistan Penal Code. Ameer afterwards sues Faqeer for breach
of contract at Karachi. Ameer has employed coercion, although his act is not offence by the law
of England and PPC was not in force at the time when or place where the act was done.

58 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

Notice that, coercion may be exercised from any person, and may be directed against any person, who is even
not a party to the contract.
 Example 05:
Ameer threatens to kill Salma, Basit’s daughter, if Basit refuses to sell his house to him. Basit
agrees to sell his house. Here, Basit’s consent has been obtained by coercion though Salma is not
a party to the contract.
 Example 06:
Asif threatens to kill Babar if Babar refuses to sell his house to Salman. Babar agrees to sell his
house. Here, Babar’s consent has been obtained by coercion though Asif is not a party to the
contract.

AT A GLANCE
1.2.2 Effect of coercion on agreement

Voidable [Section 19]


The agreement is a contract voidable at the option of the party whose consent was caused by coercion.
 Example 07:
Azam threatens to kill Babar if he does not sell his BMW for Rs 1 million to Azam. Babar
contracted to sell his BMW to Azam and receives the payments. Here, Babar’s consent has been
obtained by coercion. Hence, this contract is voidable at the option of Babar but Azam has no
right to insist that contract shall be performed.

Restitution of benefits on rescission [Section 64]

SPOTLIGHT
The party rescinding avoidable contract shall, if he has received any benefit from another party, restore such
benefit i.e. restitution.

Repayment and return [Section 72]


A person to whom money has been paid or anything delivered under coercion must repay or return it.

1.3 Undue Influence

1.3.1 Definition [Section 16]


A contract is said to be induced by “undue influence” where the relations subsisting between the parties are such

STICKY NOTES
that one of the parties is in a position to dominate the will of the other and uses that position to obtain an unfair
advantage over the other.
 Example 08:
Azam having advanced money to his son, Babar during his minority, upon Babar’s coming of age
obtains, by misuse of parental influence, a bond from Babar for a greater amount than the sum
due in respect of the advances. Azam employs undue influence.
 Example 09:
Ameer, a man enfeebled by disease or age, is induced, by Asif’s influence over him as his medical
attendant, to agree to pay Asif an unreasonable sum for his professional services. Asif employs
undue influence.

1.3.2 Presumption of position to dominate [Section 16]


In particular, and without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing principle, a person is deemed to be in a
position to dominate the will of another:

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 59


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

a) where he holds a real or apparent authority over the other; or


b) where he stands in a fiduciary relation to the other; or
c) where he makes a contract with a person whose mental capacity is temporarily or permanently affected
by reason of age, illness, or mental or bodily distress.
 Example 10:
There is presumption of position to dominate on the basis of real or apparent authority in
agreements between:
 Tax officer and taxpayer
 Police officer and accused being investigated
 Employer and employee
AT A GLANCE

 Example 11:
There is presumption of position to dominate on the basis of fiduciary relationship in agreements
between:
 Parent and child
 Guardian and minor
 Advocate and client
 Trustee and beneficiary
 Fiancé and fiancée
 Example 12:
There is presumption of position to dominate on the basis of affected mental capacity in
SPOTLIGHT

agreements between:
 Doctor and patient
 Medical attendant and patient
 Family member and enfeebled old man

1.3.3 Burden of Proof [Section 16]


Where a person who is in a position to dominate the will of another, enters into a contract with him, and the
transaction appears, on the face of it or on the evidence adduced, to be unconscionable, the burden of proving
that such contract was not induced by undue influence shall lie upon the person in a position to dominate the
will of the other.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 13:
Ameer, a man enfeebled by disease or age agrees with Asif, his medical attendant, to pay Asif a
large sum for his professional services. The burden of proof that undue influence was not
exercised lies on Asif as he is presumed to be in a position to dominate.
 Example 14:
Qaiser, a teacher sold an agricultural property to his student, Maqbool. Later, Maqbool filed a suit
to cancel the transaction. Qaiser showed that he had provided complete facts relating to property
to Maqbool, the price was market based, Maqbool had obtained advice from property dealers of
his choice before finalising the contract. Held, the contract was valid and consent was not caused
by undue influence.
 Example 15:
Asif, an agent agreed to sell stock of Sajid (the principal) @2% commission. Later, Asif demanded
5% commission being the market rate and on account that his consent was obtained by undue
influence. There is no presumption of position to dominate and burden of proof lies on Asif.

60 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

 Example 16:
Adeel applies to a banker for a loan at a time when there is stringency in the money market. The
banker declines to make the loan except at an unusually high rate of interest. Adeel accepts the
loan on these terms. This is a transaction in the ordinary course of business, and the contract is
not induced by undue influence.

1.3.4 Effect on agreement [Section 19A]


The agreement is a contract voidable at the option of the party whose consent was caused by undue influence.
Any such contract may be set aside either absolutely or, if the party who was entitled to avoid it has received any
benefits under the contract, upon such terms and conditions as to the Court may seem just.
 Example 17:

AT A GLANCE
Kanwar, a money lender advanced money to Sajid, an agriculturist in emergency situation and
by undue influence made him to execute a bond of double the amount with high interest rate.
The Court may set aside the bond, ordering Sajid to repay original amount with such interest as
may seem just.

1.4 Difference between coercion and undue influence

S.no Coercion Undue influence

1 Consent
Consent is obtained by giving a threat of an Consent is obtained by dominating the will.
offence or committing an offence.

SPOTLIGHT
2 Nature of pressure
It involves physical pressure. It involves moral pressure.

3 Relationship
Parties to a contract may or may not be related Parties to a contract are related to each other
to each other. under some sort of relationship.

4 Reason
The objective is to compel a person to enter The objective is to obtain an unfair advantage.

STICKY NOTES
into a contract.

5 Criminal liability
Criminal liability is incurred, therefore it is Criminal liability is not incurred.
illegal.

6 On whom
Coercion may be employed on a stranger Undue influence may only be employed on the
party whose consent is desired.

7 By whom
It can be exercised by a stranger to the It can only be exercised by a party to the contract
contract. and not by a stranger.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 61


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

S.no Coercion Undue influence

8 Onus of proof
The onus of proof is on the party who wants to The onus of proof is on the party in a position to
relieve himself of the consequences of coercion. dominate the will of the other party.

9 Restoration of benefit
The aggrieved party has to restore the benefit The party avoiding the contract may or may not
received. restore benefit.

 Practice Question 01:


AT A GLANCE

Jamal threatened Rafia to murder her son Atif if she did not sell her house to Mujahid. Rafia did
as she was told. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 comment on the validity of the
above contract.
 Solution:
The contract in the above situation is voidable at the option of Rafia as her consent is not free
and has been obtained by coercion.
 Practice Question 02:
Haroon was engaged to be married to Ghazala. Haroon wanted to establish his own business and
therefore he entered into a contract with Ghazala for providing him all her jewellery and
apartment by way of a gift and in return Haroon agreed to give her a small share in business
profit. After some time, Ghazala filed a suit against Haroon, requesting for setting aside the gift
SPOTLIGHT

deed as it was not made with her free will. Discuss whether Ghazala would succeed in her
contention.
 Solution:
Ghazala may succeed to recover her jewellery and apartment from Haroon on the presumption
of undue influence. A contract is said to be induced by undue influence where the relation
subsisting between the parties is such that one of the parties is in a position to dominate the will
of the other and uses that position to obtain unfair advantage over the other. Haroon in this case
is a fiancé of Ghazala and is in a position to dominate her will.
When the consent to an agreement is caused by undue influence, the agreement is voidable at the
option of the party whose consent is so caused. Therefore, the contract is voidable at the option
STICKY NOTES

of Ghazala.
The Court may set aside the contract either absolutely or, in case if Ghazala has received any
benefit under the contract, upon such terms and conditions as the Court may seem just. The
burden of prove that the above contract, which on the face of it appears to be unconscionable,
was not induced by undue influence lies on Haroon, as he is the one who is in a position to
dominate Ghazala’s will.

62 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

2. CONSENT: FRAUD AND MISREPRESENTATION


2.1 Fraud

2.1.1 Definition [Section 17]


“Fraud” means and includes any of the following acts committed by a party to a contract, or with his connivance,
or by his agent, with intent to deceive another party thereto or his agent, or to induce him to enter into the
contract:
a) the suggestion, as a fact, of that which is not true, by one who does not believe it to be true;
b) the active concealment of a fact by one having knowledge or belief of the fact;
c) a promise made without any intention of performing it;

AT A GLANCE
d) any other act fitted to deceive;
e) any such act or omission as the law specially declares to be fraudulent.
 Example 18:
Azam sells to Babar locally manufactured goods representing them to be imported goods
charging a higher price, it amounts to fraud.
 Example 19:
Zia a furniture dealer conceals the cracks in furniture sold by him by using some packing material
and polishing it in such a way that the buyer even after reasonable examination cannot trace the
defect, it would amount to fraud through active concealment.
 Example 20:

SPOTLIGHT
Buying goods under a contract of sale with an intention of not paying the price is fraud.
 Example 21:
A company issued a prospectus containing a statement that company paid dividend between
2001 and 2007 implying that company has been profitable. In fact, the company suffered losses
in those years and paid dividend out of reserves. Held, there was an intention to deceive.
 Example 22:
Ameer sold his house to Basit for Rs. 10 million. The house was mortgaged with Salman for Rs.
10 million. Ameer did not inform Basit about it, although it was his legal obligation to do so. Later,
Salman claimed Rs. 10 million from Basit. Basit can avoid contract as Ameer is guilty of fraud.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 23:
Abid knows that his watch is made in Pakistan but tells Babar that it has been made in Japan.
Babar buys the watch for a large sum. The fraud was committed by party to the contract (Abid),
it was false representation as to fact (origin of product), representation related to fact and there
was clearly intention to deceive and Babar suffered loss by paying a larger sum.

2.1.2 Silence as Fraud [Section 17]


Mere silence as to facts likely to affect the willingness of a person to enter into a contract is not fraud, unless:
a) the circumstances of the case are such that, regard being had to them, it is the duty of the person keeping
silence to speak (e.g. parties stand in fiduciary relationship), or
b) his silence is, in itself, equivalent to speech.
 Example 24:
Ameer sells by auction to Bano a horse which Ameer knows to be unsound. Ameer says nothing
to Bano about the horse's unsoundness. This is not fraud by Ameer.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 63


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 25:
Ameer sells by auction to Bano a horse which Ameer knows to be unsound. Ameer says nothing
to Bano about the horse's unsoundness. Bano is Ameer's daughter and has just come of age. Here,
the relation between the parties would make it Ameer's duty to tell Bano if the horse is unsound.
This is fraud by Ameer
 Example 26:
Ameer sells by auction to Bano a horse which Ameer knows to be unsound. Bano says to Ameer,
"If you do not deny it, I shall assume that the horse is sound." Ameer says nothing. Here Ameer's
silence is equivalent to speech. If the horse turns out to be vicious, Ameer can be held liable for
fraud.

2.1.3 Effect on agreement [Section 19]


AT A GLANCE

Voidable
The agreement is a contract voidable at the option of the party whose consent was caused by fraud.

Insist on performance
A party to a contract, whose consent was caused by fraud may, if he thinks fit, insist that the contract shall be
performed and that he shall be put in the position in which he would have been if the representation made had
been true.
 Example 27:
Abid knows that his watch is made in Pakistan but tells Babar that it has been made in Japan.
SPOTLIGHT

Babar pays amount for the watch and Abid delivers it next day. Babar committed one of his client,
Arslan, a made-in-Japan watch based on contract with Abid. On delivery, Babar discovered the
fraud committed by Abid. The contract is voidable at the option of Babar. Babar may rescind the
contract or may perform the contract and (in addition) may claim damages (for being unable to
perform contract with Arslan).

Exceptions to voidability
The contract is not voidable if the consent was caused by fraudulent silence and the party whose consent was so
caused had the means of discovering the truth with ordinary diligence.
A fraud, which did not cause the consent to a contract of the party on whom such fraud was practiced, does not
render a contract voidable.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 28:
Kamran bought a car from Habib for Rs. 1,200,000. Habib did not tell that car was fully repainted.
Kamran cannot rescind the contract. Although Habib’s silence amounted to fraud, the repainting
of car could have been discovered by ordinary diligence.
 Example 29:
Burhan Limited bought majority shares of Hussain Limited in order to gain control over new
technological research being undertaken by Hussain Limited. Later, Burhan Limited discovered
that financial statements were materially overstated (which he did not check) and he had paid
unnecessarily higher price for shares. Under the Contract Act, he cannot rescind the contract as
his purchase of shares was in ignorance of fraud.

64 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

2.2 Misrepresentation

2.2.1 Definition [Section 18]


“Misrepresentation” means and includes:
a) the positive assertion, in a manner not warranted by the information of the person making it, of that
which is not true, though he believes it to be true;
b) any breach of duty which, without an intent to deceive, gains an advantage to the person committing it,
or any one claiming under him, by misleading another to his prejudice or to the prejudice of any one
claiming under him;
c) causing, however innocently, a party to an agreement to make a mistake as to the substance of the thing
which is the subject of the agreement.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 30:
Anwar sold a mine to Munawar and told certain facts about the mine which were incorrect.
Anwar believed them to be true. Later, Munawar discovered the real facts. This is a
misrepresentation based on unwarranted statement.
 Example 31:
Azhar told Mazhar that the monthly sale of his business was Rs. 50 million before the contract
was signed. Sales was decreased to Rs. 35 million. Azhar did not inform Mazhar about the
decrease. Held, there was misrepresentation based on breach of duty.
 Example 32:
The seller told the buyer that the bike is free from defects but there was a built-in defect in it.

SPOTLIGHT
There is a misrepresentation based on inducing mistake (innocently) about subject matter.

2.2.2 Effect on agreement [Section 19]

Voidable
The agreement is a contract voidable at the option of the party whose consent was caused by misrepresentation.

Insist on performance
A party to a contract, whose consent was caused by misrepresentation may, if he thinks fit, insist that the contract
shall be performed and that he shall be put in the position in which he would have been if the representation
made had been true.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 33:
Azam sold a machine to Babar under misrepresentation that it is made-in-Germany. The contract
is voidable at the option of Babar. Babar may rescind the contract or may perform the contract.

Exceptions to voidability
The contract is not voidable if the consent was caused by misrepresentation and the party whose consent was so
caused had the means of discovering the truth with ordinary diligence.
A misrepresentation, which did not cause the consent to a contract of the party to whom such misrepresentation
was made, does not render a contract voidable.
 Example 34:
Kamran bought a car from Habib for Rs. 1,200,000. Habib made an unwarranted statement
believing it to be true regarding model of car. The model of car could have been discovered by
ordinary diligence. The contract is not voidable.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 65


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 35:
Burhan Limited bought majority shares of Hussain Limited in order to gain control over new
technological research being undertaken by Hussain Limited and also hired a consultant who
gave report on financial performance of Hussain Limited but this report was not considered
while making decision to buy shares. Later, Burhan Limited discovered that report on financial
performance contained some errors (not intentionally by the consultant). Under the Contract
Act, he cannot rescind the contract as his purchase of shares was in ignorance of
misrepresentation.

2.3 Difference between fraud and misrepresentation

S.no Fraud Misrepresentation


AT A GLANCE

1 Intention
Implies an intention to deceive. Representation is innocent without intent to
deceive.
2 Remedies
It is civil wrong and aggrieved party can claim Aggrieved party can only avoid the contract but
damages in addition to Cancellation of contract. damages are only payable at discretion of court.

 Practice Question 03:


Shafiq bought Abad’s motorcycle factory in Faisalabad on Abad’s representation that fifty
thousand motorcycles are assembled at his factory annually. Shafiq later found that the factory
has a capacity to manufacture thirty five thousand motorcycles only per annum. Shafiq now
wants to rescind the contract on the ground that his consent was obtained by misrepresentation.
SPOTLIGHT

Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 list the circumstances under which Shafiq may
not be able to rescind the contract.
 Solution:
Shafiq may not be able to rescind the contract under the following circumstances:
 If Shafiq had the means of discovering the truth with ordinary diligence; or
 Abad’s misrepresentation was not the basis for Shafiq’s consent.
 Practice Question 04:
Ghaffar purchased a piece of land from Sharif who is an engineer by profession. During the
discussion prior to the purchase, Sharif had told Ghaffar that in his opinion, the land would be
STICKY NOTES

able to support 2,500 mango trees. However, only 2300 trees could eventually be planted on the
land. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 discuss whether Ghaffar can claim damages
on the grounds of fraud.
 Solution:
Sharif’s statement that in his opinion the land could support 2,500 mango trees clearly indicated
that he was not sure about it and was just giving an opinion. Therefore, unless Ghaffar can show
that the statement was made with the intention to deceive him and representation was as to fact
and not mere an opinion, he cannot claim damages on the grounds of fraud.
 Practice Question 05:
Mughal and Dawood are trading in rice. Dawood entered into a contract with Mughal for the
purchase of 50 tons of rice. Dawood had private information of change in prices which would
have affected Mughal’s willingness to enter into the contract. When Mughal, through his own
resources, came to know about the prices, he accused Dawood of fraud and repudiated the
contract. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 explain whether Mughal is justified in
repudiating the contract.

66 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

 Solution:
No, Mughal is not justified in repudiating the contract. Dawood is not bound to disclose the
information to Mughal as the relationship existing between them is not that of ‘utmost good faith’
(i.e. fiduciary relationship). Mere silence as to facts likely to affect the willingness of a person to
enter into a contract is not fraud, unless there is a duty to disclose such fact or where silence is
equivalent to speech.
 Practice Question 06:
Sultan bought electronic appliances worth Rs. 700,000 from Zameer on thirty days’ credit. At the
time of purchase, Sultan knew that he was in insolvent circumstances. Discuss the validity of the
contract.
 Solution:

AT A GLANCE
Sultan bought electronic appliances worth Rs. 700,000 from Zameer on thirty days’ credit. At the
time of purchase, Sultan knew that he was in insolvent circumstances. Discuss the validity of the
contract.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 67


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. CONSENT: MISTAKE
3.1 Mistake

3.1.1 Definition
The term “mistake” has not been defined in the Contract Act, 1872. In the context of contract law, it can be defined
as an erroneous belief, at contracting, that certain facts are true.

3.1.2 Effect on agreement

Bilateral mistake as to matter of fact [Section 20]


Where both the parties to an agreement are under a mistake as to a matter of fact essential to the agreement, the
AT A GLANCE

agreement is void.
 Example 36:
Atif agrees to buy from Babar a certain horse. It turns out that the horse was dead at the time of
bargain though neither party was aware of the fact. The agreement is void because there is
bilateral mistake as to the existence of subject matter.
 Example 37:
Asif agrees to buy from Bakar all his horses believing that Bakar has three horses but Bakar
actually has two horses. The agreement is void because there is bilateral mistake as to the
quantity of subject matter.
 Example 38:
SPOTLIGHT

Arif agrees to buy a particular horse from Baqir. Both believe it to be a race horse but it turns to
be a cart horse. The agreement is void because there is bilateral mistake as to the quality of the
subject matter.
 Example 39:
Ameer agrees to buy a particular horse from Basit who mentioned (due to typing error) in his
letter the price as Rs 1,150 instead of 5,150. The agreement is void because there is bilateral
mistake as to the price of the subject matter.
 Example 40:
Azam agrees to buy from Babar a certain horse. Babar has one race horse and one cart horse.
STICKY NOTES

Azam thinks that he is buying race horse but Babar thinks that he is selling cart horse. The
agreement is void because there is bilateral mistake as to the identity of subject matter.
 Example 41:
Adeel agrees to buy a particular horse from Mazhar. Unknown to both parties, that horse is
already owned by Adeel. The agreement is void because there is bilateral mistake as to the title
of the subject matter.
An erroneous opinion as to the value of the thing which forms the subject matter of the agreement is not to be
deemed a mistake as to a matter of fact.
 Example 42:
Taj bought a plot of land from Raj for a large sum as they both were of the opinion that the
property prices will surge in few days. Unexpectedly, the property prices fell significantly in that
particular area. Taj cannot rescind the contract as the erroneous opinion as to value is not
deemed a mistake as to a matter of fact.

68 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

Unilateral mistake as to matter of fact [Section 22]


A contract is not voidable merely because it was caused by one of the parties to it being under a mistake as to a
matter of fact.
 Example 43:
Azam buys a painting believing it to be worth Rs 100,000 while in fact it is worth only Rs 10,000.
This is unilateral mistake and the contract is valid.

Mistake as to law [Section 21]


A contract is not voidable because it was caused by a mistake as to any law in force in Pakistan; but a mistake as
to a law not in force in Pakistan has the same effect as a mistake of fact.
 Example 44:

AT A GLANCE
Azam and Babar make a contract which is based on erroneous belief that a particular debt is
barred by Pakistani Law of limitation. The contract is valid.
 Example 45:
Andrew, a Pakistani, agrees to export a particular medicine to Boris, a foreign national. Unknown
to both of them, the law of that country has banned the sale and purchase of that particular
medicine. This is a mistake of foreign law and the agreement is void.

Repayment and return [Section 72]


A person to whom money has been paid or anything delivered by mistake must repay or return it.
 Practice Question 07:

SPOTLIGHT
Explain what effects following have on the validity of the contract:
a) Unilateral mistake of law in force in Pakistan
b) Unilateral mistake as to matter of fact
c) Mutual mistake of foreign law
 Solution:
The effects on the validity of the contract are given below:
a) In case of unilateral mistake of law in force in Pakistan the contract is not voidable.

STICKY NOTES
b) In case of unilateral mistake of fact the contract is not voidable
c) In case of mutual mistake of foreign law the agreement is void.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 69


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

4. EXPRESSLY DECLARED VOID AGREEMENTS


4.1 Restraint of marriage [Section 26]
Every agreement in restraint of the marriage of any person, other than a minor, is void. This is because the law
regards marriage and married status as the right of every individual.
 Example 46:
Bushra promises with Azam for good consideration that she will not marry Salman. It is a void
agreement.

4.2 Restraint of trade [Section 27]


AT A GLANCE

4.2.1 Basic Rule


Every agreement by which anyone is restrained from exercising a lawful profession, trade or business of any
kind, is to that extent void.
 Example 47:
Azhar and Mazhar carried on business in a certain locality in Karachi. Azhar promised to stop
business in that locality if Mazhar paid him Rs. 1,000. Azhar stopped his business but Mazhar did
not pay him the promised money. It was held that Azhar could not recover anything from Mazhar
because the agreement was in restraint of trade and was thus void.

4.2.2 Exception: Sale of goodwill


One who sells the goodwill of a business may agree with the buyer to refrain from carrying on a similar business,
SPOTLIGHT

within specified local limits, so long as the buyer, or any person deriving title to the goodwill from him, carries
on a like business therein.
However, such limits must appear to the Court reasonable, regard being had to the nature of the business.
 Example 48:
Adeel sells his bakery to Badar with goodwill of Rs. 100,000 and agrees not to open a bakery
anywhere in Pakistan. The agreement is unreasonable and so void.
 Example 49:
Salman sells his business of imitation jewellery in Multan to Dawood and promises that for two
years he will not deal in imitation jewellery in Multan. The promise is held valid and enforceable.
STICKY NOTES

4.3 Restraint of legal proceedings [Section 28]

4.3.1 Basic Rule


Every agreement, by which any party thereto is restricted absolutely from enforcing his rights under or in respect
of any contract, by the usual legal proceedings in the ordinary tribunals, or which limits the time within which
he may thus enforce his rights, is void to that extent.
 Example 50:
Anwar agrees to sell sugar to Bashir and both agree that in case of breach of contract by any
party, none of them will go to the court. The agreement is void.
 Example 51:
Azam gives Babar Rs. 100,000 as a loan for 1 year and agrees that if Babar fails to return the loan,
Azam must sue within 2 years (although period of limitation as per law of limitation is 3 years)
otherwise Babar will not be liable. The agreement is void.

70 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

The following are not absolute restrictions of legal proceedings:


a) An agreement whereby the parties agree not to file an appeal in upper court of law.
b) An agreement whereby the parties select one court of law between two courts equally competent.
 Example 52:
Adeel contracts to sell books to Naeem. In case of dispute they decide that the matter shall be
taken to district civil courts as per law but no party shall appeal against the decision to High
Court. The agreement is valid.
 Example 53:
Atif sells sports goods from Sialkot to Naeem in Lahore. In case of dispute they may sue in
Sialkot’s court or Lahore’s court. Both agree that they will sue in Lahore’s court only. The

AT A GLANCE
agreement is valid as the restriction is not absolute.

4.3.2 Exception: Refer to arbitration dispute that may arise


Two or more persons may agree that any dispute which may arise between them shall be referred to arbitration
and that only the amount awarded in such arbitration shall be recoverable in respect of the dispute so referred.
A suit may still be brought by a party in the court for specific performance or recovery of the amount so awarded
in the arbitration.
 Example 54:
Naeem and Saleem, while forming a contract, agreed that in case of breach by any of them. The
matter shall be referred to an arbitrator mutually selected by them. They also agreed that only
the amount of damages as may be awarded by such arbitrator shall be payable. Such an

SPOTLIGHT
agreement is valid.

4.3.3 Exception: Refer to arbitration questions that have already arisen


Two or more persons may agree in writing to refer to arbitration any question between them which has already
arisen.
 Example 55:
Naeem had filed a suit against Kareem in court for breach of contract. Kareem contacted Naeem
and requested out of court settlement. Naeem agreed and both of them signed and submitted a
written arbitration agreement to court. Such an agreement is valid.

STICKY NOTES
4.4 Uncertain agreements [Section 29]
Agreements void for uncertainty. Agreements, the meaning of which is not certain, or capable of being made
certain, are void.
 Example 56:
Salim agrees to sell to Babar "a hundred ton of oil". There is nothing whatever to show what kind
of oil was intended. The agreement is void for uncertainty.
 Example 57:
Dawood, who is a dealer in coconut oil, agrees to sell to Babar "one hundred ton of oil." The nature
of Dawood's trade affords an indication of the meaning of the words, and that he has entered into
a contract for the sale of one hundred tons of coconut oil.
 Example 58:
Salim agrees to sell to Babar "all the grain in my granary at Peshawar." There is no uncertainty
here to make the agreement void.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 71


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 59:
Salim agrees to sell to Babar "one thousand mounds of rice at a price to be fixed by Kashif." As
the price is capable of being made certain, there is no uncertainty here to make the agreement
void.
 Example 60:
Salim agrees to sell to Babar "my white horse for Rupees five hundred or Rupees one thousand."
There is nothing to show which of the two prices are to be paid. The agreement is void.

4.5 Wagering agreement

4.5.1 Meaning
AT A GLANCE

A wager is a bet, an agreement, by which two or more parties agree that a certain sum of money, or other thing,
shall be paid or delivered to one of them, on the happening or not happening of an uncertain event.

4.5.2 Basic Rule [Section 30]


Agreements by way of wager are void; and no suit shall be brought for recovering anything alleged to be won on
any wager, or entrusted to any person to abide the result of any game or other uncertain event on which any
wager is made.
 Example 61:
Hamid promises to pay Rs. 10,000 to Arif if it rained today, and Arif promises to pay Rs. 10,000
to Hamid if it did not. The agreement is void being a wagering agreement.
 Example 62:
SPOTLIGHT

An agreement to enter into a wrestling event in which winner was to be rewarded by the entire
sale proceeds of tickets is not a wagering agreement.
An exception is the agreement to contribute to a plate or prize of the value of Rs. 500 and above to be awarded
to winner of a horse race.

4.5.3 Agreements collateral to wagering agreements [Section 30A]


All agreements knowingly made to further or assist the entering into, effecting or carrying out, or to secure or
guarantee the performance, of any void wagering agreement, are void.
 Example 63:
STICKY NOTES

Asim agreed with Qasim to provide him credit to bet on a cricket match with the stipulation that
if Qasim won, he will share half the proceeds with Asim. This agreement being collateral to a
wagering agreement is void.

4.5.4 No suit for recovery allowed [Section 30B]


No suit or other proceeding shall lie for the recovery of:
a) any sum of money paid or payable in respect of any void wagering agreement; or
b) any commission, brokerage, fee or reward in respect of void wagering agreement; or
c) any sum of money knowingly paid or payable on account of any person by way of commission, brokerage,
fee, reward or other claim in respect of any void wagering agreement.
 Example 64:
Sajid and Majid deposited Rs. 5,000 each with Nawaz for betting, winner to take whole amount.
Sajid won the bet but Nawaz refused to pay any amount to him. Sajid cannot file a suit for
recovery of the amount.

72 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

 Example 65:
Naseem and Kareem deposited Rs. 5,000 each for a bet on a card game. Naseem agreed to give
Shahbaz 20% commission for his support during the game. Naseem won the bet but refused to
give any money to Shahbaz. Shahbaz cannot sue for recovery of the amount.

4.5.5 Payment by guardian, executor etc. for void agreements not to be allowed credit [Section 30C]
A persons shall not be allowed any credit in his account for making any payment if:
a) such person is
 guardian of the minor on whose behalf he made payment; or
 heir or personal representative of a deceased person on whose behalf he made payment; and

AT A GLANCE
b) such payment relates to void wagering agreement, or agreement collateral to void wagering agreement.
 Example 66:
Naseer is guardian of Kabeer, a minor. Kabeer lost a bet and Naseer paid Rs. 7,000 from his
pocket for the bet. Naseer shall not be entitled to any credit in his account in respect of such
payment.
 Practice Question 08:
Two wrestlers Goga and Sheeda agreed to play a wrestling match on the condition that if any of
them would fail to appear for the match, he would have to pay Rs. 5,000 to the other party. The
winner was to receive Rs. 20,000 out of the sale proceeds of the tickets. Goga failed to appear in
the match and Sheeda sued him for Rs. 5,000. Goga however, refused to pay claiming that being
wagering in nature, the contract is not enforceable by law.

SPOTLIGHT
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 describe whether Sheeda can recover the amount
from Goga.
 Solution:
All agreements knowingly made to further or assist the entering into, effecting or carrying out,
or to secure or guarantee the performance, of any agreement void being in nature of wager, are
void.
But in this case, Goga and Sheeda were not going to win or lose in terms of money as a result of
wrestling match (i.e. uncertain event). The winning amount had not to be given out of their
pockets, but had to be paid from the gate money which was provided by the public. As for the

STICKY NOTES
condition of payment for non-appearance, no uncertain event provided the equal chances of
winning or losing.
Therefore, Sheeda is entitled to recover the amount from Goga as the agreement between Goga
and Sheeda is not a wagering agreement and therefore, it is enforceable at law.
 Practice Question 09:
Until recently Mansoor and Arif were independently engaged in the business of selling sweets at
Multan railway station. Mansoor incurred a loss due to competition. Arif, in view of his friendship
with Mansoor, agreed to move his business to the old city area.
They reached an agreement that Arif would not engage in any competing business with Mansoor.
It was also agreed that in case of a breach, none of them would have recourse to a court of law
for the enforcement of their rights.
Subsequently, due to economic downturn, Arif in addition to the old city area has also started to
sell sweets at Multan railway station. Mansoor, in order to restrain Arif from selling sweets has
filed a suit against him.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 73


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 analyse the above situation and explain the
following:
i. whether Arif is justified in starting sweets business at Multan railway station.
ii. what would be your answer in (i) above, if Mansoor had bought the goodwill of Arif’s
business.
iii. whether Mansoor is justified in filing a suit in the court of law.
iv. what would be your answer in (iii) above, if both Arif and Mansoor had agreed to refer
their disputes to arbitration and not to the court of law.
 Solution:
Part (i) Agreement in restraint of trade
AT A GLANCE

Yes, Arif is justified in starting a sweets business at Multan railway station. As any agreement by
which anyone is restricted from exercising a lawful profession, trade or business of any kind, is
void to that extent.
Part (ii) Exception:
Arif in this case would not be justified to start similar business at Multan railway station. An
agreement which restrains the seller of a goodwill from carrying on a business is valid if all the
following conditions are fulfilled:
 Such restriction must relate to a similar business.
 Such restriction must be within specified local limits.
 Such restriction must be for the time so long as the buyer or any person deriving title to
SPOTLIGHT

the goodwill from him carries on a like business in the specified local limits.
 Such specified local limits must be reasonable to the Court having regard to the nature
of the business.
Part (iii) Agreement in restraint of legal proceedings:
Yes, Mansoor is justified in filing a suit against Arif. Every agreement, by which any party is
restricted absolutely from enforcing his rights under or in respect of any contract, by the usual
legal proceedings in the ordinary tribunals, is void to that extent.
Part (iv) Exception
An agreement between Arif and Mansoor to refer to arbitration any dispute which may arise
STICKY NOTES

between them is not void. However, parties right to seek remedy from court of law cannot be
absolutely restrained.
 Practice Question 10:
On 1 July 2018 Basit agreed to buy 500 grams of silver from Taimure after two months at a price
of Rs. 65 per gram. On the due date the price of silver was Rs. 62 per gram. Under the provisions
of the Contract Act, 1872 discuss the validity of the above contract if both Basit and Taimure had
an intention to settle the transaction by paying the difference between the contract price and the
market price without making any delivery.
 Solution:
The contract being wagering in nature, is not a valid contract. As both Basit and Taimure had no
intention of giving or taking delivery of goods and were only interested in earning profit by way
of fluctuations in silver prices.

74 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

5. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Relation between the parties must exist to use
(a) Fraud
(b) Undue influence
(c) Coercion
(d) Mistake

02. Undue influence implies


(a) It involves mental and moral pressure

AT A GLANCE
(b) Criminal liability is incurred
(c) Pressure of money
(d) Physical pressure on the party

03. Coercion may be directed upon


(a) The party whose consent is being caused
(b) Any other party
(c) Either (a) or (b)
(d) None of the above

SPOTLIGHT
04. Fraud exists if it is shown that false statement has been made
(a) Knowingly
(b) Without belief in its truth
(c) Recklessly without caring it be true and false
(d) All of the above, if done, with an intention to deceive

05. Undue influence is legally not presumed in case of

STICKY NOTES
(a) Guardian and ward
(b) Creditor and debtor
(c) Solicitor and client
(d) Trustee and beneficiary

06. Which of the following is not true


(a) Undue influence must be exercised by or against the party to a contract
(b) Coercion can be exercised by a stranger to the contract
(c) A contract is not voidable if it was caused by a mistake as to any law in force in Pakistan
(d) Duty to speak does not make silence as fraud

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 75


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

07. A person threatens to commit a suicide, if his wife and son did not contract with his brother to release
certain disputed property in his favour. What is the legal status of this agreement?
(a) The contract was caused by coercion
(b) The contract was caused by undue influence
(c) The contract was caused by moral pressure
(d) None of the above

08. Bilal is a manufacturer of colour television sets. He gives an advertisement that in his opinion television
sets manufactured by him is the best available in the market. Such statement
(a) Will amount to misrepresentation
AT A GLANCE

(b) Will amount to active concealment


(c) Will amount to fraud
(d) Will not amount to fraud

09. Unlawful detaining or threatening to detain any property with an intention of causing any person to enter
into a contract is
(a) Misrepresentation
(b) Bilateral mistake of fact
(c) Fraud
SPOTLIGHT

(d) Coercion

10. A young widow was forced to adopt the boy, under threat of preventing the dead body of her husband
from being removed and getting cremated. Can widow set aside adoption deed?
(a) No because the adoption deed was made by her free will
(b) No because the adoption deed was made by fraud
(c) Yes because the adoption deed was made by undue influence
(d) Yes because the adoption deed was made by coercion
STICKY NOTES

11. Coercion is the committing or threatening to commit any act which is forbidden by
(a) Pakistan Penal Code
(b) The Contract Act
(c) The Partnership Act
(d) None of the above

12. Which of the following does not affect free consent of parties
(a) Fraud
(b) Misrepresentation
(c) Undue influence
(d) Unsoundness of mind

76 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

13. In case of sale of goodwill, restraint to similar business for the seller of goodwill is valid if it is for
(a) Specified local limits
(b) Particular period of time
(c) Restriction must be reasonable
(d) All of the above

14. Which one of the following is not void


(a) Agreement to marry a particular person
(b) Agreement not to marry at all

AT A GLANCE
(c) Agreement to prevent the person from getting married
(d) Agreement to marry in heaven

15. Which one of the following is not a restraint to trade


(a) Agreement to sell all produce to a certain party with a stipulation that buyer is bound to accept
whole quantity
(b) Agreement to stop rival shop-keeper in particular locality from doing business in consideration of
money
(c) Agreement to sell all produce to a certain party and the buyer is free to rejects the goods
(d) Partial restraint in trade

SPOTLIGHT
16. In case of sale of goodwill of business, the vendor of goodwill may be lawfully restricted from doing
similar business
(a) Anywhere in that particular area
(b) Within specified local limits
(c) Within that particular district
(d) Within that particular province

STICKY NOTES
17. Agreements in restraint of legal proceedings include
(a) Agreements which tend to prevent course of justice
(b) Agreement to refer present dispute to an arbitration
(c) Agreement to settle dispute out of the court
(d) Agreement to refer future dispute to arbitration

18. Which of the following agreements is valid


(a) Agreement limiting the time allowed by the law of limitation
(b) Agreement which contains vague or ambiguous terms which cannot be made certain
(c) Agreement, meaning of which seems to be uncertain but is capable of being made certain
(d) Agreement to agree in future

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 77


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

19. Parties of wagering agreement do not have


(a) Any interest in the happening or non-happening of future uncertain event
(b) Interest in the non-happening of the events
(c) Some other interest in the happening of the event
(d) Some other interest in the non-happening of the event

20. Which one of the following is void agreement


(a) Agreement to buy ticket of lottery sponsored by the Government
(b) Agreement to pay more than Rs. 500/- to the winner of a horse race
AT A GLANCE

(c) Crosswords puzzle based on application of skill and talent


(d) Athlete competition

21. Void agreement do not create any rights and obligations between parties and cannot be enforced in the
court either by the parties in addition, there are many agreement which have also expressly being
declared as void by the law, which of the following is not a void agreement
(a) Agreement in restraint of trade
(b) Agreement in restraint of marriage
(c) Agreement in restraint of marriage of a minor
SPOTLIGHT

(d) Agreement in restraint by way of wager

22. According to the relevant section of the Contract Act, agreement by way of wager is void. Which of the
following transaction is not included in wagering agreement?
(a) Transactions of lotteries
(b) Gambling transaction
(c) Purchase of shares and debentures
(d) None of the above
STICKY NOTES

78 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS

ANSWERS
01. (b) Parties to a contract are related to each other under some sort of relationship
02. (a) Undue influence implies unfair use of dominating position and some kind of mental and moral
pressure.
03. (c) Coercion may be exercised from any person and may be directed against any person, even a
stranger
04. (d) If an act is done, with an intention to deceive because fraud is an intentional misrepresentation
of the facts.
05. (b) There is no presumption that a person is in position to dominate the will of another person in
case of creditor and debtor.

AT A GLANCE
06. (d) Duty to speak does not make silence as fraud because it is the duty of the person keeping
silence to speak.
07. (a) The threat to commit a suicide is an offence under Pakistan Penal Code.
08. (d) Will not amount to fraud because it is a mere expression of opinion for making self- praise of
his own goods.
09. (d) A contract is set to be caused by coercion when it is obtained by unlawful detaining or
threatening to detain the property
10. (d) Yes because the adoption deed was made by coercion because coercion implies use of physical
force or threat to cause consent.

SPOTLIGHT
11. (a) A contract is said to be caused by coercion when it is obtained by committing or threatening to
commit any act which is forbidden by Pakistan Penal Code
12. (d) Unsoundness of mind comes within the ambit of contractual capacity and not in free consent
of parties.
13. (d) One who sells the goodwill of the business may agree with the buyer to refrain from carrying
on a similar business, provided that such restrictions are reasonable
14. (a) A promise to marry a particular person does not imply restraint of marriage.
15. (a) Agreement to sell all produce to a certain party with a stipulation that buyer is bound to accept
whole quantity

STICKY NOTES
16. (b) Provided the restriction is reasonable, restriction can be made with the consent of both the
parties.
17. (a) Jurisdiction of court of law cannot be restricted by any agreement.
18. (c) Agreement, meaning of which seems to be uncertain but is capable of being made certain.
19. (a) They simply look at the possibility of happening of the event for their gain or loss.
20. (a) Agreement to buy ticket of lottery sponsored by the Government. A lottery is a game of chance.
An agreement to buy a lottery ticket is void.
21. (c) Agreement in restraint of marriage of a minor. Agreement, which prevents a minor from
getting married, is valid.
22. (c) Transaction of real and genuine sale and purchase of share and other securities in a stock
exchange is not of a wagering nature.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 79


CHAPTER 4: FREE CONSENT AND VOID AGREEMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

Consent: Definitions
1. Two or more persons are said to “consent” when they agree upon the same thing in
the same sense.
2. Consent is said to be free when it is not caused by coercion, undue influence, fraud,
misrepresentation, or mistake (with certain exceptions).
3. “Coercion” is the committing, or threatening to commit, any act forbidden by the
Pakistan Penal Code or the unlawful detaining, or threatening to detain, any property,
to the prejudice of any person whatever, with the intention of causing any person to
AT A GLANCE

enter into an agreement.


4. A contract is said to be induced by “undue influence” where the relations subsisting
between the parties are such that one of the parties is in a position to dominate the
will of the other and uses that position to obtain an unfair advantage over the other.
5. “Fraud” means and includes any of the following acts committed by a party to a
contract, or with his connivance, or by his agent, with intent to deceive another party
thereto or his agent, or to induce him to enter into the contract:
a) the suggestion, as a fact, of that which is not true, by one who does not believe
it to be true;
b) the active concealment of a fact by one having knowledge or belief of the fact;
SPOTLIGHT

c) a promise made without any intention of performing it;


d) any other act fitted to deceive;
e) any such act or omission as the law specially declares to be fraudulent.
6. “Misrepresentation” means and includes:
a) the positive assertion, in a manner not warranted by the information of the
person making it, of that which is not true, though he believes it to be true;
b) any breach of duty which, without an intent to deceive, gains an advantage to
the person committing it, or any one claiming under him, by misleading
another to his prejudice or to the prejudice of any one claiming under him;
c) causing, however innocently, a party to an agreement to make a mistake as
STICKY NOTES

to the substance of the thing which is the subject of the agreement.


7. In the context of contract law, “mistake” can be defined as an erroneous belief, at
contracting, that certain facts are true.

Expressly declared void agreements


Void agreement Exception
1. Restraint of marriage With a minor
2. Restraint of trade Sale of goodwill
3. Restraint of legal proceedings Refer to arbitration
4. Uncertain agreements
5. Wagering agreements Contribution to horse race winner

80 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 5

CONTINGENT CONTRACTS

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
A contingent contract is a contract to do or not to do something,
if some event collateral to such contract, does or does not

AT A GLANCE
AT A GLANCE
happen.
SPOTLIGHT If a contingent contract is to be performed if an uncertain future
event happens, it cannot be enforced until the event has
1. Introduction happened. If it is to be performed if a particular event does not
happen, its performance can be enforced if the event becomes
2. Rules regarding Contingent impossible.
Contract If a contingent contract depends for its performance on doing of
an act by the promisor, the contract becomes void where the
3. Objective Based Q&A promisor makes the performance impossible.
STICKY NOTES If a contingent contract contemplates doing of a thing if a
specified event happens within a fixed time, it becomes void if

SPOTLIGHT
the event does not happen within that time.
If a contingent contract contemplates to do anything if an
impossible event happens, it is void.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 81


CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Definition [Section 31]
A “contingent contract” is a contract to do or not to do something, if some event, collateral to such contract, does
or does not happen.
The following contracts are best examples of contingent contracts:
a) Contracts of indemnity e.g. insurance contract
b) Contract of guarantee (surety is liable to pay creditor in case of default of principal debtor)
 Example 01:
Akram contracts to indemnify Basit upto Rs. 1 million in consideration of Rs. 20,000 annual
AT A GLANCE

premium if Basit’s house is burnt. This is a contingent contract.

1.2 Characteristics of contingent contracts


The following are the characteristics of contingent contracts:
a) the performance of a contingent contract depends upon the happening or non-happening of some future
event.
b) the event must be collateral to the contract
c) the event must be uncertain
 Example 02:
Javed contracts to pay Rs. 50m to Farhan (a contractor) for constructing a building, provided the
SPOTLIGHT

construction is approved by an architect. It is a contingent contract because the consideration of


the promise to pay Rs. 50m is the construction of the building, and the event, namely, approval
by an architect is a collateral event.
 Example 03:
Azam agrees to construct a building for Babar for Rs. 5 million, on the terms that no payment
shall be made till the completion of the work. This is not a contingent contract because the
uncertain event (i.e. Azam’s completing the work) is not collateral to the contract but is the very
thing contracted for and is thus an integral part of the contract.

1.3 Contingent contract vs wagering agreement


STICKY NOTES

The main points of the distinction between the two are as under:

Contingent contract Wagering agreement


Validity
It is a valid contract. It is void and illegal.

Interest of parties
In a contingent contract parties have real interest in Parties are not interested in the occurrence or non-
the occurrence or non-occurrence of the event e.g. occurrence of the event except for the winning or
insurable interest in the property insured. losing the amount.

Uncertain event
The future uncertain event is merely collateral. The uncertain event is the sole determining factor of
the agreement.
Reciprocal promises
It consists of reciprocal promises. It may or may not consist of reciprocal promises.

82 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS

Promises which form the consideration or part of the consideration for each other are called “reciprocal
promises”. [Section 2(f)]

 Practice Question 01:


Vazir said to Saulat, “I will buy speed boats worth Rs. 10,000,000 from you, if you obtain the
licence for me to operate the boats at Clifton beach”. Saulat agreed and applied for the licence
and deposited Rs. 100,000 as processing fee. However, before the issuance of licence, the city
government imposed ban on the issuance of new licences. Saulat wants Vazir to buy the speed
boats as he had made necessary efforts to arrange for the licence. However, Vazir refuses to buy
the speed boats from Saulat.
Under the Contract Act, 1872 identify the type of contract between Vazir and Saulat. Also state
whether Vazir is now bound to purchase the speed boats from Saulat.

AT A GLANCE
 Solution:
The contract between Vazir and Saulat is a contingent contract whose performance is based on
the happening of uncertain event collateral to the contract, i.e. arranging of license for Vazir. If
such event has not happened the performance of the contract does not become due. It does not
matter at all that Saulat had applied for the license and also paid processing fee of Rs. 100,000 to
the authorities. Thus Vazir is not bound to purchase the boats from Saulat.
 Practice Question 02:
Zubair agrees to construct a bungalow for Ubaid for Rs. 20 million on the condition that payment
will only be made after Muneer, an architect, certifies that the bungalow has been constructed in
accordance with the layout plan. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 describe the
nature and validity of the above contract.

SPOTLIGHT
 Solution:
It is a contingent contract as the condition i.e. certification of the construction in accordance with
the layout plan by a third party is collateral to the contract. Although it is a valid contract, the
performance can only be enforced by Zubair after happening of the collateral event. i.e.
certification by Muneer.
 Practice Question 03:
Asim agreed to construct a bungalow for Ali at a cost of Rs. 50 million. However, it was agreed
that payment would only be made on completion of the project. Is this a contingent contract
under the Contract Act, 1872? Give reasons. Also list the requisite characteristics of a contingent
contract.

STICKY NOTES
 Solution:
No, this is not a contingent contract as the condition i.e. construction of a bungalow is not
collateral to the contract; but in itself forms a consideration and is thus an integral part of the
contract.
Essentials of a contingent contract
The following are the essential characteristics of a contingent contract:
i. the performance of such a contract depends upon the happening or non-happening of
some future event;
ii. the event must be uncertain;
iii. the event must be collateral i.e. incidental to the contract.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 83


CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. RULES REGARDING CONTINGENT CONTRACTS


2.1 Enforcement of contingent contracts [Section 32, 33, 35 & 36]

Contingent on Time fixed When enforceable When void


Happening of No If the event happens. If the event becomes
uncertain future event impossible.
Yes If the event happens within If time expires or event
time fixed. becomes impossible before
time expires.
Non-happening of No If the event becomes If the event happens.
AT A GLANCE

uncertain future event impossible.


Yes If time expires or event If the event happens within
becomes impossible before time fixed.
time expires.
Happening of an Such agreements are void whether the impossibility of the event is known or not
impossible event to the parties to the agreement at the time when it is made.

 Example 04:
Aslam makes a contract to sell a horse to Baqir, if Chand (to whom the horse has been offered)
refuses to buy it. Chand rejected the offer. The contract is enforceable.
 Example 05:
SPOTLIGHT

Andrew contracts to pay a sum of money to Becca, if Becca marries Christopher. Christopher dies
before getting married. The contract becomes void.
 Example 06:
Azam promises to pay a sum of money to Babar, if a certain ship returns within a year. The
contract becomes enforceable when the ship returns within a year.
 Example 07:
Adeel promises to pay a sum of money to Badar, if a certain ship returns within a year. The
contract becomes void if the ship sinks within a year or if it returns after a year.
 Example 08:
STICKY NOTES

Arslan agrees to pay a sum of money to Burhan, if a certain ship does not return. The ship is sunk.
The contract becomes enforceable when the ship is sunk.
 Example 09:
Amjad agrees to pay a sum of money to Basit, if a certain ship does not return. The ship returns.
The contract becomes void.
 Example 10:
Alia promises to pay a sum of money to Beenish, if a certain ship does not return within a year.
The contract becomes enforceable when the ship does not return within a year or is sunk earlier.
 Example 11:
Ashwin promises to pay a sum of money to Bumrah, if a certain ship does not return within a
year. The contract becomes void when the ship returns within a year.

84 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS

 Example 12:
Adam agrees to pay Rs. 1,000 to Boris, if he can run at 500 kilometres per hour. The agreement
is void.
 Example 13:
Asma agrees to pay Rs. 1,000 to Basheer if he marries Asma’s daughter, Chanda. Chanda is not
alive at the time of the agreement. The agreement is void.

2.2 When event based on future conduct is deemed impossible [Section 34]
If the future event on which a contract is contingent is the way in which a person will act at an unspecified time,
the event shall be considered to become impossible when such person does anything which renders it impossible
that he should so act within any definite time, or otherwise than under further contingencies.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 14:
Kamal agrees to pay Sarmad a sum of money to Sarmad, if Sarmad marries Shazia. Shazia marries
Dawood. The marriage of Sarmad to Shazia must now be considered impossible, although it is
possible that Dawood may die and that Shazia may afterwards marry. If later Sarmad actually
marries Shazia (Dawood’s widow), it will not revive the old obligation.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 85


CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Contingent contracts are
(a) Always valid
(b) May be valid
(c) May be voidable
(d) May be unenforceable

02. Performance of contingent contract depends on


(a) Happening of some future event
AT A GLANCE

(b) Non-happening of some future event


(c) Happening or Non-happening of some uncertain event
(d) Happening or Non-happening of some uncertain event collateral to such contract

03. Agreement to pay money without having any other interest on the happening or non-happening of some
future event is
(a) Contingent contract
(b) Insurance contract
(c) Wagering agreement
SPOTLIGHT

(d) Quasi contract

04. Contingent contracts are


(a) Absolute contracts
(b) Partly absolute contracts
(c) Conditional contracts
(d) None of the above
STICKY NOTES

05. Which one of the following statement is true


(a) All contingent contracts are not wagering in nature
(b) Contingent contracts and wagering contracts are one and same
(c) Contingent contracts are absolute contracts
(d) Contingent contracts are not conditional contract

06. Contingent contract is based on an event


(a) Which is uncertain
(b) Which is certain to happen
(c) Which is partly uncertain
(d) Which is partly certain

86 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS

07. A contract of insurance is a


(a) Contract of guarantee
(b) Contingent contract
(c) Wagering agreement
(d) Unilateral agreement

08. Mr. X agrees to pay a certain sum to Mr. Y, if Mr. Y brings on earth a star from the sky. It is
(a) Valid contract
(b) Void agreement

AT A GLANCE
(c) Voidable contract
(d) Void contract

09. Mr. A contract to pay Mr. B sum of Rs.20000. If his house gets on fire. It is
(a) Wagering agreement
(b) Contingent contract
(c) Unilateral agreement
(d) Bilateral agreement

SPOTLIGHT
10. In a contract, contingent on non-happening of uncertain future event within the time fixed by parties, the
contract is enforceable:
(a) Only if the event happens within time fixed.
(b) Only if time expires or event becomes impossible before time expires.
(c) Only if the event becomes impossible.
(d) Only if the event happens.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 87


CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (b) May be valid. That depends upon the situation of contingent contract that it may be valid or it
may not be
02. (d) Happening or Non-happening of some uncertain event collateral to such contract. The
performance of the contingent contract depend on the happening or non-happening of an
uncertain event in future and that event must be collateral to the main contract.
03. (c) Wagering agreement. Wagering agreement is one in which money is to be paid by one to
another party without having any other interest. It is void
04. (c) The performance of a contingent contract depends upon the happening or non-happening of
some condition.
AT A GLANCE

05. (a) If the object of a contingent contract is valid then it is perfectly a valid contract and not a
wagering agreement.
06. (a) Which is uncertain. The event must be uncertain, and contingency will arise only if it’s
happening or non-happening is quite uncertain
07. (b) Contingent contract. Insurance contract is a contract whereby the insurance company in
consideration of payment of premium from the insured promises to compensate his losses
arising out of insured cause.
08. (b) Void agreement. Any agreement which is impossible to perform is void from the beginning i.e.
void ab-initio.
09. (b) Contingent contract. Payment of money by Mr. A will be made on breaking of fire in the house
SPOTLIGHT

of Mr. B. the performance of this agreement depends on breaking of fire in Mr. B’s house.
10. (b) If time expires or event becomes impossible before time expires.
STICKY NOTES

88 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS

STICKY NOTES

Definition of Contingent Contract


A “contingent contract” is a contract to do or not to do something, if some event,
collateral to such contract, does or does not happen.

Characteristics of Contingent Contract


The following are the characteristics of contingent contracts:

AT A GLANCE
a) the performance of a contingent contract depends upon the happening or
non-happening of some future event.
b) the event must be collateral to the contract.
c) the event must be uncertain.

Summary of Rules on Contingent Contracts

Time
Contingent on When enforceable When void
fixed

SPOTLIGHT
If the event becomes
No If the event happens.
impossible.
Happening of
uncertain future
event If time expires or event
If the event happens
Yes becomes impossible before
within time fixed.
time expires.

If the event becomes


No If the event happens.
impossible.
Non-happening
of uncertain
future event If time expires or event
If the event happens within

STICKY NOTES
Yes becomes impossible
time fixed.
before time expires.

Happening of an Such agreements are void whether the impossibility of the event is
impossible known or not to the parties to the agreement at the time when it is
event made.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 89


CHAPTER 5: CONTINGENT CONTRACTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

90 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 6

PERFORMANCE OF
CONTRACTS-I

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
As a general rule, the parties to a contract must either perform
or offer for perform their respective promises. It means there
AT A GLANCE
are two types of performance:
SPOTLIGHT i. Actual performance
ii. Attempted performance or tender
1. Contracts which must be
Performed Where a debtor, owing several distinct debts to one person,
makes a payment the rules of appropriation apply as follows:
2. Appropriation of Payments
i. The debtor has, at the time of payment, right of choice
of appropriating the payment.
3. Contracts which need not be

SPOTLIGHT
Performed ii. In default of the debtor, the creditor has the right to
appropriate.
4. Objective Based Q&A
iii. In default of either, the debts will be appropriated in
order of time.
STICKY NOTES
A contract need not be performed in following circumstances:
i. When it has been rescinded, altered or substituted with
a new contract.
ii. When the promisee dispenses with or remits
performance.
iii. When promisee neglects to afford promisor reasonable

STICKY NOTES
facilities for performance.
iv. When performance becomes, afterwards, impossible or
unlawful.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 91


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. CONTRACTS WHICH MUST BE PERFORMED


1.1 Obligation to perform [Section 37]
The parties to a contract must either perform (actual performance), or offer to perform (attempted
performance), their respective promises, unless such performance is dispensed with or excused under the
provisions of this Act, or of any other law.

1.2 Types of performances


There are two types of performance, actual performance and attempted performance.

1.2.1 Actual performance


AT A GLANCE

When the promisor has made the performance in accordance with the terms of the contract and it is accepted by
the promisee it is called an actual performance.
 Example 01:
Azam contracted to deliver to Babar at his warehouse on 1st November, 500 bales of cotton of a
particular quality. Azam brought the cotton of requisite quality to the appointed place on the
appointed day during the business hours, and Babar took the delivery of goods. This is an actual
performance.

1.2.2 Attempted performance [Section 38]


When the promisor has made an offer of performance but the offer of performance of promisor is not accepted
by the promisee it is called an attempted performance. Attempted performance is also known as tender or offer
SPOTLIGHT

of performance.
 Example 02:
Azam contracted to deliver to Babar at his warehouse on 1st November, 500 bales of cotton of a
particular quality. Azam brought the cotton of requisite quality to the appointed place on the
appointed day during the business hours, and Babar refused to take the delivery of goods; it is a
case of attempted performance because Azam has done what he was required to do under the
contract.

1.3 Essentials of a valid offer of performance [Section 38]


An offer of performance is valid if it fulfils following conditions:
STICKY NOTES

a) it must be unconditional; and


b) it must be made at a proper time; and
c) it must be made at a proper place; and
d) it must be made under such circumstances that the person to whom it is made may have a reasonable
opportunity of ascertaining that the person by whom it is made is able and willing there and then to do
the whole of what he is bound by his promise to do; and
e) if the offer is an offer to deliver anything to the promisee, the promisee must have a reasonable
opportunity of seeing that the thing offered is the thing which the promisor is bound by his promise to
deliver.
 Example 03:
Anum, who is a debtor of ABC Limited, offers to pay the amount due if ABC Limited also allots
her 500 shares at par value. It is not a valid tender of money due to condition specified by Anum.

92 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

 Example 04:
Adeel ordered a cake from Shangrilla Bakers for his daughter’s birthday on 17th August.
Shangrilla Bakers brought the cake on 15th August for delivery. Adeel is not bound to accept the
cake as the tender is not made at a proper time.
 Example 05:
Azam is tenant of Babar. He offers him rent at a marriage party. Babar is not bound to accept as
the tender is not made at a proper place.
 Example 06:
Waqas is debtor of Babar. Waqas offers to pay in instalments to Babar while the contract
stipulated payment in full. It is not a valid tender as it not for the whole obligation as agreed.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 07:
Kamran delivered the goods to Waqas at 2 pm as agreed but did not allow him any time for
inspection of goods. It is not a valid tender.
 Example 08:
Akmal contracts to deliver to Basit at his warehouse, on the 1st March 2021, 100 bales of cotton
of a particular quality. In order to make a valid offer of a performance, Akmal must bring the
cotton to Basit’s warehouse, on the appointed day, under such circumstances that Basit may have
a reasonable opportunity of satisfying himself that the thing offered is cotton of the quality
contracted for, and that there are 100 bales.
An offer to one of several joint promisees has the same legal consequences as an offer to all of them.

SPOTLIGHT
 Example 09:
Ashraf owes Rs. 15,000 to Rizwan and Tanveer jointly. He offered to pay the amount to Tanveer
on a proper time and place who refused to receive it. It shall be considered valid tender of
performance by Ashraf.

1.4 Effect of refusal to accept offer of performance [Section 38]


Where a promisor has made a valid offer of performance to the promisee, and the offer has not been accepted
the promisor is not responsible for non-performance, nor does he thereby lose his rights (of compensation and
rescission) under the contract.
 Example 10:

STICKY NOTES
Naeem properly tendered goods to Asim in accordance with the terms of contract but Asim
refused to accept the goods. Naeem does not have to deliver goods later and can sue Asim for
damages caused by non-acceptance of goods.

1.5 Obligation of representatives of the promisors [Section 37]


Promises bind the representatives of the promisors in case of the death of such promisors before performance,
unless a contrary intention appears from the contract e.g. contract is of personal nature.
 Example 11:
Ajmal promises to deliver goods to Bano on a certain day on payment of Rs. 1,000. Ajmal dies
before that day. Ajmal’s representatives are bound to deliver the goods to Bano, and Bano is
bound to pay the Rs. 1,000 to Ajmal’s representatives.
 Example 12:
Anwar promises to paint a picture for Saleem by a certain day, at a certain price. Anwar dies
before the day. The contract cannot be enforced either by Anwar’s representatives or by Saleem.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 93


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.6 Effect of refusal to perform promise wholly [Section 39]


When a party to a contract has refused to perform or disabled himself from performing his promise in its entirety,
the promisee may put an end to the contract, unless he has signified, by words or conduct, his willingness in its
continuance.
 Example 13:
Asma, a singer enters into a contract with Babar, the manager of a theatre, to sing at his theatre
two nights in every week during the next two months, and Babar engages to pay her Rs.100 for
each night's performance. On the sixth night, Asma wilfully absents herself from the theatre.
Babar is at liberty to put an end to the contract.
 Example 14:
Asma, a singer enters into a contract with Babar, the manager of a theatre, to sing at his theatre
AT A GLANCE

two nights every week during the next two months and Babar engages to pay her at the rate of
Rs.100 for each night. On the sixth night, Asma wilfully absents herself. With the assent of Babar,
Asma sings on the seventh night. Babar has signified his acquiescence in the continuance of the
contract, and cannot now put an end to it, but is entitled to compensation for damage sustained
by him through Asma's failure to sing on the sixth night.
 Practice Question 01:
In accordance with the contract entered into by Masoom and Mubarak, Masoom has offered to
deliver 300 Rolex watches to Mubarak on 1 March 2015. Under the provisions of the Contract
Act, 1872 advise Masoom about the conditions which must be satisfied for constituting a valid
offer of performance.
 Solution:
SPOTLIGHT

In order to constitute a valid offer, Masoom must fulfil the following conditions:
i. The offer must be unconditional;
ii. It must be made at a proper time and place, and under such circumstance that Mubarak
may have a reasonable opportunity of ascertaining that Masoom is able and willing there
and then to deliver 300 Rolex watches;
iii. Mubarak (the promisee) must have a reasonable opportunity of satisfying himself that
the watches offered are the Rolex watches and are 300 in numbers which Masoom (the
promisor) was bound by his promise to deliver.
 Practice Question 02:
STICKY NOTES

Mehboob, a promisor and Saulat, a promisee, entered into a valid contract. However, when
Mehboob made an offer of performance, Saulat refused to accept the same. Briefly state the rights
and responsibility of Mehboob against such refusal. Also state the essentials of a valid offer of
performance under the provisions of Contract Act, 1872.
 Solution:
Rights and responsibilities of Mehboob:
Mehboob would not be responsible for non-performance; he will not lose his rights to claim
damages under the contract, for instance he will be entitled to compensation and contract will
become voidable at his option; in case of performance by Saulat on Mehboob’s demand, Mehboob
will be responsible to perform his promise.

94 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

Essentials of a valid offer of performance:


i. it must be unconditional;
ii. it must be made at a proper time and place, and under such circumstances that the
person to whom it is made may have a reasonable opportunity of ascertaining that the
person by whom it is made is able and willing there and then to do the whole of what he
is bound by his promise to do;
iii. if the offer is an offer to deliver anything to the promisee, the promisee must have
reasonable opportunity of seeing that the thing offered is the thing which the promisor
is bound by his promise to deliver.
An offer to one of several joint promisees has the same legal consequences as an offer to all of
them.

AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 95


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. APPROPRIATION OF PAYMENTS
Appropriation of payment means application of payment to a particular debt or debts where a debtor owes
several distinct debts to one person. The various rules are as under:

2.1 Where debt to be discharged is indicated [Section 59]


Where a debtor makes a payment with either express or implied intimation that the payment is to be applied to
the discharge of some particular debt, the payment, if accepted, must be applied accordingly.
 Example 15:
Azam owes to Babar, among other debts; the sum of Rs. 567. Babar writes to Azam and demands
payment of this sum. Azam sends to Babar Rs. 567. This payment is to be applied to the discharge
of the debt of which Babar had demanded payment.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 16:
Azam owes Babar, among other debts, Rs.1,000 related to invoice # 27, which falls due on the
first June. He owes Babar no other debt of that amount. On the first June, Azam pays to Babar
Rs.1,000. The payment is to be applied to the discharge of the invoice # 27.

2.2 Where debt to be discharged is not indicated [Section 60]


Where the debtor has omitted to intimate and there are no other circumstances indicating to which debt the
payment is to be applied, the creditor has option to apply the payment to any lawful debt due from the debtor
even if it is a time barred debt but he cannot apply the payment to a disputed debt.
 Example 17:
SPOTLIGHT

Azam owes several debts to Babar, one of them of Rs. 100,000 is time barred. Azam sends Rs.
200,000 to Babar without indicating the debt which is to be appropriated. Babar may appropriate
Rs. 100,000 against the time barred debt.

2.3 Neither party makes an appropriation [Section 61]


The payment shall be applied in discharge of the debts in order of time whether or not they are time barred. In
other words, all payments shall be applied towards the payment of first debt till it gets extinguished. Similarly,
all subsequent payments applied towards second debt till it gets fully paid and so on and so forth.
If the debts are of equal standing, the payment shall be applied in discharge of each, proportionately.
 Example 18:
STICKY NOTES

Azam owes Babar three debts, Rs. 150,000 (18 April), Rs. 300,000 (18 April) and Rs. 400,000 (25
April). Azam sends Rs. 90,000 to Babar on 20th May. It will be appropriated against the two debts
of 18 April proportionately, as Rs. 30,000 and Rs. 60,000.

2.4 When interest and principal both are due


As a general rule, if principal amount and mark-up both are due, then mark-up is settled first and then principal
amount is settled.
 Example 19:
Azam owes Rs. 100,000 as principal amount and Rs. 20,000 as interest. Azam sends Rs. 30,000
to Babar. Babar can apply Rs. 20,000 towards interest and Rs. 10,000 towards principal amount.

96 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

 Practice Question 03:


Following is the statement of sums payable by Nisar to Mairaj on 4 March 2017:

Date of invoice Rupees Remarks


01/01/2016 200,000 Guaranteed by Imran.
08/06/2016 150,000
350,000

Nisar sent a cheque for Rs. 100,000 on 5 March 2017. As there were no instructions from Nisar,
Mairaj adjusted the payment against the amount of Rs. 150,000. The guarantor (Imran) objected
to such appropriation and claimed that adjustment should be made in the order of the date of

AT A GLANCE
invoices. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 discuss whether the objection of Imran
is justified.
 Solution:
Imran’s objection is not valid. In the absence of any intimation from the debtor or circumstances
indicating to which debt payment is to be applied, the creditor is free to use his discretion and
apply it to any lawful debt actually due and payable to him from the debtor.
 Practice Question 04:
Following is the statement on August 4, 2011 of sums payable by Ubaid on account of cloth
supplied by Bilal:
Date of transaction Rupees Remarks

SPOTLIGHT
01/01/2008 37,000 Time barred under Limitation Act.
02/03/2009 20,000
30/08/2010 50,000 Guaranteed by Wasim.
28/04/2011 63,000
170,000
Ubaid sent a cheque for Rs. 70,000 on August 5, 2011. There being no instructions from Ubaid,
Bilal adjusted the payment against the following:

Date of transaction Rupees


01.1.2008 37,000

STICKY NOTES
02.3.2009 20,000
28.4.2011 13,000
70,000

The guarantor (Wasim) objected to such appropriation and claimed that since the amount of Rs.
37,000 was time barred, it should not be adjusted and the full amount guaranteed by him should
be fully adjusted.
a) Is the objection of Wasim valid?
b) Discuss how the above payment of Rs. 70,000 should be applied under each of the
following independent circumstances, according to the provisions of the Contract Act,
1872:
i. The following words were written on the back of the cheque: (20,000 + 50,000 =
70,000)
ii. No instructions about appropriation of payment were given by Ubaid. Bilal did not
make any appropriation either.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 97


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
Part (a)
The payment is correctly applied by Bilal and the objection of Wasim is not valid. In the absence
of any intimation from debtor or circumstances indicating to which debt payment is to be applied,
the creditor is free to use his discretion and apply it to any lawful debt actually due and payable
to him from the debtor whether its recovery is or is not barred by the law in force for the time
being as to the limitation of suits.
Part (b) (i)
The payment should be applied in discharging the following debts:

Debt of Rupees
AT A GLANCE

March 2, 2009 20,000


August 30, 2010 50,000
70,000

As Ubaid has written the break-up of payment at the back of the cheque, it implies that payment
should be applied to discharge those particular debts.
Part (b) (ii)
The payment should be applied in discharging the debts in the order in which they became due.
It is irrelevant whether the debts are or are not barred by the law in force for the time being as
to limitation of suits.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

98 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

3. CONTRACTS WHICH NEED NOT BE PERFORMED


A contract is said to be discharged either by performance or when contractual relations between the parties are
terminated or comes to an end otherwise, in which case it need not be performed.

3.1 Novation, rescission and alteration [Section 62]


If the parties to a contract agree to substitute a new contract for it, or to rescind or alter it, the original contract
need not be performed.
 Example 20:
Akram owes money to Bashir under a contract. It is agreed between Akram, Bashir and Shazim
that Bashir shall now accept Shazim as his debtor; instead of Akram. The old debt of Akram to
Bashir no longer exists and a new debt from Shazim to Bashir has been contracted.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 21:
Azam owes Babar Rs.10,000. Azam enters into an agreement with Babar, and gives Babar a
mortgage of his (Azam's) estate for Rs.5,000 in place of the debt of Rs. 10,000. This is a new
contract and extinguishes the old.
 Example 22:
Ajmal owes Boris Rs. 10,000 under a contract. Boris owes Chandra Rs. 10,000. Boris orders Ajmal
to credit Chandra with Rs. 10,000 in his books, but Chandra does not assent to the arrangement.
Boris still owes Chandra Rs. 10,000, and no new contract has been entered into.
 Example 23:

SPOTLIGHT
Asif promises Beenish to sell and deliver 500 Bales of cotton on 1st November at her warehouse
and Beenish promises to pay for goods on 1st December. Later Asif and Beenish mutually decide
not to perform the contract. Asif and Beenish need not perform the contract.
 Example 24:
Zahid promises to sell and deliver 500 bales of cotton, on 1st November and Yasir promises to
pay for goods on 1st December. Afterwards, Zahid and Yasir mutually decide that the goods shall
be delivered in five equal instalments at Zahid's warehouse. Now, the parties need not perform
the original contract and must perform the contract as altered.

3.2 Promisee may dispense with or remit performance [Section 63]

STICKY NOTES
A promisee may dispense with or remit, wholly or in part, the performance of the promise made to him, or may
extend the time for such performance, or may accept instead of it any satisfaction which he thinks fit.
 Example 25:
Adeel promises to paint a picture for Saleem. Saleem afterwards requested Adeel not to do so.
Adeel, if agreed is no longer bound to perform the promise.
 Example 26:
Azam owes Babar Rs. 5,000. Azam pays to Babar, and Babar accepts, in satisfaction of the whole
debt Rs. 2,000 paid at the time and place at which the Rs. 5,000 were payable. The whole debt is
discharged.
 Example 27:
Anum owes Bilal Rs.5,000. Sohail pays to Bilal Rs.1,000, and Bilal accepts the amount in
satisfaction of his claim on Anum. This payment is a discharge of the whole claim.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 99


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 28:
Ahmad owes Rizwan, under a contract, a sum of money, the amount of which has not been
ascertained. Ahmad, without ascertaining the amount, gives to Rizwan, and Rizwan, in
satisfaction thereof, accepts, the sum of Rs. 20,000. This is a discharge of the whole debt,
whatever may be its amount.
 Example 29:
Ashraf owes Habib Rs. 20,000, and is also indebted to other creditors. Ashraf makes an
arrangement with his creditors, including Habib, to pay them a composition of 50% upon their
respective demands. Payment to be of Rs. 10,000 is a discharge of Habib’s demand.

3.3 Promisee refusal or neglect [Section 67]


AT A GLANCE

If any promisee neglects or refuses to afford the promisor reasonable facilities for the performance of his
promise, the promisor is excused by such neglect or refusal as to any non-performance caused.
 Example 30:
Adeel contracts with Sajid to repair Sajid’s house. Sajid neglects or refuses to point out to Adeel
the places in which his house requires repair. Adeel is excused for the non-performance of the
contract caused by such neglect or refusal.

3.4 Impossible acts [Section 56]

3.4.1 Void agreement


An agreement to do an act impossible in itself is void.
SPOTLIGHT

 Example 31:
Arslan agrees with Habib to discover treasure by magic. The agreement is void.

3.4.2 Subsequent impossibility or illegality


A contract to do an act which, after the contract is made, becomes impossible, or, by reason of some event which
the promisor could not prevent, unlawful, becomes void when the act becomes impossible or unlawful.
The following are acceptable grounds of supervening impossibility:
a) Destruction of subject matter.
b) Death or personal incapacity in contracts of personal nature.
STICKY NOTES

c) Declaration of war making it impossible to perform the contract.


d) The particular state of things cease to exist or occur which form the basis of contract.
 Example 32:
A music hall was rented out for a series of concerts. The hall caught fire before the date of first
concert. It was held, the contract has become void on the ground of supervening impossibility.
 Example 33:
Atif agreed to sing on a specified day. Atif fell seriously ill and could not perform on that day. The
contract was discharged.
 Example 34:
Zahid contracts to take in cargo for Yasir at a foreign port. Zahid's government afterwards
declares war against the country in which the port is situated. The contract becomes void when
the war is declared.

100 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

 Example 35:
Alex and Boris contract to marry each other. Before the time fixed for the marriage, Alex goes
mad. The contract becomes void.
The following are not an acceptable excuse from performance on account of supervening impossibility:
a) The performance of contract becoming difficult, more costly or less beneficial than that agreed at the
time of its formation.
b) The contract becomes commercially unviable.
c) There is default by third party, on whose work the promisor was relying.
d) Strikes, lockouts and civil disturbances.
e) Partial impossibility of some of the objects of the contract.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 36:
Asim agreed to supply gold within a specified time. He failed to supply in time because of
government's restriction on the transport of gold from collieries. Here Asim will not be
discharged because the gold was available in the open market from where Asim could have
obtained it.
 Example 37:
Ajay, a furniture retailer, agreed to supply certain furniture to Sanjay at an agreed rate.
Afterwards, there was a sharp increase in the rates of the timber and rates of wages. Since, it was
no longer profitable to supply at the agreed rate, Ajay did not supply. Ajay will not be discharged
on the ground of supervening impossibility.

SPOTLIGHT
 Example 38:
Alex entered into a contract with Boris for the sale of goods to be manufactured by Catherine, a
manufacturer of those goods. Catherine did not manufacture those goods. Alex will not be
discharged and will be liable to Boris for damages.
 Example 39:
Austin agreed to supply to Bashir certain goods to be imported from America. The goods could
not be imported due to riots in that country. It was held that this was no, excuse for non-
performance of the contract.
 Example 40:

STICKY NOTES
HB agreed to let out a boat to Harry (a) for viewing a naval review of on the occasion of coronation
of King Edward VII, and (b) to sail around the fleet. Owing to the King’s illness, the naval review
was abandoned but the fleet was assembled. The boat, therefore, could be used to sail around the
fleet. Held, the contract was not discharged.

3.4.3 Compensation in certain circumstances


Where one person has promised to do something which he knew, or, with reasonable diligence, might have
known, and which the promisee did not know to be impossible or unlawful, such promisor must make
compensation to such promisee for any loss which such promisee sustains through the non-performance of the
promise.
 Example 41:
Ashvin contracts to marry Bipasha, being already married to Champakali, and being forbidden
by the law to which he is subject to practise polygamy. Ashvin must make compensation to
Bipasha for the loss caused to her by the non-performance of his promise.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 101


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3.5 Consequences of rescission of voidable contract [Section 64 & 66]


The rescission of a voidable contract may be communicated or revoked in the same manner, and subject to the
same rules, as apply to the communication or revocation of a proposal.
When a person at whose option a contract is voidable rescinds it, the other party thereto need not perform any
promise therein contained in which he is promisor. The party rescinding a voidable contract shall if he have
received any benefit there under from another party to such contract, restore such benefit, so far as may be, to
the person from whom it was received.
 Example 42:
Jameel employed coercion on Talat to sell his goods to Talat above market price. Jameel also
delivered the goods and payment is due on Talat. Later, Talat proved in court of law that coercion
was employed and rescinded the contract. Talat must also return the goods to Jameel.
AT A GLANCE

3.6 Advantage received under void agreement or void contract [Section 65]
When an agreement is discovered to be void, or when a contract becomes void, any person who has received any
advantage under such agreement or contract is bound to restore it, or to make compensation for it to the person
from whom he received it.
 Example 43:
Azam pays Basit Rs. 100,000 in consideration of Basit’s promising to marry Chanda, Azam’s
daughter. Chanda is dead at the time of the promise. The agreement is void, but Basit must repay
Azam the Rs. 100,000.
 Example 44:
SPOTLIGHT

Adeel contracts with Babar to deliver to him 250 kg of rice before the first of May. Adeel delivers
130 kg only before that day, and none after. Babar retains the 130 kg after the first of May. He is
bound to pay Adeel for them.
 Example 45:
Alia, a singer, contracts with Bisma, the manager of a theatre, to sing at her theatre for two nights
in every week during the next two months, and Bisma engages to pay her Rs. 10,000 for each
night’s performance. On the sixth night, Alia wilfully absents herself from the theatre, and Bisma,
in consequence, rescinds the contract. Bisma must pay Alia for the five nights on which she had
sung.
 Example 46:
STICKY NOTES

Atif contracts to sing for Bilal at a concert for Rs. 1 million, which are paid in advance. Atif is too
ill to sing. Atif is not bound to make compensation to Bilal for the loss of the profits which Bilal
would have made if Atif had been able to sing, but must refund to Bilal the Rs. 1 million paid in
advance.
 Practice Question 05:
What is meant by discharge of a contract? Briefly describe the modes of discharging a contract
by act of parties to the contract under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872.
 Solution:
A contract is said to be discharged either by performance or when contractual relations between
the parties are terminated or comes to an end otherwise, in which case it need not be performed.
If the parties to a contract agree to substitute a new contract for it, or to rescind or alter it, the
original contract need not be performed.

102 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

A promisee may dispense with or remit, wholly or in part, the performance of the promise made
to him, or may extend the time for such performance, or may accept instead of it any satisfaction
which he thinks fit.
If any promisee neglects or refuses to afford the promisor reasonable facilities for the
performance of his promise, the promisor is excused by such neglect or refusal as to any non-
performance caused.
 Practice Question 06:
Talib was indebted to Bashir for Rs. 10,000. On Talib’s request Bashir agreed to accept Jahangir
as his debtor, in place of Talib. Jahangir failed to make payment on due date. Under the provisions
of Contract Act, 1872 you are required to explain whether Bashir can now demand payment from
Talib.

AT A GLANCE
 Solution:
If the parties to a contract agree to substitute a new contract for it, the original contract need not
be performed.
Since Bashir accepted Jahangir as his debtor in place of Talib, so now he cannot demand payment
from Talib. Consent of all the parties is essential.
 Practice Question 07:
Lalchi Traders agreed to supply cotton yarn to Farzi Textile Limited at a fixed price for one year.
Three months after the formation of the contract the price of yarn increased sharply, making it
commercially unviable for Lalchi Traders to continue the supply at the agreed price. Therefore,
they terminated the contract on the ground of difficulty/impossibility of performance.

SPOTLIGHT
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 briefly describe:
i. whether the contract would be discharged under the above circumstances.
ii. what would be your decision if Lalchi Traders were importing yarn and Government has
imposed a ban on its import.
 Solution:
i. A contract to do an act which, after the contract is made, becomes impossible, or, by
reason of some event which the promisor could not prevent, becomes void when the act
becomes impossible, or unlawful.
However, events that make the contract extremely more difficult, costly or less beneficial

STICKY NOTES
or commercially unviable or non-profitable then that agreed at the time of its formation,
but not impossible, are not accepted as an excuse for non-performance.
Therefore, in the given scenario, Lalchi Traders pleas shall not be acceptable and in the
event of non-performance they will be held liable for the breach of contract and the
consequential damages.
ii. A contract is discharged, if after its formation, a law or regulation is adopted that makes
performance impossible/ illegal. Therefore, due to the imposition of ban on the import
of yarn by the Government, Lalchi Traders would be discharged from their liability to
perform the contract.
 Practice Question 08:
Imran Traders entered into a one-year contract with Minhas Oils Limited for the supply of gravels
for their extraction project in Badin at a fixed price of Rs. 30,000 per dumper. Six months after
the contract, the diesel prices increased sharply, making it non-profitable for Imran Traders to
continue the supply at the agreed price. Therefore, they terminated the contract on the ground
of impossibility of performance. Describe whether the contract is discharged in the above
situation.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 103


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
A contract to do an act which, after the contract is made, becomes impossible, or, by reason of
some event which the promisor could not prevent, becomes void when the act becomes
impossible, or unlawful.
However, events that make the contract extremely difficult, costly or less beneficial or
commercially unviable or non-profitable then that agreed at the time of its formation, but not
impossible, are not accepted as an excuse for non-performance.
Therefore, in the given scenario, Imran Traders excuses shall not be acceptable and in the event
of non-performance they will be held liable for the breach of contract and the consequential
damages.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

104 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

4. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Contract is said to be performed when
(a) One party fulfils his promise
(b) Both promisors perform their respective promises
(c) Law dispenses with performance
(d) One of the promisor makes attempted performance

02. Valid tender requires


(a) To be unconditional

AT A GLANCE
(b) To be made at proper place and time
(c) To be made for whole quantity / obligation
(d) All of the above factors

03. Mr. A agrees to supply 100 bags of tea to Mr. B @ Rs.1000/- per Bag on a particular date. Mr. B was to
pay subsequently after the supply of tea. On due date Mr. A supplies tea and Mr. B makes payment. But,
if on due date, Mr. A takes the contracted quantity of tea to Mr. B’s warehouse and Mr. B refuses to accept
the delivery. State the legal position.
(a) 1st case is attempted performance and 2nd is voidable contract
(b) 1st case is voidable contract and 2nd is attempted performance

SPOTLIGHT
(c) 1st case is actual performance and 2nd is attempted performance
(d) 1st case is attempted performance and 2nd is actual performance

04. Payment received by the creditor must be appropriated for discharging debt
(a) Which has been borrowed at last
(b) According to instruction given by the debtor
(c) In a logical sequence of the debts
(d) Which has been borrowed at first

STICKY NOTES
05. Mr. X promises to sell standing timber to Mr. Y. As per the terms of a contract Mr. X will cut and cord the
timber, whereupon Mr. Y will take it away and pay for it. Mr. X cords only a part of timber and neglects
to cord the rest. Mr. Y wants to initiate legal proceedings. Suggest him the legal action.
(a) Mr. Y may avoid contract
(b) Mr. Y may claim compensation from Mr. X
(c) Mr. Y does not have any legal remedy
(d) Mr. Y may avoid the contract and claim compensation from Mr. X

06. Mr. Karam owes several debts to Mr. Karim, which are of distinct amount and payable on different dates.
One of the debts has become time-barred which Mr. Karim cannot legally recover from Mr. Karam. On a
particular date Mr. Karam makes a payment, but does not give any instruction. State the legal position
with regard to the appropriation of payment.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 105


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

(a) Mr. Karim has no right to apply this payment for time-barred debt
(b) Mr. Karam’s instruction has to be followed
(c) Mr. Karim has to obtain court’s advice
(d) Mr. Karim has a right to apply this payment for time-barred debt

07. Contract is said to be discharged (not needed to be performed) by mutual agreement when:
(a) Change in a contract is made without free consent of the parties
(b) Change in a contract is made by one of the parties
(c) Old contract is substituted by new contract
(d) New contract is substituted by old one
AT A GLANCE

08. Mr. A agreed to supply 100 tonnes of iron-ore to Mr. B on 1st January. On the due date of supply he took
stipulated quantity of iron-ore to Mr. B’s Residence at 12:00 am. This is the case of attempted
performance. This offer of performance or attempted performance is
(a) Valid because the promisor is fulfilling the terms of the contract
(b) Invalid because the place and time of supply is not reasonable
(c) Valid because the performance is unconditional
(d) Invalid because the time of supply is not reasonable
SPOTLIGHT

09. Acceptance of lesser performance by promisee is


(a) Void
(b) Invalid
(c) Valid
(d) Not allowed

10. Remission means


(a) Giving up some rights in favour of promisor
(b) Acceptance of a lesser performance than due in contract
STICKY NOTES

(c) Avoidance of contract by one party


(d) Avoidance of contract by both the parties

11. Mr. A entered to an agreement with Mr. B for selling 100 tonnes of wheat at specified price to him on
15th March. But, before the due date of delivery the President of Pakistan has passed an Ordinance,
debarring the individuals from supplying more than 5 tonnes of wheat. State the legal position of the
contract between Mr. A and Mr. B.
(a) The contract between Mr. A and Mr. B comes to an end because its performance has becomes
unlawful.
(b) The contract between Mr. A and Mr. B comes to an end because the subject matter of the contract
is destroyed.
(c) The contract between Mr. A and Mr. B comes to an end because of the personal incapacity of the
party.
(d) The contract between Mr. A and Mr. B comes to an end because certain state of things gets changed.

106 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

12. Contract will not be discharged on account of supervening impossibility in case of:
(a) Change in law
(b) Death of promisor in the contract of personal nature
(c) Failure of third party relied upon by the promisor
(d) Non-existence of particular state of thing essential for the performance of a contract

13. Supervening impossibility means


(a) Subsequent impossibility
(b) Initial impossibility

AT A GLANCE
(c) Irrelevant impossibility
(d) Relevant impossibility

14. Which of the following statement is true


(a) Partial impossibility does not invalidate a contract
(b) Impossibilities due to conduct of third party will discharge contract
(c) Commercial impossibility affects validity of a contract
(d) Difficulty in performance is a valid ground of supervening impossibility

SPOTLIGHT
15. Mr. H hired a room in some hotel of Lahore to witness PSL Final Match on 22nd March but due to the
emergency declared by government in the wake of Pandemic Coronavirus, the match was cancelled.
Examine the legality of this contract
(a) Mr. H is liable to pay the rent to the hotel
(b) Mr. H is excused from the obligation of paying rent to the hotel
(c) Mr. H is liable to pay the rent along with interest
(d) Mr. H is excused from the obligation due to the personal incapacity

16. The contract is a mutual exchange of promises between two parties when both the promisor do what

STICKY NOTES
they have promised to do, the contract is set to be performed and contract comes to an end. Performance
of contract may be of two types
(a) Legal performance and illegal performance
(b) Conditional performance and unconditional performance
(c) Attempted performance and offer of performance
(d) Actual performance and attempted performance

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 107


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (b) Both promisors perform their respective promises. After having made promises, the
parties are legally bound to fulfil what they have promised to perform.
02. (d) Tender must be unconditional, be made at proper place and time and be made for whole
quantity.
03. (c) 1st case is actual performance and 2nd is attempted performance. Under both ways of
performance, the promisors get released from their obligations in that contract and the
contract comes to an end.
04. (b) According to instruction given by the debtor. In such case appropriation must be made
according to those instructions given by the debtor.
AT A GLANCE

05. (d) Mr. Y may avoid the contract and claim compensation from Mr. X. if one party prevents
another from performing a promise the contract becomes voidable at the option of the
party so prevented. He can also claim compensation
06. (d) Mr. Karim has a right to apply this payment for time-barred debt. When the debtor does
not give any instruction, the creditor has a discretion to apply such payment for
discharging any lawful debt even for time barred debt
07. (c) A contract is formed when the parties are mutually agreed. In a same way both the parties
of a contract by mutual agreement can discharge that contract.
08. (b) Attempted performance to be legally effective, must be made within usual business hours
and at a reasonable place.
SPOTLIGHT

09. (c) Remission means accepting a less amount than the initial amount agreed
10. (b) Acceptance of a lesser performance than due in contract. Sometimes, the promisor may
perform only a part of his promise and promisee accepts it for the performance of the
whole promise.
11. (a) The contract between Mr. A and Mr. B comes to an end because its performance has
becomes unlawful. Change of law, after the formation of a contract, if renders performance
of contract unlawful, such contract is discharged.
12. (c) Failure of third party or his inability will not be considered sufficient ground for
discharging a contract.
13. (a) When a contract is valid at the time of formation and becomes impossible to perform
STICKY NOTES

subsequently it is called effected by supervening impossibility


14. (a) The contract may be made for achieving more than one objectives. In case one object fails,
contract will not be discharged.
15. (b) Mr. H is excused from the obligation of paying rent to the hotel. The contract cannot be
performed due to the reasons beyond the control of both parties.
16. (d) Actual performance and attempted performance. When both the promisor do what they
have promised to do, the contract is set to be performed

108 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I

STICKY NOTES

Types of Performance
1. Actual 2. Attempted (tender)

Essentials of valid tender of performance


1. Unconditional
2. Proper time

AT A GLANCE
3. Proper place
4. Reasonable opportunity of inspection
5. Reasonable opportunity to ascertain cicumstances of perforamnce

Appropriation of payments (rules to be applied in order)


1. As indicated by the debtor
2. As may be allocated by the creditor

SPOTLIGHT
3. In order of time (for equal standing debts, proportionately)
Allocate the amount to interest first and then remaining (if any) to principal amount.

Circumstances when contract need not be performed


1. When it has been rescinded, altered or substituted with a new contract.
2. When the promisee dispenses with or remits performance.
3. When promisee neglects to afford promisor reasonable facilities for
performance.

STICKY NOTES
4. When performance becomes, afterwards, impossible or unlawful.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 109


CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-I CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

110 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 7

PERFORMANCE OF
CONTRACTS-II

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER: The contract must be performed by the promisor himself only
when it is the intention of the parties. In other cases, contract
AT A GLANCE may be performed by promisor himself, by his legal
representatives (in case of death) or they may employ a
SPOTLIGHT competent person to perform it.
1. By Whom Contracts must be It is only the promisee, and in case of his death, his legal
Performed representatives, who can demand performance. In case of
several joint promisee, all of them (or legal representatives in
2. Time and Place for case of death) jointly can demand performance.
Perfromance Time and place of performance of a contract are matters to be
determined by agreement between the parties themselves.

SPOTLIGHT
3. Performance of Reciprocal Where no time for performance is specified, the promisor must
Promises perform the promise within a reasonable time. If no time and
place is fixed for the performance of the promise, the promisor
4. Objective Based Q&A must apply to the promisee to fix the day and time for
performance.
STICKY NOTES
Time for the performance of a contract may be fixed in the
contract itself. In that case the contract must be performed
within that time when time is of the essence of contract.
Promises which form the consideration or part of the
consideration for each other are called ‘reciprocal promises’.
The reciprocal promises must be performed in the order fixed

STICKY NOTES
by the contract. When reciprocal promises have to be
simultaneously performed, the promisor is not bound to
perform unless the promisee is ready and willing to perform his
promise.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 111


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. BY WHOM CONTRACTS MUST BE PERFORMED


1.1 Person by whom promise is to be performed
1.1.1 Promisor himself [Section 40]
If it appears from the nature of the case that it was the intention of the parties to any contract that any promise
contained, in it should be performed by the promisor himself, such promise must be performed by the promisor
himself only.
 Example 01:
Arif promises to marry Bisma, Arif must perform this promise personally.
 Example 02:
AT A GLANCE

Azam promises to paint a picture for Babar, Azam must perform the promise personally.

1.1.2 Legal representative [Section 37]


Promises bind the representatives of the promisors in case of the death of such promisors before performance
unless a contrary intention appears from the contract. The liability of legal representatives is limited to the
amount of estate of the deceased.
 Example 03:
Azam promises to deliver goods to Babar on a certain day on payment of Rs. 1,000. Azam dies
before that day. Azam’s representatives are bound to deliver the goods to Babar and Babar is
bound to pay Rs. 1,000 to Azam’s representatives.
 Example 04:
SPOTLIGHT

Azam promises to marry Bushra. Azam dies. Azam’s legal representatives cannot perform this
promise being a contract of personal nature.

1.1.3 Other competent person [Section 40]


In other case, the promisor or his representatives may employ a competent person to perform it.
 Example 05:
Azam promises to pay Babar a sum of money. Azam may perform this promise either by
personally paying the money to Babar, or by causing it to be paid to Babar by another, and if
Azam dies before the time appointed for payment, his representatives must perform the promise,
STICKY NOTES

or employ some proper person to do so.

1.1.4 Effect of accepting performance from third person [Section 41]


When a promisee accepts performance of the promise from a third person, he cannot afterwards enforce it
against the promisor.
 Example 06:
Kamran borrows Rs. 200,000 from Babar and promises to repay within a month. Akmal, the
father of Kamran, pays Rs. 200,000 to Babar. Kamran is discharged from his liability.

1.1.5 Devolution of Joint liabilities [Section 42]


Unless a contrary intention appears, in case of several promisor the following persons must perform the promise:
 All the promisors jointly in case of all the promisors are alive
 Representatives of the deceased promisor jointly with the surviving promisor(s) in case of death of any
of the joint promisors
 Representatives of all of them jointly in case of death of all joint promisors.

112 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

 Example 07:
Azam and Babar jointly promise to repay a loan of Rs.10,000 on a specified day. Azam dies before
that specified day. Azam's representative jointly with Babar must perform the promise on the
specified day.
 Example 08:
Aslam, Bashir and Sahil jointly promise to pay Rs. 3,000 to Dawood. Aslam, Bashir and Sahil must
contribute Rs. 1,000 each. If Aslam dies, then legal representative of Aslam are liable to pay Rs.
1,000 along with Bashir and Sahil.
1.2 Rules regarding performance of joint promises
1.2.1 Joint and several liability[Section 43]

AT A GLANCE
When two or more persons make a joint promise, the promisee may, in the absence of express agreement to the
contrary, compel any one or more of such joint promisors to perform the whole of the promise.
 Example 09:
Azam, Babar and Saqlain jointly promise to pay Dawar Rs. 3,000. Dawar may compel either Azam
or Babar or Saqlain to pay him Rs. 3,000.
1.2.2 Right to claim contribution [Section 43]
Each of two or more joint promisors may compel every other joint promisor to contribute equally with himself
to the performance of the promise unless a contrary intention appears from the contract.
 Example 10:
Azam, Babar and Saqlain jointly promise to pay Dawar a sum of Rs. 3,000. Saqlain is compelled

SPOTLIGHT
to pay the whole. Azam is insolvent, but his assets are sufficient to pay one-half of his debts.
Saqlain is entitled to receive Rs.500 from Azam's estate and Rs.1,250 from Babar.
1.2.3 Sharing of loss by default in contribution [Section 43]
If any one of two or more joint promisors makes default in such contribution, the remaining joint promisors must
bear the loss arising from such default in equal shares.
 Example 11:
Azam, Babar and Saqlain are under a joint promise to pay Dawar Rs.3,000. Saqlain is unable to
pay anything and Azam is compelled to pay the whole. Azam is entitled to receive Rs.1,500 from
Babar.

STICKY NOTES
1.2.4 Effect of release of one joint promisor [Section 44]
Where two or more persons have made a joint promise, a release of one of such joint promisors by the promisee
does not discharge the other joint promisor or joint promisors; neither does it free the joint promisors so
released from responsibility to the other joint promisor or joint promisors.
 Example 12:
Azam, Babar and Saqlain jointly promise to pay Dawar Rs.3,000. Dawar releases Azam from his
liability and sues Babar and Saqlain for payment, Here, neither Babar and Saqlain are released
from their liability to Dawar nor is Azam released from his liability to Babar and Saqlain for
contribution.
1.2.5 Devolution of joint rights [Section 45]
When a person has made a promise to two or more per sons jointly, then, unless contrary intention appears from
the contract, the right to claim performance rests, as between him and them, with them during their joint lives,
and, after the death of any of them, with the representative of such deceased person jointly with the survivor or
survivors, and, after the death of the last survivor, with the representatives of all jointly.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 113


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 13:
Azam, in consideration of Rs.5,000 lent to him by Babar and Saqlain, promises Babar and Saqlain
jointly to repay them that sum with interest on a day specified. Babar dies. The right to claim
performance rests with Babar's representative jointly with Saqlain during Saqlain's life, and,
after the death of Saqlain, with the representatives of Babar and Saqlain jointly.
 Practice Question 01:
Binyamin borrowed Rs. 1 million from Hatim and Tahir jointly and promised to repay the amount
on March 1, 2011. With reference to the Contract Act, 1872, state who can claim performance in
the following situations.
a) Both Hatim and Tahir are alive on due date
b) Hatim dies before due date
AT A GLANCE

c) Both Hatim and Tahir die before the due date


 Solution:
Unless a contrary intention appears from the contract, the right to claim performance rests:
a) with Hatim and Tahir jointly
b) after the death of Hatim, with the representative of Hatim jointly with Tahir
c) after the death of both Hatim and Tahir, with the representative(s) of both, jointly.
 Practice Question 02:
Sohail and Afaq lent Rs. 2.0 million to Mohsin, Laila and Faizan jointly. On due date Laila became
SPOTLIGHT

insolvent. Without informing Sohail, Afaq wants Mohsin to repay the full amount to him. Under
the provisions of Contract Act, 1872 explain:
a) whether Mohsin can be compelled to pay the full amount to Afaq; and
b) what rights are available to Mohsin if he repays the full amount.
 Solution:
Part (a)
Afaq alone cannot compel Mohsin to make payment unless a contrary intention appears from the
contract. The right to claim performance rests with all the promisees jointly and a single
promisee cannot demand performance.
STICKY NOTES

Part (b)
Mohsin may compel every other joint promisor to contribute equally with himself to the
performance of the promise unless a contrary intention appears from the contract.
Therefore, Faizan must share the loss arising from default of Laila equally with Mohsin.
 Practice Question 03:
Faheem, Saleem and Jameel jointly borrowed Rs. 50 million for a business project from a common
friend Kamal. They jointly promised to repay the borrowed amount. Under the provisions of the
Contract Act, 1872 comment on the following:
a) in the absence of express agreement, what would be the rights and liabilities of joint
promisors. Also explain their rights and liabilities if Kamal releases Jameel from the joint
liability.
b) how the liability would devolve in case of death of one or more of the joint promisor.

114 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

 Solution:
Part (a) Any one of Joint promisors may be compelled to perform
In absence of express agreement to the contrary, Faheem, Saleem and Jameel are jointly liable to
fulfil the promise. However, Kamal, may compel anyone (Faheem/Saleem/Jameel) or more of
them to perform whole of the promise.
Each joint promisor (Faheem/Saleem/Jameel) may compel every other joint promisor to
contribute equally with himself to the performance of the promise. If anyone of joint promisor
(Faheem/Saleem/Jameel) or more of them makes default in such contribution, the remaining
joint promisors must bear the loss arising from such default in equal share.
Effect of release of one joint promisor
If Kamal releases Jameel, it will not discharge the other joint promisors Faheem and Saleem;

AT A GLANCE
neither would it free Jameel from responsibility to Faheem and Saleem.
Part (b) Devolution of Joint Liabilities
In case of death of one or more of joint promisors, the liability would devolve as follows:
i. to representatives of the deceased promisor jointly with the surviving promisor(s) in
case of death of any of the joint promisors; and
ii. to representatives of all of them jointly in case of death of all joint promisors.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 115


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. TIME AND PLACE FOR PERFORMANCE


2.1 Rules regarding time and place of performance
The various rules regarding the time and place of performance are given below:

2.1.1 No time specified and no application to be made [Section 46]

Circumstances No time for performance is specified; and


The promisor is to perform his promise without application by the promisee.
Rule of performance The promise must be performed within a reasonable time. The question “what is a
reasonable time” is, in each particular case, a question of fact.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 14:
Hamid ordered a large flag to celebrate Independence Day but did not specify the time for
performance. The flag must be delivered before the Independence Day.

2.1.2 Certain day specified and no application to be made [Section 47]

Circumstances Promise is to be performed on a certain day; and


The promisor has undertaken to perform it without application by the promisee.
Rule of performance The promisor may perform it at any time during the usual hours of business on
such day and at the place at which the promise ought to be performed.

 Example 15:
SPOTLIGHT

Azam promises to deliver goods at Babar’s warehouse on 1st January. Azam brings the goods to
Babar’s warehouse but after the usual hour of business. Thus, the goods are not received. Azam
has not performed his promise.

2.1.3 Certain day specified and application to be made [Section 48]

Circumstances Promise is to be performed on a certain day; and


The promisor has not undertaken to perform it without application by the
promisee.
Rule of performance It is the duty of the promisee to apply for performance at a proper place and within
STICKY NOTES

the usual hours of business. The question “what is a proper time and place” is, in
each particular case a question of fact.

 Example 16:
Adeel ordered decorations to be installed on 17th August on occasion of his daughter’s birthday.
Adeel must apply for performance and specify proper time and place for the decorations to be
installed.

2.1.4 No place fixed and no application to be made [Section 49]

Circumstances No place is fixed for the performance; and


The promise is to be performed without application by the promisee.

Rule of performance It is the duty of the promisor to apply to the promisee to appoint a reasonable place
for the performance of the promise, and to perform it at such place.

116 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

 Example 17:
Adeel undertakes to deliver 1,000 kg of rice to Bilal on a fixed day. Adeel must apply to Bilal to
appoint a reasonable place for the purpose of receiving it, and must deliver it to him at such place.

2.1.5 Prescribed or sanction by promisee [Section 50]

Circumstances The manner or time prescribed or sanctioned by the promisee


Rule of performance The promise should be made in the manner and at the time which the promisee
prescribes or sanctions.

 Example 18:
Azam and Babar are mutually indebted. Azam and Babar settle an account by setting off one item

AT A GLANCE
against another, and Babar pays Azam the balance found to be due from him upon such
settlement. This amounts to payment by Azam and Babar, respectively, of the sums which they
owed to each other.
 Example 19:
Azam owes Babar Rs. 2,000. Babar accepts some of Azam's goods in reduction of the debt. The
delivery of the goods operates as a part payment.
 Example 20:
Azam desires Babar, who owes him Rs. 100, to send him a cheque for Rs.100 by post. The debt is
discharged as soon as Babar posts a letter containing the cheque duly addressed to Azam.
 Example 21:

SPOTLIGHT
Bilal owes Ameen Rs. 2,000. Ameen desires Bilal to pay the amount to Ameen’s account with XYZ
Bank. Bilal, who also banks with XYZ Bank, orders the amount to be transferred from his account
to Ameen’s credit, and this is done by XYZ Bank. Afterwards, and before Ameen knows of the
transfer, XYZ Bank fails and Ameen cannot get anything from his account. There has been a good
payment by Bilal.

2.2 Failure to perform at fixed time [Section 55]

2.2.1 When time is essential?


The time is essential to a contract if the intention of parties (expressed or implied) was that time should be of
essence of the contract.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 22:
Adeel ordered Yum Bakers for a Birthday cake to be delivered on 22nd February. The nature of
transaction clearly indicates that time is the essence of the contract.

2.2.2 Effect of failure to perform at fixed time, when time is essential


In case the performance is not made within or at time fixed and time is essence, the contract (or so much of it as
remains unperformed) becomes voidable at the option of the promisee. He may rescind the contract and sue for
the breach caused by non-performance.
 Example 23:
Azam agreed to deliver 20 books to Babar on 12th May 2011 in which delivery time was
important as books were required for an exhibition. Azam failed to deliver by that time. The
contract is voidable at the option of Babar.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 117


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2.2.3 Effect of failure to perform at fixed time, when time is not essential
In case the performance is not made within or at time fixed and time is not essence, the contract is not voidable
at the option of promisee but the promisee is entitled to compensation from the promisor for any loss occasioned
to him by such failure.
 Example 24:
Azam promises to deliver a car to Babar on 1st May, the time not being essential. Azam delivers
it on 9th May. Babar will have to accept the delivery but he can claim damages.

2.2.4 Effect of acceptance of delayed performance


If, in case of a contract voidable on account of the promisor’s failure to perform his promise at the time agreed,
the promisee accepts performance of such promise at any time other than that agreed, the promisee cannot claim
AT A GLANCE

compensation for any loss occasioned by the non-performance of the promise at the time agreed, unless, at the
time of such acceptance he gives notice to the promisor of his intention to do so.
 Example 25:
Mahad promised to supply bricks to Nadeem on 4th May. Mahad delivers on 8th May. Nadeem
accepts the delayed delivery while clearly stating his intention to claim compensation for the
delay. Nadeem can claim damages.
 Example 26:
Mahad promised to supply bricks to Nadeem on 4th May. Mahad delivers on 8th May. Nadeem
accepts the delayed delivery and did not give any indication as to claiming compensation for the
delay. Later, Nadeem cannot claim damages.
SPOTLIGHT

 Practice Question 04:


Golden Foods (GF) agreed to supply 2,500 cans to Riaz Grocery Stores (RGS). According to the
agreement, the date of delivery was 31 August 2017. However, on the due date GF refused to
supply the cans.
a) Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 discuss the rights of RGS in the above
situation assuming that time was the essence of the contract.
b) What would be your answer to (a) above, if GF supplied the cans on 12 September 2017
and RGS accepted the performance; but suffered a loss on account of delayed supply?
 Solution:
STICKY NOTES

Part (a) Rights when time is essence of the contract


Time being essence of the contract, following would be the rights of Riaz Grocery Stores (RGS)
under the circumstances:
i. Contract would be voidable at the option of RGS (promisee);
ii. RGS may insist that Golden Foods (GF) should deliver the product and to claim
compensation on account of the delayed supply;
iii. RGS may decide not to accept performance beyond the stipulated time and claim
compensation for any damages which it may have sustained due to non-fulfilment of the
contract by GF.
Part (b) Effect of acceptance of performance at a time other than that agreed upon:
Riaz Grocery Stores (RGS) is not entitled to claim compensation for any damages which it may
have sustained through the non-fulfilment of the contract where performance beyond the
stipulated time is accepted, unless at the time of acceptance RGS gives notice to GF of its intention
to claim damages.

118 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

3. PERFORMANCE OF RECIPROCAL PROMISES


3.1 Definition [Section 2(f)]
Promises which form the consideration or part of the consideration for each other are called 'reciprocal
promises'.
 Example 27:
In a contract for sale, Azam promises to deliver the goods to Babar at a fixed price and Babar
promises to give promise for the payment of the price. Such promises are called reciprocal
promises.

3.2 When promisor is not bound to perform [Section 51]

AT A GLANCE
When a contract consists of reciprocal promises to be simultaneously performed, no promisor need perform his
promise unless the promisee is ready and willing to perform his reciprocal promise.
 Example 28:
Azam and Babar contract that Azam shall deliver goods to Babar to be paid for by Babar on
delivery. Azam needs not deliver the goods unless Babar is ready and willing to pay for the goods
on delivery. Babar needs not pay for the goods, unless Azam is ready and willing to deliver them
on payment.
 Example 29:
Azam and Babar contract that Azam shall deliver goods to Babar at a price to be paid in
instalments, the first instalment to be paid on delivery. Azam need not deliver unless Babar is
ready and willing to pay the first instalment on delivery. Babar needs not pay the first instalment,

SPOTLIGHT
unless Azam is ready and willing to deliver the goods on payment of the first instalment.

3.3 Order of performance [Section 52]


Where the order in which reciprocal promises are to be performed is expressly fixed by the contract, they shall
be performed in that order; and, where the order is not expressly fixed by the contract, they shall be performed
in that order which the nature of the transaction requires.
 Example 30:
Azam and Babar contract that Azam shall build a house for Babar at a fixed price. Azam's promise
to build the house must be performed before Babar's promise to pay for it.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 31:
Azam and Babar contract that Azam shall make delivery of his stock-in-trade to Babar at a fixed
price, and Babar promises to give security for the payment of the money. Azam's promise need
not be performed until the security is given, because the nature of the transaction requires that
Azam should have security before he delivers up his stock.

3.4 Liability of party preventing the performance [Section 53]


When a contract contains reciprocal promises, and one party to the contract prevents the other from performing
his promise, the contract becomes voidable at the option of the party so prevented ; and he is entitled to
compensation from the other party for any loss which he may sustain in consequence of the non-performance of
the contract.
 Example 32:
Azam and Babar contract that Babar shall execute certain work for Azam, for Rs.1,000. Babar is
ready and willing to execute the work accordingly, but Azam prevents him from doing so. The
contract is voidable at the option of Babar; and, if he elects to rescind it, he is entitled to recover
from Azam compensation for any loss which he has incurred by its non-performance.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 119


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3.5 Effect of default of promise which should be first performed [Section 54]
When a contract consists of reciprocal promises, such that one of them cannot be performed, or that its
performance cannot be claimed till the other has been performed, and the promisor of the promise last
mentioned fails to perform it, such promisor cannot claim the performance of the reciprocal promise, and must
make compensation to the other party to the contract for any loss which such other party may sustain by the
non-performance of the contract.
 Example 33:
Ajmal hires Bilal’s ship to take in and convey, from Karachi to Mauritius, a cargo to be provided
by Ajmal, Bilal receiving a certain freight for its conveyance. Ajmal does not provide any cargo
for the ship. Ajmal cannot claim the performance of Bilal’s promise, and must make compensation
to Bilal for the loss which Bilal sustains by the non-performance of the contract.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 34:
Azam contracts with Babar to execute certain builder's work for a fixed price, Babar supplying
the timber necessary for the work. Babar refuses to furnish any timber. Azam need not execute
the work, and Babar is bound to make compensation to Azam for any loss caused to him by the
non-performance of the contract.
 Example 35:
Azam contracts with Babar to deliver to him, at a specified price, certain merchandise on board
of a ship which cannot arrive for a month, and Babar engages to pay for the merchandise within
a week from the date of the contract. Babar does not pay within the week. Azam's promise to
deliver need not be performed, and Babar must make compensation.
 Example 36:
SPOTLIGHT

Azam promises Babar to sell him 1000 bales of merchandise to be delivered next day, and Babar
promises Azam to pay them within a month. Azam does not deliver according to his promise.
Babar's promise to pay need not be performed, and Azam must make compensation.

3.6 Reciprocal promises to do things legal, and also other things illegal [Section 57]
Where persons reciprocally promise, firstly, to do certain things which are legal, and, secondly, under specified
circumstances, to do certain other things which are illegal, the first set of promises is a contract, but the second
is a void agreement.
 Example 37:
STICKY NOTES

Azam and Babar agree that Azam shall sell Babar a house for Rs.10,000,000 but that, if Babar
uses it as a gambling house, he shall pay Rs.50,000,000 for it. The first set for reciprocal promises,
namely, to sell the house and to pay Rs.10,000,000 for it, is a contract. The second set is for an
unlawful object, namely, that Babar may use the house as a gambling house and is a void
agreement.

3.7 Alternative promise, one branch being illegal [Section 58]


In the case of an alternative promise, one branch of which is legal and the other illegal, the legal branch alone can
be enforced.
 Example 38:
Zahid and Yasir agree that Zahid shall pay Yasir Rs. 1 million for which Yasir shall afterwards
deliver to Zahid either rice or smuggled opium. This is a valid contract to deliver rice, and a void
agreement as to the opium.

120 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

 Practice Question 05:


Maimar promised to manufacture and deliver to Nasir, remote-controlled toy helicopters of
agreed specifications in first week of March 2011. Nasir in turn promised to pay for them by
second week of March 2011. Maimar did not deliver the toys according to his promise. Should
Nasir keep his promise and what remedy, if any, is available to him?
 Solution:
No, Nasir need not perform his promise to pay and Maimar must compensate Nasir for any loss
which Nasir may sustain due to Maimar’s non-performance.

AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 121


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

4. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Which one of the following is not a joint promise:
(a) Several joint promisors with a single promisee
(b) Single promisor with several joint promisees
(c) Several joint promisors with several joint promisees
(d) Single promisor with single promisee

02. Mr. X borrowed sum of Rs. 100,000/- from Mr. Y for two years. After one year Mr. X dies and Mr. Z, who
is a legal representative inherits property of Rs. 60,000/- from him. On the due date of repayment Mr. Y
will call upon Mr. Z to repay. But the capacity of Mr. Z is limited up to the value of Rs. 60,000/-. State the
AT A GLANCE

legal position.
(a) Mr. Z is liable to pay only Rs.60,000/-
(b) Mr. Z is liable to pay only Rs.100,000/-
(c) Mr. Z is liable to pay only Rs.40,000/-
(d) Mr. Z is liable to pay only Rs.160,000/-

03. For the performance of joint promise


(a) All joint promisors are jointly liable
(b) All of them are severally liable
SPOTLIGHT

(c) All joint promisors are individually liable


(d) All joint promisors are jointly and severally liable

04. Contract should be performed


(a) By promisor
(b) By his legal representative
(c) By the agent of promisor
(d) Any of the above
STICKY NOTES

05. Mr. A and Mr. B have borrowed sum of Rs.10,000/- from Mr. C. On due date both parties i.e. Mr. A and Mr.
B are jointly liable to pay. If before the payment Mr. A dies, who will be liable to pay Rs.10,000/-?
(a) Mr. B is liable to pay Rs.10,000/-
(b) Mr. B is liable to pay Rs.15,000/-
(c) The legal representative of Mr. A along with Mr. B is liable to pay Rs.10,000/-
(d) The legal representative of Mr. A is liable to pay Rs.10,000/-

06. Contractual obligation involving personal skill of the promisor


(a) Becomes obligation of legal representative of the promisor during his life time
(b) Never becomes obligation of legal representative of the deceased promisor
(c) Becomes obligation of legal representative of the deceased promisor
(d) Becomes obligation of legal representative of the deceased promisor

122 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

07. When the time is an essence of a contract, promisor fails to perform his promise on time,
(a) Contract becomes voidable at the option of promisee
(b) Contract becomes void
(c) Contract becomes unenforceable
(d) Promisor must pay compensation to the promise

08. Where two or more persons have made a joint promise, a release of one of such joint promisors by the
promisee:
(a) Does not discharge the other joint promisor(s), neither does it free the joint promisor so released
from responsibility to the other joint promisor(s).

AT A GLANCE
(b) Discharges the other joint promisor(s) but it does not free the joint promisor so released from
responsibility to the other joint promisor(s).
(c) Discharges the other joint promisor(s) and also frees the joint promisor so released from
responsibility to the other joint promisor(s).
(d) Release of one of such joint promisors is not allowed under the law.

09. Where a contract consists of reciprocal promises and such reciprocal promises are to be simultaneously
performed:
(a) Promisor need not perform his part of promise at all.
(b) Promisor need not perform his part of promise unless promisee is ready and willing to perform his

SPOTLIGHT
reciprocal promise.
(c) Promisor has to compel promise to perform his promise first.
(d) There is not valid contract between the parties.

10. Which one of the following statements is incorrect regarding the time of performance?
(a) Where time is of the essence of a contract, a slight delay shall not allow the aggrieved party the
right to terminate the contract.
(b) Where the contract does not provide that performance must be completed by a certain date, the
parties must perform their respective obligations within a reasonable time.

STICKY NOTES
(c) Parties can mutually decide whether the time is essence of the contract or not.
(d) Time shall be of the essence of the contract where the subject matter of the contract indicates that
time shall be of the essence.

11. When two or more persons have made a joint promise, then, unless a contrary intention appears from
the contract, the promise shall be performed, during their joint lives by:
(a) Any one of the joint promisors
(b) By a majority of joint promisors
(c) By all of them jointly.
(d) By any of the above ways.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 123


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

12. Where time for performance is specified in a contract:


(a) The promisor has to perform without application by the promisee.
(b) The promisor shall perform after specified time in the contract as per his own choice.
(c) Either of the above
(d) The promisor should wait for the application by the promisee and need not perform before that.

13. In a contract where time is not specified for performance, the promisor can perform the contract:
(a) At any time he wishes
(b) Within the shortest possible time
AT A GLANCE

(c) Within a reasonable time


(d) Within the latest time

14. Amjad, Babar and Chand jointly promise to pay Dawood the sum of Rs. 6,000. Chand is compelled to pay
the whole. Amjad in insolvent, but his assets are sufficient to pay one-half of his debts. Which of the
following is correct?
(a) Chand is entitled to receive Rs. 1,000 from Amjad’s estate and Rs. 2,500 from Babar
(b) Chand is entitled to receive Rs. 1,000 from Amjad’s estate and Rs. 2,000 from Babar
(c) Chand is entitled to receive Rs. 1,000 from Amjad’s estate and Rs. 3,000 from Babar
SPOTLIGHT

(d) None of above

15. Anwar promises Bunty to sell him 100 bales of cotton, to be delivered next day and Bunty promises
Anwar to pay for them within a month. Anwar does not deliver according to promise. Which of the
following is correct?
(a) Bunty’s promise to pay need not be performed, and he may claim compensation from Anwar
(b) The contract becomes void and ceases to be enforceable on non-delivery.
(c) Bunty’s promise to pay need not be performed, and but he cannot claim compensation from Anwar
(d) Bunty must pay after a month and only then he can sue for compensation.
STICKY NOTES

124 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

ANSWERS
01. (d) Single promisor with single promisee. Contract is nothing but a bundle of promises, when the
promise is made by one promisor and accepted by one promisee, this is known as single
promise
02. (a) Mr. Z is liable to pay only Rs.60000/-. The liability of a legal representative of the deceased
promisor is limited to the value of property he inherits from the deceased and not more than
that
03. (d) All joint promisors are jointly and severally liable. When two or more persons jointly make a
promise, they are jointly and severally liable to perform the promise.
04. (d) Contract is to be performed by promisor or by his legal representative or by his agent

AT A GLANCE
05. (c) The legal representative of Mr. A along with Mr. B is liable to pay Rs.10000/-. In case of death
of any one of joint promisors, his legal representative along with remaining promisors will
perform the promise
06. (b) If it is a contractual obligation involving personal skill or ability than the contract becomes
impossible to perform on death of the promisor
07. (a) Contract becomes voidable at the option of promisee. Being an aggrieved party, it depends upon
the promisee either to continue the contract or to rescind the contract.
08. (a) Does not discharge the other joint promisor(s), neither does it free the joint promisor so
released from responsibility to the other joint promisor(s).
09. (b) Promisor need not perform his part of promise unless promisee is ready and willing to perform

SPOTLIGHT
his reciprocal promise.
10. (a) Where time is of the essence of a contract, a slight delay shall not allow the aggrieved party the
right to terminate the contract.
11. (c) By all of them jointly.
12. (a) The promisor has to perform without application by the promisee.
13. (c) Within a reasonable time
14. (a) Chand is entitled to receive Rs. 1,000 from Amjad’s estate and Rs. 2,500 from Babar
15. (a) Bunty’s promise to pay need not be performed, and he may claim compensation from Anwar

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 125


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

Persons by whom the promise is to be performed


1. Promisor himself only (in case of personal nature contracts)
2. Legal representatives (in case of death of promisor)
3. Other competent person (unless there is intention to contrary)
4. Promisors jointly (or their legal representatives) in case of joint promise
AT A GLANCE

Rules regarding performance of joint promises


1. Joint and several liability
2. Right to claim contribution
3. Sharing of loss by default in contribution
4. Effect of release of one joint promisor
5. Performance to be demanded jointly (in case of joint promise)
SPOTLIGHT

Summary of Rules regarding time and place of performance


1. No time specified and no Perform within reasonable time
application to be made.
2. Certain day specified and no Perform at any time during usual hours
application to be made. of business.
3. Certain day specified and Promisee must apply for performance at
application to be made. porper place and within the usual hours
of business.
4. No place fixed and no Promisor must apply to promisee to
STICKY NOTES

application to be made appoint reasonable place.


5. Time and place prescribed or Perform accordingly.
sanctioned by promisee

Failure to perform at fixed time


1. When time is essential, the contract becomes voidable.
2. When time is not essential, the contract is not voidable.
The notice of intention to claim compensation must be given in case of acceptance of
delayed performance.

126 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 6: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II

Performance of reciprocal promises


1. Order of performance should be as fixed by parties or as the nature of
transaction requires.
2. No need to perform unless promisee is ready to perform his promise too, in
case of simultanous performance.
3. Contract becomes voidable at the option of the party prevented from
performance.
4. Reciprocal promises to do things legal (a contract) and also other things
illegal (void agreement)
5. Alternative promsies, legal branch (enforceable) and illegal branch (cannot

AT A GLANCE
be enforced)

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 127


CHAPTER 7: PERFORMANCE OF CONTRACTS-II CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

128 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 8

CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING


THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
In certain cases, the law imposes an obligation and allows an
AT A GLANCE action to be brought on it as if it arose out of an agreement,
though none was present in fact. Such cases, strictly speaking,
are not contracts, but the law recognises them as ‘certain
SPOTLIGHT
relations resembling those created by contracts’. In English law,
such relations are called quasi-contracts.
1. Quasi Contracts
Quasi-contracts rest on the ground of equity that a person shall
2. Objective Based Q&A not be allowed to enrich himself unjustly at the expense of
another.
STICKY NOTES
The Contract Act deals with the following quasi-contracts:

SPOTLIGHT
i. Claim for necessaries supplied to a person incapable of
contracting or on his account.
ii. Reimbursement of a person paying money due by
another in payment of which he is interested.
iii. Obligation of person enjoying benefit of a non-
gratuitous act.
iv. Responsibility of finder of goods.
v. Liability of person to whom money is paid or thing
delivered by mistake or under coercion.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 129


CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. QUASI CONTRACTS
In certain situation, the law of contract imposes obligations on a person in absence of any agreement. These
obligations resemble those as created by a contract. These are called quasi contract or constructive contract. The
concept of quasi contract is that of a contract that should have been formed even though in actuality it was not.

1.1 Supply of necessaries [Section 68]


If a person, incapable of entering into a contract (e.g. minor or person of unsound mind), or any one whom he is
legally bound to support, is supplied by another person with necessaries suited to his condition in life, the person
who has furnished such supplies is entitled to be reimbursed from the property of such incapable person.
 Example 01:
Habib supplies necessaries to the wife and children of Arslan, a minor. Habib can recover
AT A GLANCE

expenses from Arslan’s property, if any.


 Example 02:
Habib supplied a coat with diamond buttons to Arslan, a minor. Habib cannot demand the price
of coat from Arslan’s property.
 Example 03:
A minor purchased 11 coats. He had sufficient clothes at that time. It was held that coats were
not necessaries of life and minor was not liable to pay for them.
 Example 04:
Azam supplies Habib, a lunatic, with necessaries suitable to his condition in life. Azam is entitled
SPOTLIGHT

to be reimbursed from Habib's property, if any.


 Example 05:
Waseem supplies the wife and children of Saeed, a lunatic, with necessaries suitable to their
condition in life. Waseem is entitled to be reimbursed from Saeed's property, if any.
Notice that such claim is against the property of the minor or person of unsound mind and they are not personally
liable.
 Example 06:
Maryam, a minor buys medicines from Zain. Maryam has no property. Maryam cannot be held
personally liable for payment. She cannot be declared insolvent.
STICKY NOTES

1.2 Reimbursement of payment by interested person [Section 69]


A person who is interested is the payment of money which another is bound by law to pay, and who therefore
pays it, is entitled to be reimbursed by the other.
 Example 07:
Babar holds land in Sindh, on a lease granted by Azam, a Zamindar. The revenue payable by Azam
to the Government being in arrears, his land is advertised for sale by the Government. Under the
revenue law, the consequence of such sale will be the annulment of Babar's lease. Babar, to
prevent the sale and the consequent annulment of his own lease, pays the Government the sum
due from Azam. Azam is bound to make good to Babar the amount so paid.
 Example 08:
Azam pays arrears of rent of Babar voluntarily to avoid dispute between Babar and his landlord.
Azam cannot recover from Babar as he has no interest in the payment.

130 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT

 Example 09:
Bilal imported goods and stored in Anum’s warehouse without paying the custom duty. The
custom authorities recovered custom duty from Anum. Anum can recover the amount from Bilal.

1.3 Person enjoying benefit of non-gratituitous act /goods [Section 70]


Where a person lawfully does anything for another person, or delivers anything to him, not intending to do so
gratuitously, and such other person enjoys the benefit thereof, the latter is bound to make compensation to the
former in respect of, or to restore, the thing so done or delivered.
 Example 10:
Awais, a tradesman, leaves goods at Afaq's house by mistake. Afaq treats the goods as his own.
He is bound to pay Awais for them.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 11:
Azam saves Babar's property from fire. Azam is not entitled to compensation from Babar, if the
circumstances show that he intended to act gratuitously.

1.4 Responsibility of finder of goods [Section 71]


A person who finds goods belonging to another and takes them into his custody, is subject to the same
responsibility as a bailee.
He is bound to take as much care of the goods as a man of ordinary prudence would, under similar circumstances,
take of his own goods. He must also take reasonable steps to trace its owner - if he does not, he will be guilty of
wrongful conversion of the property. Until the true owner is found, he has right to retain possession of the goods.
[Section 151]

SPOTLIGHT
A finder of goods may sell the goods when the goods are of perishable nature or when the lawful charges for
finding the true owner amount to two-third or more of the value of the goods. [Section 169]
 Example 12:
Adeel found a diamond ring at wedding reception of Bilal. Adeel told Bilal and other guests about
it with an intention to find the true owner. If he is not able to find the owner he can retain the
ring as bailee.

1.5 Payment or delivery by mistake or under coercion [Section 72]


A person to whom money has been paid or anything delivered by mistake or under coercion, must repay or

STICKY NOTES
return it.
 Example 13:
Anum and Bilal jointly owe Rs. 100 to Saima. Anum alone pays the amount to Saima, and Bilal,
not knowing this fact, pays Rs. 100 over again to Saima. Saima is bound to repay the amount to
Bilal.
 Example 14:
A railway company refuses to deliver up certain goods to the consignee, except upon the payment
of an undue charge for carriage. The consignee pays the sum charged in order to obtain the goods.
He is entitled to recover so much of the charge as was excessive.
 Practice Question 01:
Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 briefly describe various types of quasi-contracts.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 131


CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
Supply of necessaries:
If a person incapable to enter into contract or his dependent is supplied by another person
necessities suited to his conditions in life, the person supplying such necessities is entitled to be
reimbursed the price from the property of such incompetent person.
Payment by interested person:
A person, who is interested in the payment of money which another is bound by law to pay, and
who therefore pays it, is entitled to be reimbursed by the other.
Person enjoying benefit of non-gratuitous act/goods:
Where a person lawfully does anything for another person, or delivers anything to him, not
AT A GLANCE

intending to do so gratuitously and such other person enjoys the benefit thereof, the latter is
bound to make compensation to the former in respect of, or to restore, the thing so done or
delivered.
Finder of goods:
A person who finds goods belonging to another, and takes them into his custody, is subject to the
same responsibility as a bailee.
Payment by mistake or under coercion:
A person to whom money has been paid, or anything delivered by mistake or under coercion,
must repay or return it.
 Practice Question 02:
SPOTLIGHT

Under certain special conditions, obligations resembling those created by a contract are imposed
by law although the parties have never entered into a contract. In view of the provisions of the
Contract Act, 1872 describe the conditions which must be fulfilled for claiming the amount in
each of the following cases:
i. Baqir supplied a jacket to Sultan in order to save him from cold weather. Sultan who was
a minor agreed to pay Rs. 2,000 for the jacket although its market price was Rs. 1,500.
ii. Rohi, who paid the electricity bill of Saulat without being asked, is now demanding
payment from Saulat.
iii. Sami, a coolie picked up the goods purchased by Nadia from the supermarket and took
them to her car. Nadia did not object to it. Sami demanded service charges from Nadia.
STICKY NOTES

 Solution:
Part (i) Claim for necessaries supplied to person incapable of contracting, or on his
account:
Baqir can recover the amount from Sultan if following conditions were satisfied:
 the jacket supplied was the necessity suited to Sultan’s condition in life.
 Baqir can recover the reasonable market value of Rs. 1,500 only from Sultan’s property.
He cannot recover Rs. 2,000 which Sultan had agreed to pay to Baqir as Sultan, being an
incompetent person was not in the capacity to contract.
Part (ii) Reimbursement of person paying money due by another in payment of which he
is interested:
Rohi can recover the amount of electricity bill from Saulat only if the following two conditions
were satisfied:
 Rohi who made the payment had interest in such payment.
 the payment must be such which Saulat was bound by law to pay.

132 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT

Part (iii) Obligation of person enjoying benefit of non-gratuitous act:


Sami can recover the amount of service charges from Nadia if following conditions were satisfied:
 Sami had lawfully done the service for Nadia, i.e. Nadia had the option to accept or reject
the services rendered by Sami.
 Sami did not have an intention to act gratuitously and Nadia had enjoyed the benefits of
the service so provided by Sami.
 Practice Question 03:
Sami rented his house to Qurban for a period of one year at an agreed sum of Rs. 10,000 per
month. After the first two months, Qurban defaulted in making payment of the rent. Baqir, a
neighbour, being concerned with the strained relationship between Sami and Qurban, paid the
rent with good intention. Subsequently, on Qurban’s refusal to reimburse the amount, Baqir filed

AT A GLANCE
a suit against him on the grounds that he made the payment to Sami which Qurban was legally
bound to make and being a quasi-contract Baqir is entitled to the reimbursement.
Explain whether Baqir is justified in his suit.
 Solution:
To constitute a quasi-contract and be entitled for reimbursement, following conditions must be
satisfied:
a) the person who made the payment must have his own interest in the payment; and
b) the other person must be bound by law to pay.
Baqir does not seem to have any interest in the payment and therefore, he is not justified in his
suit.

SPOTLIGHT
 Practice Question 04:
Mohsin acquired a piece of agricultural land in Moro, Sindh from a local landlord, Qasim Soomro,
on a lease term of twenty years. The revenue payable by Qasim Soomro on his land to the
Provincial Government was in arrears. As a result, the land was advertised for sale by the
Provincial Government. Mohsin, in order to prevent the sale of land, paid the sum due by Qasim
Soomro to the Provincial Government.
Under the provisions of Contract Act, 1872 explain whether Mohsin can recover such amount
from Qasim Soomro.
 Solution:

STICKY NOTES
To constitute a quasi-contract and be entitled for reimbursement, following conditions must be
satisfied:
i. the person who made the payment must have his own interest in the payment; and
ii. the other person must be bound by law to pay.
In the given scenario, Qasim Soomro was legally bound to pay the land revenue to the Provincial
Government and Mohsin, being interested in such payment, as his lease would have been
annulled upon sale of land by the provincial government, is entitled to recover the amount from
Qasim Soomro.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 133


CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Quasi-contract means
(a) Obligations imposed by law resembling those created by contract
(b) Obligation partly created by contract and partly by law
(c) Obligation partially enforceable by the law
(d) Obligation imposed by contract

02. Quasi-contract are based on


(a) Surrounding circumstances
AT A GLANCE

(b) Naturally created rights and obligation


(c) Principal of equity and justice
(d) Principal of reasonableness and fairness

03. In case, articles of necessaries are supplied to the person having no contractual capacity or to his
dependent, the supplier is entitled to be reimbursed
(a) From the property of that incapable person
(b) From the property of dependent
(c) Personal liability of that capable person
SPOTLIGHT

(d) From none of these

04. Compensation for non-gratuitous act is valid provided


(a) Party doing act has an intention to get compensation
(b) The person for whom the act is done must have got benefit
(c) Act done by the party is lawful
(d) All of the above
STICKY NOTES

05. In case, necessaries are supplied to the person having no contractual capacity, which of the following is
recoverable from his property
(a) Market price
(b) Contracted price
(c) Reasonable price
(d) Cost plus price

06. Finder of goods is under legal obligation for taking


(a) Reasonable care of the goods
(b) Required care of the goods
(c) Little care of the goods
(d) That much care, which he can take

134 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT

07. When one party under a mistake pays money to the other party, which is not due by contract, then
(a) That other party should refuse to repay it
(b) That other party must repay it to the party paying it
(c) That other party may repay it to the party paying it
(d) That other party may refuse to repay it

08. Quasi-contract implies creation of legal rights and obligations between parties without making any
formal contract which one of the following is not the type of Quasi-contract
(a) Supply of necessaries to the person having no contractual capacity
(b) Supply of necessaries to the person having no contractual capacity or to his dependent

AT A GLANCE
(c) Obligation to pay for non-gratuitous act or service
(d) Obligation to pay for gratuitous act or service

09. Mr. A has lost his pet dog. Not being able to find it out he announces that whosoever finds it and returns
it back to him, he will suitably reward him. Mr. D found that dog and took custody of it. On tracing Mr.
A, Mr. D claimed expenses which he incurred for the maintenance of dog and reward. State the legal
position
(a) Mr. A is bound to pay only reward to Mr. D
(b) Mr. A is bound to pay only expenses to Mr. D
(c) Mr. A is bound to pay both reward and expenses to Mr. D

SPOTLIGHT
(d) Mr. A is bound to pay nothing to Mr. D

10. Mr. X supplied rice and wheat worth Rs.20000/-, Mr. Y supplied a mobile phone worth Rs. 30000/- and
Mr. Z lent Rs.50000/- for the purchase of necessaries to the wife and children of Mr. M, a lunatic. Mr. M
has assets worth Rs. 100000/-. Can Mr. X, Mr. Y and Mr. Z recover anything from Mr. M?
(a) Mr. X, Mr. Y and Mr. Z can recover their full money.
(b) Mr. X, Mr. Y and Mr. Z cannot recover their full money.
(c) Mr. X and Mr. Y can recover their full money.
(d) Mr. X and Mr. Z can recover their full money.

STICKY NOTES
11. In case of non-gratuitous act or service, the obligation to pay arises if the following condition is satisfied.
(a) The thing must have been done or delivered lawfully
(b) The person who had done or delivered the thing must not have intended to do so gratuitously
(c) The person for whom the act is done must have enjoyed the benefit of the act
(d) All of the above

12. In Quasi-contract, there are


(a) Legal formalities
(b) Legal obligations
(c) Contractual obligations
(d) None of these

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 135


CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (a) In Quasi Contract, the parties do not go into the process of offer & acceptance, rather a
relationship resembling with that of a contract is established.
02. (c) According to this principle, nobody will be allowed to be enriched at the expense or cost of
another person.
03. (a) From the property of that incapable person. The supplier of necessaries is legally entitled to
recover the cost of such supplies.
04. (d) The person who gets benefit of non-gratuitous act or service is liable to compensate the person
doing such act or rendering services.
05. (c) Supplier of necessaries is legally entitled to recover the reasonable cost of such supplies
AT A GLANCE

06. (a) To take reasonable care of goods, as he would have taken in case of his own goods.
07. (b) Another party must repay it to the party paying it. That person is under legal obligations to
return it to the person paying.
08. (d) The person doing the act should not have intended to do it gratuitously.
09. (c) Mr. A is bound to pay both reward and expenses to Mr. D. Being a finder of goods, Mr. D is
entitled to claim both expenses & reward.
10. (d) Mr. X and Mr. Z can recover their full money because Mr. X & Mr. Z supplied necessaries but Mr.
Y cannot recover anything because he has not supplied necessaries.
11. (d) The person who gets benefit of non-gratuitous act or service is liable to compensate the person
SPOTLIGHT

doing such act or rendering services.


12. (b) A Quasi-contract is an obligation imposed by law in absence of any agreement between the
parties.
STICKY NOTES

136 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT

STICKY NOTES

Quasi Contracts
1. Claim for necessaries supplied to person incapable of contracting or his
dependents
2. Reimbursement of person paying money due by another in payment of
which he is interested
3. Obligation to pay by person enjoying benefit of non-gratuitous act
4. Responsibility of finder of goods as bailee.

AT A GLANCE
5. Liability of person to whom money is paid or thing deliverd by mistake or
under coercion.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 137


CHAPTER 8: CERTAIN RELATIONS RESEMBLING THOSE CREATED BY CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

138 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 9

CONSEQUENCES FOR
BREACH OF CONTRACT

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
When a contract has been broken, the injured party is entitled
to such damages which naturally arose in the usual course of
AT A GLANCE
things from such breach (ordinary damages) and such damages
which the parties knew, when they made the contract, to be
SPOTLIGHT
likely to result from the breach (special damages).
1. Compensation for Loss or However, such compensation is not to be given for any remote
Damage caused by Breach or indirect loss or damage sustained by reason of the breach and
in estimating the amount of compensation, the means which
2. Compensation where Penalty existed of remedying the inconvenience cause by non-
is Stipulated performance of the contract must be taken into account.
Sometimes the parties to a contract stipulate at the time of its

SPOTLIGHT
3. Objective Based Q&A
formation that on the breach of the contract by either of them, a
certain specified sum will be payable as damages.
STICKY NOTES
An aggrieved party can claim reasonable compensation only not
exceeding the amount named in the contract regardless of
whether the amount is penalty or not.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 139


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. COMPENSATION FOR LOSS OR DAMAGE CAUSED BY BREACH


Breach of contract occurs when a party either refuses or fails to perform his part of contract other than when
such performance is excused under the law. There are various remedies available to an aggrieved party of which
damages are more frequently sought remedies for breach of contract.

1.1 Damages arising naturally – ordinary damages [Section 73]


When a contract has been broken, the party who suffers by such breach is entitled to receive, from the party who
has bro ken the contract, compensation for any loss or damage caused to him thereby, which naturally arose in
the usual course of things from such breach.
The general rule for measuring damages, in case of breach of contract of sale, is the difference between contract
price and market price at the date of breach.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 01:
Naveed promised to deliver food at an event organised by Adeel for 80 persons for Rs. 85,000.
Just an hour before the event, Naveed informed that he would not be able to deliver the food.
Adeel arranged the food from another caterer which did cost him Rs. 93,000. Adeel may claim
damages of differential amount i.e. Rs. 8,000 from Naveed.
 Example 02:
Asif hires Bilal’s ship to go to Karachi, and there take on board, on the first of January, a cargo
which Asif is to provide and to bring it to Gwadar, the freight to be paid when earned. Bilal’s ship
does not go to Karachi, but Asif has opportunities of procuring suitable conveyance or the cargo
upon terms as advantageous as those on which he had chartered the ship. Asif avails himself of
those opportunities, but is put to trouble and expense in doing so. Asif is entitled to receive
SPOTLIGHT

compensation from Bilal in respect of such trouble and expense.


 Example 03:
Azam contracts to buy of Babar, at a Rs. 150 per kg, 500 kgs of rice, no time being fixed for
delivery. Azam afterwards informs Babar that he will not accept the rice if tendered to him, the
market price being dropped to Rs. 130 per kg on this day. Babar is entitled to receive from Azam,
by way of compensation, Rs. 20 per kg (i.e. total Rs. 10,000).
 Example 04:
Alia contracts to buy Bisma’s ship for Rs. 6 billion, but breaks her promise. The price which Bisma
could obtain at the time of breach of promise was Rs. 5.8 billion. Alia must pay to Bisma, by way
of compensation, the excess, Rs. 0.2 billion.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 05:
Arslan, the owner of a boat, contracts with Burhan to take a cargo of yarn to Gwadar, for sale at
Gwadar, starting on a specified day. The boat owing to some avoidable cause, does not start at
the time appointed, whereby the arrival of the cargo at Gwadar is delayed beyond the time when
it would have arrived if the boat had sailed according to the contract. After that date, and before
the arrival of the cargo, the price of yarn falls. The measure of the compensation payable to
Burhan by Arslan is the difference (Rs. 1 million) between the price which Burhan could have
obtained for the cargo at Gwadar at the time when it would have arrived (Rs. 6 million) if
forwarded in due course, and its market price at the time when it actually arrived (Rs. 5 million).
 Example 06:
Akmal contracts to repair Kamran’s house in a certain manner, and receives payment in advance.
Akmal repairs the house, but not according to contract. Kamran is entitled to recover from Akmal
the cost of making the repairs conform to the contract.

140 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT

 Example 07:
Ajmal contracts to let his ship to Saeed for a year, from the first of January for a certain price (Rs.
28 million). Freights rise, and, on the first of January, the hire obtainable for the ship is higher
(Rs. 32 million) than the contract price. Ajmal breaks his promise. He must pay to Saeed, by way
of compensation, a sum equal to the difference (Rs. 4 million) between the contract price and the
price for which Saeed could hire a similar ship for a year on and from the first of January.
 Example 08:
Adeel contracts to supply Jazib with a 1,000 kg of iron at Rs. 20 per kg above the price at which
Adeel could procure and deliver the iron. Jazib wrongfully refuses to receive the iron. Jazib must
pay to Kashif, by way of compensation, the difference between the contract price of the iron and
the sum for which Adeel could have obtained and delivered it, i.e. Rs. 20,000.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 09:
Abid sells certain merchandise to Sajid, warranting it to be of a particular quality, and Sajid, in
reliance upon this warranty, sells it to Habib with a similar warranty. The goods prove to be not
according to the warranty, and Sajid becomes liable to pay Habib a sum of money by way of
compensation. Sajid is entitled to be reimbursed this sum by Abid.
 Example 10:
Amjad contracts to deliver 5,000 kg of rice to Tanveer on the first of January at Rs. 100 per kg.
Tanveer afterwards, before the first of January, contracts to sell the rice to Rizwan at a price (i.e.
Rs. 125 per kg) higher than the market price (i.e. Rs. 120 per kg) on the first of January. Amjad
breaks his promise. In estimating the compensation payable by Amjad to Tanveer, the market
price (Rs. 120 per kg) of the first of January, and not the profit which would have arisen to

SPOTLIGHT
Tanveer from the sale to Rizwan, is to be taken into account. The damages are to be calculated as
Rs. 20 per kg.

1.2 Damages in contemplation of parties – special damages [Section 73]


When a contract has been broken, the party who suffers by such breach is entitled to receive, from the party who
has bro ken the contract, compensation for any loss or damage caused to him thereby, which the parties knew,
when they made the contract, to be likely to result from the breach of it.
 Example 11:
Azam, a builder; contracts to erect and finish a house by the first of January, in order that Babar
may give possession of it at that time to Qasim, to whom Babar has contracted to let it. Azam is

STICKY NOTES
informed of the contract between Babar and Qasim. Azam builds the house so badly that, before
the first of January it falls down, and has to be rebuilt by Babar, who, in consequence, loses the
rent which he was to have received from Qasim, and is obliged to make compensation to Qasim
for the breach of his contract. Azam must make compensation to Babar for the cost of rebuilding
the house, for the rent lost, and for the compensation made to Qasim.
 Example 12:
Asif, having contracted with Basheer to supply Basheer with 1,000 kg of iron at Rs. 500 per kg, to
be delivered at a stated time, contracts with Saleem for the purchase of 1,000 kg of iron at Rs.
400 per kg, telling Saleem that he does so for the purpose of performing his contract with
Basheer. Saleem, fails to perform his contract with Asif, who cannot procure other iron, and
Basheer, in consequence, rescinds the contract. Saleem must pay to Asif Rs. 100,000, being the
profit which Asif would have made by the performance of his contract with Basheer.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 141


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 13:
Amjad contracts with Bilal to make and deliver to Bilal, by a fixed day for a specified price, a
certain piece of machinery. Amjad does not deliver the piece of machinery at the time specified,
and, in consequence of this, Bilal is obliged to procure another at a higher price than that which
he was to have paid to Amjad, and is prevented from performing a contract which Bilal had made
with a third person at the time of his contract with Amjad (but which had not been then
communicated to Amjad), and is compelled to make compensation for breach of that contract.
Amjad must pay to Bilal by way of compensation, the difference between the contract price of the
piece of machinery and the sum paid by Bilal for another, but not the sum paid by Bilal to the
third person by way of compensation.
 Example 14:
Aslam contracts to sell and deliver 500 bales of cotton to Kunal on a fixed day, Aslam knows
AT A GLANCE

nothing of Kunal’s mode of conducting his business. Aslam breaks his promise, and Kunal, having
no cotton, is obliged to close his mill. Aslam is not responsible to Kunal for the loss caused to
Kunal by the closing of the mill.
1.3 Remote and indirect loss [Section 73]
Such compensation is not to be given for any remote and indirect loss or damage sustained by reason of the
breach.
There may be losses which clearly result from the defendant’s breach of contract but are considered too remote
from the breach for it to be fair to expect the defendant to compensate the claimant for them.
 Example 15:
On 1st December; Qasim contracted to sell and deliver 50 tons of wheat @ Rs. 8,000 per ton to
SPOTLIGHT

Yousaf on 1st January. On 20th December Yousaf, afterwards, contracted to sell those goods to
Haris at Rs. 10,000 per ton. Qasim failed to deliver goods on 1st January when the price of the
wheat was Rs. 9,500 per ton. Yousaf is entitled to recover Rs. 75,000 [i.e. (Rs. 9,500 – Rs. 8,000)
x 50). Yousaf is not entitled to recover Rs. 100,000 as profit which would have arisen to Yousaf
from the sale to Haris because the profit is the indirect consequence of the breach of contract.
 Example 16:
Azam delivers to Babar, a common carrier; a machine to be delivered without delay, to Azam's
mill informing that his mill has stopped for want of the machine. Babar unreasonably delays the
delivery of machine, and Azam, in consequence, loses a profitable contract with the Government.
Azam is entitled to receive from Babar, by way of compensation, the average amount of profit,
which would have been made by the working of the mill during the time that delivery of it was
STICKY NOTES

delayed, but not the loss sustained through the loss of the Government contract.
 Example 17:
Joseph contracts to pay a sum of money to Biden on a day specified. Joseph does not pay the
money on that day. Biden, in consequence of not receiving the money on that day, is unable to
pay his debts, and is totally ruined. Joseph is not liable to make good to Biden anything except
the principal sum he contracted to pay, together with interest up to the day of payment.
 Example 18:
Pence, a ship-owner, contracts with Harris to convey him from Karachi to Sydney in Pence’s ship,
sailing on the first of January, and Harris pays to Pence, by way of deposit, 50% of his passage
money. The ship does not sail on the first of January, and Harris, after being, in consequence,
detained in Karachi for some time, and there by put to some expense, proceeds to Sydney in
another vessel, and, in consequence, arriving too late in Sydney, loses a sum of money. Pence is
liable to repay to Harris his deposit, with interest, and the expense to which he is put by his
detention in Karachi and the excess, if any, of the passage money paid for the second ship over
that agreed upon for the first, but not the sum of money which Harris lost by arriving in Sydney
too late.

142 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT

 Example 19:
Xi Ping contacts to sell and deliver to Putin, on the first of January, certain cloth, which Putin
intends to manufacture into caps of a particular kind, for which there is no demand, except at
that season. The cloth is not delivered till after the appointed time, and too late to be used that
year in making caps. Putin is entitled to receive from Xi Ping, by way of compensation, the
difference between the contract price of the cloth and its market price at the time of delivery, but
not the profits which he expected to obtain by making caps, nor the expenses which he has been
put to in making preparation for the manufacture.

1.4 Damages in quasi contract [Section 73]


When an obligation resembling those created by contract has been incurred and has not been discharged, any
person injured by the failure to discharge it is entitled to receive the same compensation from the party in default,

AT A GLANCE
as if such person had contracted to discharge it and had broken his contract.
It means the compensation for damages arising from breach of a quasi-contract shall be same as in any other
contract.
 Example 20:
Anwar, a tradesman, leaves goods at Saleem’s house by mistake. Saleem treats the goods as his
own and consumes them. Anwar had to buy the goods from market next day. Saleem is liable to
pay Anwar the market price paid by Anwar for those goods.

1.5 Means of remedying the inconvinience [Section 73]


In estimating the loss or damage arising from a breach of contract, the means which existed of remedying the in
convenience caused by the non-performance of the contract must be taken into account.

SPOTLIGHT
It is the duty of the aggrieved party to take all reasonable steps to mitigate the loss caused by the breach and it
cannot claim compensation for the loss which could reasonably have been avoided.
 Example 21:
Bilal contracted to pay Rs. 500,000 to Jamal for procuring raw materials for a specific order from
government. Bilal clearly stated that in case order is not fulfilled he will lose profit of Rs. 200,000.
Jamal did not deliver the raw materials. Bilal could buy the raw materials from market for Rs.
600,000 but did not do that and filed a suit for recovery of special damages of Rs. 200,000. He
can recover only Rs. 100,000 as it was duty of Bilal to minimise the damage suffered due to breach
and he could do so by procuring material from the market.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 22:
Abid took a shop on rent from Hamid and paid one month’s rent in advance. Hamid could not
give possession of the shop to Abid. Abid chose to do no business for 8 months though there were
other shops available in the vicinity. Abid sued Hamid for breach of contract and claimed
damages for loss suffered. Abid is entitled only to a refund of his advance and nothing more, as
he had failed in his duty to minimise the loss by not taking another shop in the neighbourhood.

1.6 Party rightly rescinding the contract [Section 75]


A person who rightly rescinds a contract is entitled to compensation for any damage which he has sustained
through the non-fulfilment of the contract.
 Example 23:
Asifa, a singer, contracts with Behzad, the manager of a theatre, to sing at his theatre for two
nights in every week during the next two months, and Behzad engages to pay her Rs. 100,000 for
each night’s performance. On the sixth night, Asifa wilfully absents herself from the theatre, and
Behzad, in consequence, rescinds the contract. Behzad is entitled to claim compensation for the
damage which he has sustained through the nonfulfillment of the contract.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 143


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 01:


Saleem entered into a contract for the purchase of 5 vehicles from Phony (Private) Limited (PL)
which were to be delivered in the month of February. Saleem also entered into another contract
for onward sale of these vehicles to Jabbar Limited (JL). However, PL refused to deliver the
vehicles as contracted. Saleem had to buy the vehicles from another supplier at an extra cost of
Rs. 2 million for supplying these to JL. Saleem also had to pay compensation of Rs. 0.6 million to
JL due to delay in supply. Under the provisions of the Contract Act, 1872 analyse the above
situation and comment whether Saleem is entitled to receive any compensation from PL.
 Solution:
Saleem is entitled to receive from Phony (Private) Limited (PL), compensation for any loss or
damage caused to him which naturally arose in the usual course of things from such breach i.e.
Rs. 2 million. However, such compensation cannot be claimed for any remote and indirect loss or
AT A GLANCE

damage sustained by reason of the breach unless the parties knew about such consequences
when they made the contract. Hence, PL would only be liable to pay the amount of Rs. 0.6 million
claimed by JL if PL knew about this arrangement at the time of entering into the contract.
 Practice Question 02:
Describe the principles of determining compensation for loss or damages caused due to breach
of contract.
 Solution:
The party who suffers from breach of contract is entitled to receive compensation for any loss or
damage caused to it, which naturally arose from the usual course of things from such breach, or
which the parties knew, when they made the contract to be likely to result from such breach.
SPOTLIGHT

Such compensation is not to be given for any remote or indirect loss or damage sustained by
reason of the breach.
STICKY NOTES

144 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT

2. COMPENSATION WHERE PENALTY IS STIPULATED


2.1 Basic rule [Section 74]
The parties to a contract may stipulate at the time of its formation that on the breach of the contract by either of
them, a certain specified sum will be payable as damages. Such a sum may or may not be by way of penalty.
A sum is by way of penalty when it is extravagant and disproportionate to the damage likely to accrue as a result
of the breach.
The Court will award to the party aggrieved only reasonable compensation not exceeding the amount named or
penalty stipulated. Therefore, the amount fixed up at the time of contract, regardless of whether it is a penalty or
not, determines only the maximum limit of liability in case of breach of contract.
 Example 24:

AT A GLANCE
Arslan, under a sale of goodwill arrangement, contracts with Burhan that if Arslan practices as a
surgeon within Peshawar, he will pay Burhan Rs. 5 million. Arslan practices as surgeon in
Peshawar. Burhan is entitled to such compensation not exceeding Rs. 5 million as the Court
considers reasonable.
 Example 25:
Azam contracts with Babar to pay Rs. 2 million, if he fails to pay Babar Rs. 1 million on a given
day. The double amount is disproportionate to the likely actual loss. This is a penalty clause.
Azam fails to pay Babar Rs. 1 million on that day. Babar is entitled to recover from Azam such
compensation not exceeding Rs. 2 million as the Court considers reasonable.
 Example 26:

SPOTLIGHT
Azam undertakes to repay Babar a loan of Rs. 1,000,000 by five equal monthly instalments with
a stipulation that, in default of payment of any instalment, the whole shall become due. This
stipulation is not by way of penalty and contract may be enforced according to its terms. Notice
that no extra amount is being paid.
 Example 27:
Azam borrows Rs. 1,000,000 from Babar and gives him a bond of Rs. 2,000,000 payable by five
yearly instalments of Rs. 400,000, with a stipulation that, in default of payment of any
instalments, the whole shall become due. This is a stipulation by way of penalty. The court may
order reasonable compensation only.
 Example 28:

STICKY NOTES
Asif who owes money to Basheer, a money lender, undertakes to repay him by delivering to
him10 ton of grain on a certain date, and stipulates that, in the event of his not delivering by the
stipulated date, he shall be liable to deliver 20 ton. This is stipulation by way of penalty, and
Basheer is only entitled to reasonable compensation in case of breach.

2.2 Increased interest as penalty [Section 74]


A stipulation for increased interest from the date of default may be a stipulation by way of penalty.
 Example 29:
Azam gives Babar a bond for the repayment of Rs. 1,000,000 with interest at 12 per cent, at the
end of six months, with a stipulation that in case of default, interest shall be payable at the rate
of 75 per cent, from the date of default. This is a stipulation by way of penalty, and Babar is only
entitled to recover from Azam such compensation as the Court considers reasonable.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 145


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. The main object of awarding damages is
(a) To compensate monetary losses of aggrieved party
(b) To punish the party responsible for breach of contract
(c) To honour the petition of aggrieved party
(d) To put aggrieved party in a better position

02. In a breach of contract of sale, general rule for measuring damage is


(a) Difference between contract price and market price
AT A GLANCE

(b) Difference between purchase price and selling price


(c) Difference between selling price and market price
(d) Difference between cost price and selling price

03. Damages which naturally arose in the usual course of things from breach of contract are called:
(a) Ordinary damages
(b) Special damages
(c) Remote damages
(d) Indirect damages
SPOTLIGHT

04. Such damages which the parties knew, when they made the contract, to be likely to result from the breach
are called:
(a) Ordinary damages
(b) Special damages
(c) Remote damages
(d) Indirect damages

05. In case of fixed damages provided in contract


STICKY NOTES

(a) Damages for actual loss will be awarded


(b) Damages for actual loss to the maximum of amount fixed will be awarded
(c) Amount of damages, as fixed will be awarded
(d) None of these are applicable

06. Mr. B agreed to supply spare parts of machine to Mr. A on 5th September at particular price. Mr. B fails
to deliver spare parts on due date. There is a breach of contract and Mr. A filed a suit against Mr. B for the
compensation of losses. Mr. A claimed that due to non-availability of spare parts, the machine could not
function, so Mr. A claimed (i) depreciation on machine (ii) fixed expenses such as salary and (iii) loss of
profit due to non-function of machine. State the legal position.
(a) Mr. A can only claim depreciation on machine
(b) Mr. A can only claim fixed expenses such as salary
(c) Mr. A cannot claim any amount
(d) Mr. A can claim depreciation on machine and fixed expenses only such as salary

146 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT

07. Which of the following losses can be recovered in case of breach of contract?
(a) Losses arising naturally from the breach.
(b) Losses in contemplation of parties after they had entered into the contract
(c) Remote losses
(d) Indirect losses

08. The rules for damages in quasi contract are same as those:
(a) Contingent contracts.
(b) Voidable contracts.

AT A GLANCE
(c) Any other contract.
(d) Property contracts.

09. Mr. A agrees to sell 200 bags of sugar to Mr. B on 11th November at Rs.500/- per bag. Mr. B is to make
payment on the delivery of sugar bags. Before the due date the price of sugar has increased to Rs. 600/-
per bag. Mr. A refuse to supply sugar to Mr. B. There is a breach of contract Mr. B is
(a) Not entitled to claim any amount
(b) Entitled to claim Rs. 600/- per bag of sugar
(c) Entitled to claim Rs. 100/- per bag of sugar
(d) Not entitled to claim Rs.100/- per bag of sugar

SPOTLIGHT
10. The amount of damages fixed by the parties at the time of making a contract is not by way of penalty if:
(a) It is extravagant and unreasonable in amount as compared to maximum possible loss that may
arise.
(b) The higher interest rate has been stipulated in case of default.
(c) The breach consists of not paying a sum of money and amount fixed is double the amount of that
sum of money.
(d) The amount is genuine pre-estimate of the probable loss.

11. In case of breach, full amount is to pe paid as stipulated in the contract if:

STICKY NOTES
(a) The amount relates to bond given by one Pakistani citizen to another.
(b) The amount relates to recognisance.
(c) The amount is by way of penalty.
(d) The amount is not by way of penalty.

12. Mr. A entered into an agreement for constructing house for Mr. B and to give complete possession on 1st
January. Mr. B makes an agreement with Mr. C for renting out that house to him from 2nd January. This
fact is in the knowledge of Mr. A. The house was badly constructed and collapsed before 1st January. Mr.
B is entitled to get compensation for
(a) Cost of reconstructing the house
(b) Loss of rent
(c) Compensation, which Mr. B was to pay Mr. C for not renting out the house
(d) All of the above

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 147


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (a) The basic idea of providing compensation to the aggrieved party is to put him in the same
financial position as he would have been if the contract had been performed.
02. (a) Difference between contract price and market price.
03. (a) Ordinary damages
04. (b) Special damages
05. (b) Damages for actual loss to the maximum of amount fixed will be awarded. The court will make
assessment of actual loss and grant damage for compensating that loss.
06. (d) Mr. A can claim depreciation on machine and fixed expenses only such as salary. Compensation
AT A GLANCE

may be granted only for depreciation, fixed expenses, and salary. The loss of profit is a remote
and indirect loss.
07. (a) Losses arising naturally from the breach.
08. (c) Any other contract.
09. (c) Entitled to claim Rs. 100/- per bag of sugar. Natural and direct losses may, vary situation to
situation depending on nature of transaction and prevailing circumstances.
10. (d) The amount is genuine pre-estimate of the probable loss.
11. (b) The amount relates to recognisance.
12. (d) The aggrieved party, Mr. A can claim cost of rebuilding the house, loss of rent and compensation
to third party.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

148 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT

STICKY NOTES

Compensation for loss or damage caused by breach


1. Damages arising naturally – ordinary damages
2. Damages in contemplation of parties – special damages
3. Remote and indirect loss not to be compensated
4. Damages in quasi contract is same as any other contract
5. The possibility of mitigatitng the loss also be considered while measuring

AT A GLANCE
the damages.
6. A party that rightfully rescinds the contract is also entitled to compensation.

Compensation where penalty is stipulated


1. Court will allow only reasonable compensation not exceeding amount fixed
whether or not the amount fixed is by way of penalty.
2. Full amount of compensation to be paid in case of bail-bond, recognisance,
etc.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 149


CHAPTER 9: CONSEQUENCES FOR BREACH OF CONTRACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

150 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 10

APPOINTMENT AND
AUTHORITY OF AGENTS

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
An agent is a person employed to do any act for another or to
AT A GLANCE represent another in dealings with third persons. The person for
whom such act is done, or who is so represented, is called
principal.
SPOTLIGHT
Whatever a person competent to contract may do himself, he
1. Appointment of Agents may do through an agent. The consideration is not necessary in
agency relationship i.e. Contract between principal and agent.
2. Authority of Agents
The authority of an agent means his capacity to bind the
principal. This authority may be actual authority or ostensible
3. Objective Based Q&A
authority.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES Actual authority is the authority conferred on an agent by the
principal. It may be expressed or implied. An agent having
authority to do an act has authority to do every lawful thing
which is necessary in order to do such act.
Ostensible or apparent authority is the authority of an agent as
it appears to others i.e. third party.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 151


CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. APPOINTMENT OF AGENTS
1.1 Definition [Section 182]
An “agent” is a person employed to do any act for another or to represent another in dealings with third persons.
The person for whom such act is done, or who is so represented, is called the “principal”.
Analysis
All types of business may use agents. An agent is a person who acts on behalf of someone else (a ‘principal’) to
arrange a transaction with a third party.
AT A GLANCE

There is a legal relationship between the agent and the principal. This legal relationship is called ‘agency’.
SPOTLIGHT

 Example 01:
Pasha appoints Azam to buy 10 bags of sugar on his behalf. Pasha is ‘principal’ and Azam is ‘agent’
and the contract between the two is ‘agency’.
The agent acts on behalf of the principal, by negotiating with a third party. Under normal circumstances, there is
no legal agreement between the agent and the third party.
 Example 02:
Pasha appoints Azam to buy 10 bags of sugar on his behalf. If in pursuance of contract of agency,
Azam finalises a deal to purchase the bags of sugar from Tariq, a wholesale dealer in sugar, on
credit, on behalf of Pasha. There is no legal agreement between Azam and Tariq.
STICKY NOTES

However, the agent may negotiate the terms of a contract between the principal and the third party. When the
contract is made, it is between the principal and the third party.
 Example 03:
Pasha appoints Azam to buy 10 bags of sugar on his behalf. If in pursuance of contract of agency,
Azam purchases the bags of sugar from Tariq, a wholesale dealer in sugar, on credit, then Pasha
and Tariq are in direct contractual relations and the contract of purchase is enforceable both by
and against Pasha.
An agent may act for a principal in arranging just one transaction. However, it is common in business for an agent
to act regularly on behalf of a principal, arranging large numbers of different business transactions and contracts.

1.2 Who may employ agent [Section 183]


Any person who is of the age of majority according to the law to which he is subject, and who is of sound mind,
may employ an agent.

152 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS

 Example 04:
Parveen (25 years old) employed Azam (36 years old) as her agent to finalise a business deal
with Tariq. Azam made the contract on behalf of Parveen with Tariq. Parveen and Tariq can
enforce the contract against each other.
 Example 05:
Maria (17 years old) employed Azam (36 years old) as her agent to finalise a business deal with
Tariq. Azam made the contract on behalf of Maria with Tariq. Maria is not allowed to employ an
agent under the law. Tariq cannot enforce the contract against Maria but may enforce it against
Azam.

1.3 Who may be an agent [Section 184]

AT A GLANCE
As between the principal and third persons any person may become an agent.
Such agent shall be responsible to his principal according to the provisions contained in the Contract Act, except
when such person is minor or of unsound mind.
 Example 06:
Parveen (25 years old) employed Azam (36 years old) as her agent to finalise a business deal
with Tariq. Azam made the contract on behalf of Parveen with Tariq. Azam as an agent shall be
responsible to Parveen in case he breaches his duty as an agent.
 Example 07:
Parveen (25 years old) employed Asif (15 years old) as her agent to finalise a business deal with
Tariq. Asif made the contract on behalf of Parveen with Tariq. Asif as an agent shall not be

SPOTLIGHT
responsible to Parveen in case he breaches his duty as an agent.

1.4 Consideration not necessary [Section 185]


No consideration is necessary to create an agency.
 Example 08:
Arslan promises to sell Faisal’s house on his behalf. An agreement between Arslan and Faisal is
valid even without consideration.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 153


CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. AUTHORITY OF AGENTS
2.1 Legal issues with agency relationships
There are two main legal issues with agency arrangements when there may be some doubt about the validity of
a contract that an agent makes with a third party on behalf of a principal.
 A person (A) might claim to act on behalf of a principal (P), and a third party (T) might enter into an
agreement believing the contract to be with P. However, P might deny that the person is in fact his agent.
 A person (A) might be the agent of Principal (P) with authority to make certain agreements on behalf of
P. However, the agent might make an agreement with a third party (T) and in doing so go beyond the
limits of his authority as agent. The principal (P) might then refuse to accept the agreement as legally
binding. An example of this is where a manager makes an agreement on behalf of the company he works
AT A GLANCE

for, and the company refuses to honour the agreement on the grounds that the manager did not have the
authority to make the agreement.
The principal is liable to third party when agent has authority, whether that authority is express or implied, or
whether that authority is actual or apparent.

2.2 Express Authority [Section 186 & 187]


The authority of an agent may be expressed. An authority is said to be express when it is given by words spoken
or written.
 Example 09:
Paras appointed Azam as his agent to sell his house by a written power of attorney. Azam sold
the house to Tariq. Azam had express authority and the transaction is binding on Paras.
SPOTLIGHT

 Example 10:
Paras appointed Atif as his agent to sell goods at his shop by a verbal agreement. Atif sold the
goods. Atif had express authority and the transaction is binding on Paras.

2.3 Implied Authority [Section 186, 187 & 188]


The authority of an agent may be implied. An authority is said to be implied when it is to be inferred from the
circumstances of the case, and things spoken or written, or the ordinary course of dealing, may be accounted for
circumstances of the case.
 Example 11:
STICKY NOTES

Amjad owns a shop in Quetta, living himself in Karachi, and visiting the shop occasionally. The
shop is managed by Basit, and he is in the habit of ordering goods from Dawood in the name of
Amjad for the purposes of the shop, and of paying for them out of Amjad’s funds with Amjad’s
knowledge. Basit has an implied authority from Amjad to order goods from Dawood in the name
of Amjad for the purposes of the shop.

2.3.1 Extent of agent’s authority


An agent having an authority to do an act has authority to do every lawful thing which is necessary in order to
do such act.
 Example 12:
Anwar is employed by Parveen, residing in London, to recover at Karachi a debt due to Parveen.
Anwar may adopt any legal process necessary for the purpose of recovering the debt, and may
give a valid discharge for the same.
An agent having an authority to carry on a business has authority to do every lawful thing necessary for the
purpose, or usually done in the course of conducting such business.

154 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS

 Example 13:
Paras constitutes Asif as his agent to carry on his business of a shipbuilder. Asif may purchase
timber and other materials, and hire workmen, for the purposes of carrying on the business.

2.4 Apparent (ostensible) authority


The principal is liable to third party when third party has reasonable reason to believe that the agent has
authority to act on behalf of principal, even though it might not be the actual case.
Unless the third party has knowledge to the contrary, he is entitled to assume that an agent holding a particular
position has all the powers that are normally given to a person in such a position.
 Example 14:
Parvez terminated the services of his agent Anum. No notice to this effect was given by Parvez.

AT A GLANCE
Subsequently; Anum purchased some goods from Talal on behalf of Parvez. It was held that
Parvez was liable to pay the price to Talal.
 Example 15:
Paras writes to Talal that Azam is authorised to sell his car. Paras privately instructs Azam not to
sell the car. Azam sells the car to Talal for Rs. 400,000. The sale is binding on Paras. Azam had
ostensible, not actual, authority to sell.
 Example 16:
Pasha leaves certain articles with Aslam, an auctioneer asking him not to sell them below a stated
price. Aslam sells the articles to Tariq below the stated price. Tariq knows of Pasha’s instructions
to Aslam. Pasha can set aside the contract with Tariq.

SPOTLIGHT
 Example 17:
Pasha leaves certain articles with Aslam, an auctioneer asking him not to sell them below a stated
price. Aslam sells the articles to Tariq below the stated price. Tariq is ignorant of Pasha’s
instructions to Aslam. Pasha cannot set aside the contract with Tariq.

2.5 Agent’s authority in an emergency [Section 189]


An agent has authority, in an emergency, to do all such acts for the purpose of protecting his principal from loss
as would be done by a person of ordinary prudence, in his own case, under similar circumstances.
 Example 18:

STICKY NOTES
Pasha consigns butter to Ameen (his agent) at Lahore, with directions to send them immediately
to Baqir at Rawalpindi. Ameen noticed that butter might not bear the journey to Rawalpindi
without spoiling. Ameen sold the butter at Lahore to avoid loss. Ameen’s act is valid.
 Example 19:
Pasha consigns Furniture to Abid (his agent) at Lahore, with directions to send the items
immediately to Babar at Rawalpindi. Abid thought the furniture might not fetch good price at
Rawalpindi and sold the furniture in Lahore. Abid’s act is not valid as there was no real
emergency.
 Example 20:
An agent for sale may have goods repaired if it be necessary.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 155


CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. A Minor can
(a) Be an agent but not liable to his principal for breach of duty
(b) Be a principal
(c) Be an agent liable to his principal as any agent with age of majority
(d) Both (b) and (c)

02. An agent has authority in emergency to do all such acts as would be done by a person of ordinary
prudence in his own case under similar circumstances, for the purpose of
AT A GLANCE

(a) Securing maximum benefit for himself


(b) Making secret profit
(c) Protecting his principal from loss
(d) Protecting third party from loss

03. The agent acts on behalf of the principal, by negotiating with the third party. Under normal circumstance,
there is no legal agreement between
(a) The agent and the principal
(b) The principal and the third party
SPOTLIGHT

(c) The agent and the third party


(d) The agent and the sub-agent

04. Jamal appointed Adeel to do act for him or to represent in dealings with third parties. Since Adeel is an
agent and Jamal will be:
(a) The Boss
(b) The master
(c) The Principal
(d) None of these
STICKY NOTES

05. The relationship between the principal and the agent is called:
(a) Master and servant relationship
(b) Boss and secretary relationship
(c) Agency relationship
(d) None of these

06. If the principal is not competent to contract, he:


(a) can make an agency relationship.
(b) cannot make an agency relationship.
(c) can appoint another person to make an agency relationship on his behalf.
(d) None of the above is true.

156 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS

07. Naveed appointed Imran as his agent. Now the acts of Imran are:
(a) Binding for Naveed
(b) Binding for both Naveed and Imran
(c) Not binding for Naveed
(d) Binding for Imran

08. What is the minimum consideration required to create an agency?


(a) Minimum Rs. 1,000 per day
(b) Equal to minimum monthly wage fixed by government in that area

AT A GLANCE
(c) No consideration at all is required
(d) Equal to average commission paid in the industry in last three years.

09. What are the essentials for a person to employ an agent?


(a) The person should not be of sound mind
(b) The person should be a major, according to the law to which the agent is subject
(c) The person should be a major, according to the law to which he is subject and should also be of sound
mind
(d) The person should have executed a contract of indemnity before employing an agent

SPOTLIGHT
10. An Agent’s authority can be created
(a) Only by expressly writing the terms thereof
(b) Only by implication
(c) Only by expressly writing the terms thereof and registering the same with sub-registrar
(d) Either expressly or impliedly

11. Out of the following, who can appoint an agent?


(a)

STICKY NOTES
Person of sound mind aged sixteen
(b) Person of sound mind aged twenty five
(c) Person of unsound mind aged twenty five
(d) Person of unsound mind aged sixteen

12. Asif is residing in Khanewal and has a house in Layyah. Asif appoints Basheer by a power of attorney to
take care of his house. State the nature of agency created between Asif and Basheer.
(a) Implied agency
(b) Agency in emergency
(c) Agency by holding out
(d) Express agency

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 157


CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (a) As between the principal and third person any person may become an agent. Even a minor or
a person of unsound mind can be appointed as agent, however, they shall not be liable to
principal as they are not competent to contract.
02. (c) An agent has authority in emergency to do all such acts for the purpose of protecting his
principal from loss.
03. (c) There is no legal agreement between the agent and the third party. However, the agent may
negotiate the terms of a contract between the principal and the third party.
04. (c) Jamal is the Principal
05. (c) Agency relationship
AT A GLANCE

06. (b) A person who is incompetent to contract cannot make an agency relationship.
07. (a) The authorised act of agent is binding on the Principal i.e. Naveed.
08. (c) No consideration is necessary in contract of agency.
09. (c) The person should be a major, according to the law to which he is subject and should also be of
sound mind
10. (d) An agency can be expressed or implied.
11. (b) Person of sound mind aged twenty five
12. (d) Power of attorney is written. An agency by words spoken or written is an express agency.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

158 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS

STICKY NOTES

Appointment
1. An agent is a person employed to do any act for another or to represent
another in dealing with third persons.
2. The person for whom such act is done, or who is so represented, is called the
principal.
3. Any person (other than minor and person of unsound mind) may employ an
agent.

AT A GLANCE
4. Any person may become agent.
5. No consideration is necessary in contract of agency.

Authority
1. Express authority (by words spoken or written)
2. Implied authority (inferred from circumstances of the case)
3. Apparent authority (as it appears to third persons)

SPOTLIGHT
4. Authority in emergency (for protecting principal from loss)

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 159


CHAPTER 10: APPOINTMENT AND AUTHORITY OF AGENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

160 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 11

THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
Partnership is the relation between persons who have agreed to
share the profits of a business carried on by all or any of them

AT A GLANCE
AT A GLANCE
acting for all.
SPOTLIGHT Persons who have entered into partnership with one another
are called individually ‘partners’ and collectively a ‘firm’. The
1. Introduction name under which their business is carried on is called the firm
name.
2. Test of Partnership
Law of partnership is an extension of the law of agency.
Partnership is merely an abstract legal relationship between
3. Types of Partnership and
partners. Partnership is a special type of contract and as such all
Partners
the elements of valid contract must be present unless contrary
is required by the Partnership Act, 1932.
4. Objective Based Q&A
In determining, whether a group of persons is or is not a firm, or

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES whether a person is or is not a partner in a firm, regard shall be
had to the real relation between the parties as shown by all
relevant facts taken together.
The test of partnership is mutual agency and not necessarily the
sharing of profits or the contribution of capital or the holding of
a particular property jointly.
A partnership may be for a fixed period of time. Where
no provision is made by the partners for the duration
of the partnership, it is partnership at will. A partnership
for undertaking a particular adventure is called particular

STICKY NOTES
partnership.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 161


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Short Title, Extent And Commencement [Section 1]
The law relating to partnership businesses in Paksitan is the Partnership Act, 1932. It shall be referred to as “the
Act” or “this Act” in this chapter and next two chapters.
This Act came into force on the first day of October 1932 and it is applicable to the whole of Pakistan.

1.2 Definitions [Section 2 and 4]


The Partnership Act, 1932 defines various terms used in the Act as given below. All other expressions shall have
the same meanings as defined under Contract Act, 1872.
 “partnership” is the relation between person who have agreed to share the profits of a business carried
AT A GLANCE

on all or any of them acting for all.


 Persons who have entered into partnership are individually called “partners”.
 Persons who have entered into partnership are collectively called “firm”.
 The name under which the business of partnership is carried on is called the “firm name”.
 An “act of a firm” means any act or omission by all the partners, or by any partner or agent of the firm
which gives rise to a right enforceable by or against the firm.
 “business” includes every trade, occupation and profession.
 “third party” used in relation to firm or to a partner therein means any person who is not a partner in
the firm.
 Example 01:
SPOTLIGHT

Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only.
On first day, on behalf of Solar Traders, Aftab ordered 100 light bulbs on credit from Tanveer, a
wholesaler of electric products.
 Solar Traders is a partnership firm
 Aftab, Badal and Chand each is an individual partner in this partnership firm and
collectively these three partners are the firm with the name Solar Trader.
 Tanveer is a third party in the context of this partnership firm.
 Aftab entered into contract with Tanveer as an agent of the firm, and this contract is an
act of firm. The firm is liable to pay to Tanveer i.e. all three partners are liable.
STICKY NOTES

1.3 Application of Contract Act [Section 3]


Those provisions of Contract Act, 1872 shall continue to apply to firms that are not inconsistent with the
provisions of Partnership Act, 1932.

162 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

2. TEST OF PARTNERSHP
2.1 Mode of determining existence of Partnership [Section 6]
In determining whether a group of persons is or is not a firm or whether a person is or is not a partner in a firm
regard shall be given to the real relationship between the parties as shown by all the relevant facts taken
together i.e.
a) Association of two or more persons
b) Agreement
c) Carrying on business
d) Sharing of profits
e) Mutual agency

AT A GLANCE
2.1.1 Association of two or more persons
The partnership is an association between two or more persons and all persons must be competent to contract.
Thus, there can be no partnership consisting of a single individual. If the number gets reduced to one, for any
reason, it ceases to be a partnership. The partnership Act does not say anything about the maximum number of
partners. However, in company law the following maximum numbers are fixed:
a) In case of a partnership firm carrying on banking business maximum number is 10.
b) In case of a partnership firm carrying on any other business maximum number is 20.
c) In case of a partnership firm of professional persons maximum number may exceed 20.
If the number of partners exceeds the maximum number allowed then such partnership firm becomes an illegal

SPOTLIGHT
association.
 Example 02:
In an MBA class, 28 class fellows decided to form a partnership firm to work collectively as
marketing and advertisement advisors. Such partnership will be illegal association. They should
form a company under Companies Act, 2017.
 Example 03:
After qualifying CA, 28 Chartered Accountants decided to form a partnership firm to work
collectively as Chartered Accountants. Such partnership is allowed under the law.

2.1.2 Agreement

STICKY NOTES
A partnership is a contractual agreement between the partners. This agreement may be express (whether
written or oral) or implied. The written agreement is known as ‘partnership deed’. In Pakistan partnership arises
from contract and not from status such as, (Joint Family Business) operation of law inheritance, or succession.
A partnership deed usually sets out the following:
 Firm name
 Place or principal place of business of the firm
 Names of any other places where the firm carries on business
 The date when each partner joined the firm
 Number of partners
 Names in full and permanent addresses of partners
 Duration of partnership (if any)
 Purpose of the partnership
 Rights and duties of the partners.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 163


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Amount of capital that each partner should put into the business, and keep in the business until the
partner retires or the partnership is dissolved
In Pakistan, if the partnership agreement does not specify what the rights or duties of the partners should be in
particular circumstances, the rules set out in the Partnership Act 1932 are assumed to apply. These are the
‘default rules’ in the absence of anything else.
This means that if a partnership exists but does not have a written agreement, it will be assumed (unless there
is evidence to suggest otherwise) that the rules of the partnership agreement are those contained in the
Partnership Act.
 Example 04:
Azhar and Babar started a business together and share its profit. They made a formal agreement
titled “Partnership deed” and included all possible legal clauses to avoid disputes and confusion
AT A GLANCE

between them in future. It is a valid way of forming a partnership.


 Example 05:
Although there is no express agreement between them, but Arslan regularly buys old furniture
and repairs it and then, his cousin Faisal sells the furniture and they both share the profit equally.
The relation between Arslan and Faisal is partnership, by implied agreement.

2.1.3 Carrying on business


To constitute a partnership, the parties must have agreed to carry on a business. Where there is no business to
be done, there can be no question of partnership. Business here includes any lawful trade, occupation and
profession. An agreement to carry on business at a future time does not result in partnership unless that time
arrives and the business is commenced. If the purpose is to carry on some charitable work it will not be a
SPOTLIGHT

partnership.
 Example 06:
Ghaffar and Jabbar purchased a shop, incurred additional expenses to renovate it contributing in
the ratio of 50:50 and then leased out the shop on rent which was shared equally by them. It
won’t be a partnership as they are co-owners and never carried out any business.

2.1.4 Sharing of profits


The next essential element of partnership is that there must be an objective to make profit. The partners may
agree to share profits in any manner they like. The sharing of profits is a prima facie evidence and not a conclusive
evidence of partnership. Partners may share it equally or in any other proportion. Further, it is not necessary
STICKY NOTES

that the partners should agree to share losses. It must be noted that even though a partner may not share in the
losses of the business, yet his liability towards outsiders shall be unlimited.
 Example 07:
Ahmad and Baqir, two chartered accountants, agree to carry on practice in common at the office
of Ahmad under the name “Ahmad and Baqir” for a period of seven years. The terms of agreement
entered into between them provide that Baqir should manage the office and supervise the clerical
work and that he should draw a fixed allowance of Rs. 20,000 per month in lieu of profits. It is
further agreed that losses, if any, shall be borne by Ahmad alone, and that after seven years
Ahmad would be entitled to the office and all the other equipment, and Baqir would not have any
right, or claim, in respect of them. Are Ahmad and Baqir partners?
Yes, Ahmad and Baqir are partners. In a partnership, partners are free to agree to any term as
regards sharing of profits. Again, sharing of loss is not necessary for becoming a partner. So also,
partners may agree that on the dissolution of their partnership all the assets will belong to one
partner only.

164 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

 Example 08:
Saleem, the licensed proprietor of a theatre, lets the use of it to Jameel for dramatic
entertainments. Saleem manages the theatre and bears all its expenses. He also incurs certain
expenses for advertising and the band. He also collects door money of which he retains half and
hands over the other half to Jameel. There is not partnership, Saleem and Jameel are sharing
revenues and not profits.

2.1.5 Mutual agency


There must exist a mutual agency relationship among partners. Mutual Agency relationship means that each
partner is both an agent and a principal. Each partner is an agent in the sense that he has the capacity to bind
other partners by his acts done. Each partner is principal in the sense that he is bound by the acts of other
partners.

AT A GLANCE
Following two important features of the partnership need to be understood:
 A partnership does not have a legal personality. Unlike a company, it is not a legal person. A third party
entering into business transaction with a partnership does not have a contractual agreement with the
partnership; the contractual agreement is between the third party and all the partners as individuals.
 Partners in a partnership do not have limited liability, and are personally liable for any liabilities of the
partnership business that the partnership cannot pay.
 Example 09:
Ali, Bilal and Chand are partners in a business. Dawood an outsider deals with the firm through
Ali. As between Ali and Dawood, Ali is the principal. But as between Ali, Bilal and Chand, Ali is
also the agent of Bilal and Chand. As such Ali, Bilal and Chand can all sue Dawood. Dawood can

SPOTLIGHT
also sue Ali, Bilal and Chand. Furthermore Ali is accountable to Bilal and Chand because he is an
agent of Bilal and Chand.
Mutual agency relationship in case of a firm of Ali, Bilal and Chand

An act by: Ali Bilal Chand


Who is an agent Ali Bilal Chand
The contract is binding on: Ali, Bilal and Chand
.

2.2 Not a Partnership

STICKY NOTES
2.2.1 Joint or common interest in the property [Section 6]
The sharing of profits or of gross returns arising from property by persons holding a joint or common interest in
that property does not of itself make such persons partners.
 Example 10:
Arslan and Noman are co-owners of a house and let it to a paying guest. They divide the rent
between them. There is no business being carried on and therefore, they are not partners.
The partnership and co-ownership are two different relationships and it is important to understand the
difference between the two:

DIFFERENCE Partnership firm Co-ownership

1. Formation It is created by an agreement alone. Co-ownership is not necessarily a result of


an agreement.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 165


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

DIFFERENCE Partnership firm Co-ownership

2. Business In partnership carrying on business Co-ownership does not necessarily


is an essential. If there will be end of involve the carrying on of a business.
business it will ultimately result in
end of partnership firm.
3. Number of Minimum two competent to contract No limit on maximum number of co-
persons persons are required and a owners.
maximum of 20 persons can carry
partnership other than banking
business.
AT A GLANCE

4. Sharing of profit Sharing of profit is one of the It does not involve sharing of profit.
essential elements.

5. Mutual agency A partner is an agent of the firm for Co-owners are not agents to one another.
the purpose of business of the firm.

6. Transfer of A partner cannot transfer his Co-owner can transfer his interest without
interest interest without getting consent getting consent from other co-owner(s).
from other partners.

 Example 11:
Jazib and Ghalib jointly purchased a tea shop and incurred additional expenses for purchasing
SPOTLIGHT

pottery and some other materials to furnish the shop. The money was contributed half and half
and then the rented out the shop. The rent has to be shared equally by them. They are only co-
owners and not partners as they never carried on any business.
 Example 12:
Ahmad and Rizwan are joint owners of a ship. Ahmad works on the ship, takes the entire
management of it, and meets all the expenses. He takes two-thirds of gross earnings and pays
over the balance to Rizwan who does nothing. There is no partnership. They are sharing gross
revenue and not profits.

2.2.2 Sharing of Profits is not a Conclusive Evidence of Partnership [Section 6]


STICKY NOTES

The receipts by a person of a share of the profits of a business, or of a payment contingent upon profits of
business, does not of itself make him a partner with the persons carrying on the business.
 Example 13:
Hussain, a publisher agrees to publish at his own expense, a book written by Burhan and to pay
Burhan half the net profits. Hussain and Burhan are not partners. Hussain is simply paying
Burhan royalty by way of profits.
In particular, the receipt of share of profit or payment contingent upon profit by following persons does not of
itself make them a partner with the persons carrying on the business:
a) Lender of money to persons engaged or about to engage in any business
b) Servant or agent as remuneration
c) Widow or child of a deceased partner as annuity
d) A transferee of a partner’s interest
e) A minor who is admitted to the benefits of an existing partnership
f) Previous owner or part owner as consideration for the sale of goodwill or share of it.

166 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

 Example 14:
A customer is not a partner of the bank in which he has profit or loss sharing account.
 Example 15:
Raheem, a clerk in Kareem’s business, entered into a verbal agreement with Kareem for 10%
share of profit, rather than a fixed salary. It was further agreed that the building in which the
business was carried on should remain the property of Kareem and all work and decisions will
be solely decided by Kareem. Raheem alleges that he is a partner and claims dissolution of the
firm. Kareem denies the partnership, and alleges that Raheem is only a clerk. In view of the
surrounding circumstances of the case it is evident that Raheem is only a clerk. It is an established
fact that sharing of profits is not the sole test of partnership.
 Example 16:

AT A GLANCE
Moiz, Adeeb and Mumtaz were partners in a firm. Adeeb died. Moiz and Mumtaz continued the
business and agreed to give 10% share of profits of business to the widow of Adeeb as annuity.
Discuss whether Adeeb’s widow would be deemed to be a partner in the firm.
No, Adeeb’s widow is not a partner in the firm. The receipt by a person of a share of the profits of
a business, is a prima facie evidence of the existence of partnership. However, the receipt by the
widow of a deceased partner, as annuity, does not of itself make the receiver a partner with the
persons carrying on the business. In determining whether Adeeb’s widow is a partner in the firm
regard shall be had to the presence of mutual agency relationship among Moiz, Mumtaz and
Adeeb’s widow, which is a conclusive evidence, of the presence of partnership, and which in this
case does not exist.

2.2.3 Loan from Banking Company [Section 6A]

SPOTLIGHT
The Partnership Act, 1932 shall not apply to a relationship created by any agreement between a banking
company and a person or group of persons providing for sharing of profit and losses arising from or relating to
the provisions by a banking company of finance to such person or group of persons.
 Example 17:
Amjad applied for a loan from ABC Bank for his business. It was decided that bank will get 20%
of profit or loss, in lieu of interest. There is no partnership between Amjad and ABC Bank.

2.2.4 Partnership Not Created by Status [Section 5]


The relation of partnership arises from contract and not from status.

STICKY NOTES
 Example 18:
In particular, the members of Hindu undivided family carrying on a family business as such, or a
Burmese Buddhist husband and wife carrying on business as such are not partners in such
business. Although, they are carrying business together but the relationship between them has
not arisen from contract.
 Practice Question 01:
Sharing net profits usually creates a very strong inference that the parties have formed a
partnership. But in certain situations, the fact that the profits are shared or the parties have
agreed to share the profits will not by itself create a presumption that a partnership was
intended. List such situations as given in the Partnership Act, 1932.
 Solution:
These situations are:
 The joint owners of a property who share profits or gross returns arising from the
property are not partners.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 167


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Where the profits are received by a creditor in payment of a debt or as interest on


loan.
 Where the profits are received as wages by an employee.
 Where the profits are received as an annuity by a widow or child of a deceased
partner.
 Where the profits are received as consideration for the sale of property/goodwill
or share thereof.
 A transferee of a partner’s interest.
 A minor who is admitted to the benefits of an existing partnership.
 Practice Question 02:
Munaf, a sole proprietor, engaged in the business of selling cooking oil to wholesalers agreed to
AT A GLANCE

admit Lari in his business on the following terms:


That Lari shall not bring any capital and shall not be liable for any losses of the firm. However, he
shall be entitled to receive Rs. 150,000 on introducing any new client to the business, share 40%
of the profits and have the right to exercise all the powers of a partner in the firm.
Analyse the above situation and advise whether a partnership is constituted between Munaf and
Lari under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932.
 Solution:
In determining whether Munaf and Lari constitute a partnership, regard shall be had to the real
relation between the parties, as shown by all relevant facts taken together.
The essentials of a partnership are:
SPOTLIGHT

i. There should be a relationship by agreement between two or more persons;


ii. They should run a business with the intention of sharing profits; and
iii. The business should be run by all, or by any one of them acting for all.
The Partnership Act does not require that a partner must contribute money or capital. Similarly
the partners may also agree that any one of them shall not be liable for losses. Thus, in the
presence of the above essentials and the fact that Lari is entitled to exercise all the powers of a
partner Munaf and Lari are said to have constituted a partnership.
 Practice Question 03:
The sharing of profit is a prima facie evidence but not a conclusive test of partnership’. Under the
STICKY NOTES

provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 list the circumstances in which receipt by a person of a
share of profits of a business does not of itself make him a partner with the persons carrying on
the business.
 Solution:
Under the following circumstances the receipt by a person of a share of profits of a business does
not of itself make him a partner with the persons carrying on the business:
i. where profit or payment is received by a lender of money from persons engaged or about
to engage in any business
ii. by a servant or agent as a remuneration
iii. by the widow or child of a deceased partner, as annuity
iv. by the previous owner or part owner of the business, as consideration for the sale of
goodwill or share thereof
v. by a transferee of a partner’s interest

168 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

vi. by the persons holding a joint or a common interest in any property


vii. by the minor who is admitted to the benefits of existing partnership
viii. by a sub partner from a partner in the firm.
 Practice Question 04:
X has been carrying on textile business for the past few years. He has recently met Y who is an
expert in textile designing. X and Y have agreed that Y would advise X on various technical issues
and use his contacts for the benefit of the business. Y would be entitled to 35% of the profits of
the business. However, Y will not be required to bring any capital and will not take part in the
day to day affairs of the business.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 analyse the above situation and advise
whether partnership exists between X and Y.

AT A GLANCE
 Solution:
In determining whether X and Y are partners, regard shall be had to the real relationship between
the partners, as shown by all the relevant facts taken together.
A partnership exists where following conditions are complied with:
i. There is an agreement between two or more persons;
ii. They run a business with the intention of sharing profits; and
iii. The business is run by all, or by any one of them acting for all.
The Partnership Act, does not require that a partner must contribute money or capital in the
partnership.

SPOTLIGHT
Therefore, since both X and Y have a common interest in the same business in which they are
sharing profit and have a mutual agency relationship between them, partnership does exist in
the above situation unless it can be proved that the real relationship of being partners does not
exist.
 Practice Question 05:
The sharing of profit is a prima facie evidence of partnership. Under the provisions of the
Partnership Act, 1932 list any four circumstances in which a non-partner could benefit from the
profits of a partnership.
 Solution:

STICKY NOTES
Following are the circumstances in which a non-partner could benefit from the profits of a
partnership:
 Lender of money to persons engaged or about to engage in any business
 Servant or agent as remuneration
 Widow or child of a deceased partner as annuity
 Transferee of a partner’s interest
 A minor who is admitted to the benefits of partnership
 Previous owner or part owner as consideration for the sale of goodwill or share thereof.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 169


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. TYPES OF PARTNERSHIP AND PARTNERS


3.1 Types of Partnership

3.1.1 Partnership-at-will [Section 7]


Where no provision is made between the partners for the duration of their partnership, or for the determination
of their partnership, the partnership is called partnership at will. In such partnership there is no provision as to
when the partnership will come to an end. Any partner is free to dissolve the partnership by giving a notice in
writing to all other partners of his intention to dissolve the firm. The firm is dissolved as from the date mentioned
in the notice as the date of dissolution or if no date is mentioned as from the date of the communication of the
notice.
If freedom to dissolve the firm at will is curtailed by agreement, like if the agreement provides that the
AT A GLANCE

partnership can be dissolved by mutual consent of all the partners, only then will it not constitute a partnership
at will.
 Example 19:
Azam and Babar are partners in a firm. There is no formal express agreement and no duration
fixed. Azam does not want to continue. This is partnership at will and he may give a reasonable
notice of his intention to dissolve the firm to Babar and firm will be dissolved from the date
mentioned in the notice.
 Example 20:
Azam, Babar and Misbah are partners in a firm. The partnership deed states that firm can only
be dissolved with mutual consent of all the partners although no duration is fixed. Azam does not
SPOTLIGHT

want to continue. This is not partnership at will and he can dissolve the partnership only if Babar
and Misbah also agree.

3.1.2 Particular partnership [Section 8]


Where a partnership is created for any particular adventure or undertaking or for a specific time period it is
called a particular partnership. Such partnership comes to an end on the completion of venture or on the expiry
of the period.
If the partners decide to continue such a partnership even after the expiry of the specific period or completion of
specific venture then it becomes partnership at will.
 Example 21:
STICKY NOTES

Anum and Maha entered into a partnership agreement specifically for an interior designing
project. This is particular partnership and it shall come to an end on completion of the project.
 Example 22:
Adeel and Saima entered into a partnership agreement for 10 years. This is a particular
partnership. However, on completion of 10 years, they decided to continue the partnership, now
their partnership is partnership at will.

3.2 Types of Partners

3.2.1 Actual or ostensible partner


A partner who is actively engaged in the conduct of a business is called actual or ostensible partner. Such a
partner is an agent of all other partners for the purposes of the business of the firm. He can bind himself and
other partners for the acts done in the ordinary course of the business.

170 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

 Example 23:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only.
Aftab is active or ostensible partner.

3.2.2 Sleeping or dormant partner


A sleeping partner is not known as such as a partner to third parties dealing with the firm. He may or may not
take active part in the conduct of the business of the firm. He, like other partners, invests capital and shares in
the profits of the business. He is equally liable along with other partners for all the debts of the firm, even though
his existence is kept a secret from the outsiders dealing with the firm.
Note: A sleeping partner is not required to give public notice of his retirement and he is not liable for any act
done by the firm after his retirement.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 24:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and the existence of Badal and Chand as partners will be kept secret from outsiders. Badal and
Chand are sleeping partners.

3.2.3 Nominal partner


A partner who does not contribute any capital or share in profits, but lends his name to the firm is called a
nominal partner. He along with other partners is liable to the outsiders for all the debts of the firm.
 Example 25:

SPOTLIGHT
Azam and Babar started a law firm. They also requested a retired senior lawyer Arif to join in.
Arif stated that they can use his name as partner but he would not be able to give his time to the
firm and that he would not share in profits as well. Arif is a nominal partner and would still be
liable to outsiders for the acts of firm.

3.2.4 Partner in profits only


A partner may agree that a partner shall get a share of the profits only and that he shall not be liable to contribute
towards the losses. But for third parties he is liable for all the debts of the firm.
 Example 26:
Adeel and Kashif are partners in a firm. The terms of agreement are that they will share profit in

STICKY NOTES
the ratio of 3:2 but in case of loss, all loss shall be borne by Adeel only. Here, Kashif is partner in
profits only.

3.2.5 Sub-partner
When a partner agrees to share his profits derived from the firm with a stranger, that stranger is known as a sub-
partner. A sub-partner is in no way connected with the firm and cannot represent himself as a partner of the firm.
He has no rights against the firm nor is he liable for the acts of the firm.
 Example 27:
Adeel and Kashif are partners in a firm. The terms of agreement are that they will share profit in
the ratio of 3:2. Unknown to Kashif, Adeel further agrees with his friend Adnan to share half of
his individual share from partnership with Kashif. Adnan is a sub-partner.

3.2.6 Silent partner


Those who by agreement with other partners have no voice in the management of the partnership business. They
share profit and losses, are fully liable for the debts of the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 171


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 28:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management although their existence shall
be known to outsiders. Badal and Chand are silent partners.

3.2.7 Partner by estoppel or holding out [Section 28(1)]


Where a person:
 Holds himself out as a partner; or
 Allows others to do it
they are then stopped from denying the character he has assumed and upon the faith of which creditors may be
AT A GLANCE

presumed to have acted.


 Example 29:
Paras represents to Rizwan that he is a partner in the firm of Arslan, Noman and Ali, while
actually he is not a partner. On the faith of this representation Rizwan gives credit to the firm.
The firm becomes insolvent subsequently. Rizwan can make Paras liable on the basis of holding
out and Paras is estopped from denying that he is a partner in the firm.
 Practice Question 06:
In view of the Partnership Act, 1932, briefly explain the meaning of ‘Partnership at Will’ and
‘Particular Partnership’.
 Solution:
SPOTLIGHT

Where no provision is made by contract between the partners for the duration of their
partnership, or for the determination of their partnership, the partnership is ‘partnership at will’.
When a partnership is formed for a particular period or for a specific venture, e.g. for working a
coal mine, or producing a film, it is called a ‘particular partnership’.
STICKY NOTES

172 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

4. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. X and Y formed a partnership firm to undertake construction of a shopping plaza. Such a partnership is
called:
(a) limited partnership
(b) particular partnership
(c) partnership at will
(d) implied partnership

02. The conclusive evidence of a partnership is:

AT A GLANCE
(a) mutual agency
(b) sharing of profit and loss
(c) mutual understanding
(d) capital contribution

03. Partnership is:


(a) the relationship between persons who have agreed to share the profits of jointly owned property
managed by all or any of them acting for all
(b) the relationship created by an agreement between a banking company and person(s) providing for
sharing of profit and loss arising from the finance provided to such person(s)

SPOTLIGHT
(c) both of the above
(d) the relation between persons arising from a contract who have agreed to share the profits of a
business carried on by all or any of them acting for all

04. Relation of partnership


(a) Arises by legal status of the persons.
(b) Arises out of business dealings
(c) Arises out of a contract between persons

STICKY NOTES
(d) Arises out of legal implications

05. Partnership firm has:


(a) Separate legal entity from partners if the firm is registered
(b) No separate legal entity
(c) Separate legal entity
(d) Separate legal entity distinct from the partner

06. The persons who have entered into partnership with one another are collectively called:
(a) Co-owners
(b) Company
(c) Partnership
(d) Firm

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 173


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

07. The relation of partnership arises from:


(a) Status
(b) Birth
(c) Contract
(d) Inheritance

08. Which of the following statement is correct?


(a) A partnership contract must be expressed in writing only.
(b) A partnership contract must be expressed either in writing or orally.
AT A GLANCE

(c) A partnership contract may be expressed (in writing only) or implied.


(d) A partnership contract may be expressed (either in writing or orally) or implied.

09. In order to form a partnership, the parties contact to share:


(a) Only losses
(b) Only profits
(c) Both profits and losses
(d) Profits and losses but some partners may share in profits only
SPOTLIGHT

10. Where the partnership is at will, the firm may be dissolved by any partner giving notice, of his intention
to dissolve the firm, in writing to
(a) Any one of the partners
(b) All the other partners
(c) Two partners
(d) Three partners
STICKY NOTES

174 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

ANSWERS
01. (b) Particular partnership

02. (a) Mutual agency

03. (d) Partnership is the relation between persons arising from a contract who have agreed to
share the profits of a business carried on by all or any of them acting for all.

04. (c) In Pakistan partnership arises from contract and not from status.

05. (b) A partnership does not have a legal personality. Unlike a company, it is not a legal person.

AT A GLANCE
06. (d) ‘Firm’ represents all the partners collectively.

07. (c) The status of partnership arises from contract only.

08. (d) A partnership contract may be expressed (either in writing or orally) or implied.

09. (d) Profits and losses but some partners may share in profits only

10. (b) Notice to all the other partners is required.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 175


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

“Partnership” is the relation between persons who have agreed to share the profits
of a business carried on by all or any of them acting for all.
Persons who have entered into partnership with one another called individually
“partners” and collectively “a firm” and the name under which their business is
carried on is called the “firm name”.
AT A GLANCE

Factors to determine existence of partnership include:


1. Association of two or more persons
2. Agreement
3. Caryying on business
4. Sharing of profits
5. Mutual agency

Not a Partnership
1. Joint or common interest in the property is not a partnership.
SPOTLIGHT

2. Sharing of profits is not a conclusive evidence of partnership


a) Lender of money to persons engaged or about to engage in any
business
b) Servant or agent as remuneration
c) Widow or child of a deceased partner as annuity
d) A transferee of a partner’s interest
e) A minor who is admitted to the benefits of an existing partnership
f) Previous owner or part owner as consideration for the sale of
goodwill or share of it.
3. Loan from banking company (even if non-interest based) does not create
STICKY NOTES

a partnership relationship.
4. Partnership is created by contract and not status.

Types of Partnership
1. Partnership at will: There is no provision as to when the partnership will
end.
2. Particular partnership: Such partnership comes to an end on the
completion of particular adventure or on the expiry of the period.

176 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP

Types of Partners
1. Actual or ostensible partner
2. Sleeping or dormant partner
3. Nominal partner
4. Partner in profits only
5. Sub-partner
6. Silent partner
7. Partner by estoppel or holding out

AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 177


CHAPTER 11: THE NATURE OF PARTNERSHIP CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

178 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 12

RELATIONS OF PARTNERS
TO ONE ANOTHER

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
Every partner has duty to carry on business to the greatest
common advantage, to be just and faithful, to render true
AT A GLANCE
accounts and provide all relevant information relating to the
firm. A partner must also indemnify his co-partners for loss
SPOTLIGHT
caused by his fraud.
1. The Duties, Rights and The rights and duties of partners are usually included in
Liabilities of Partners partnership contract which may made and varied expressly or
impliedly.
2. The Property of the Firm
In relation to conduct of business, every partner has right to take
part in management and to access the books, also has duty to
3. Objective Based Q&A
attend diligently to his duties. The decisions are made by simple

SPOTLIGHT
majority, however change in nature of business and
STICKY NOTES
introduction of new partner requires unanimous consent.
In absence of partnership contract, there is no right to
remuneration, equal profit sharing, loss sharing in same ratio as
profit, no interest on capital, 6% interest on advances from
partner to firm, right to be indemnified for proper expenses and
duty to indemnify the firm for wilful neglect. Further, personal
profits earned by a partner, without consent of other partners,
using firm name or connection and from competing business are
to be accounted for and paid to the firm.
The Partnership Act, 1932 also requires, subject to contract, that

STICKY NOTES
property of the firm shall be used exclusively for the business of
firm. The property of the firm includes all property and rights
and interests in property originally brought into the stock of the
firm, or acquired by purchase or otherwise, by or for the firm, or
for the purposes and in the course of the business of the firm,
and also includes the goodwill of the business.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 179


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. THE DUTIES, RIGHTS AND LIABILITIES OF PARTNERS


1.1 General duties of partner
These are mandatory duties of a partner that cannot be changed by an agreement amongst the partners. These
are:

1.1.1 Duty to carry on business to the greatest common advantage [Section 9]


Partners are bound to carry on the business of the firm to the greatest common advantage.
 Example 01:
Saleem, Naeem, Kareem and Raheem established a partnership for refining sugar. Raheem was
considered expert in the job of buying sugar. Thus he was entrusted with the duty of purchasing
AT A GLANCE

sugar for the firm. Ajmal, cousin of Rahim, was a wholesale dealer in sugar. Raheem bought sugar
from Ajmal despite the fact that the rate was higher than the market rate for same quality.
Raheem has breached his duty to carry on business to greatest common advantage of all the
partners.

1.1.2 Duty to be just and faithful [Section 9]


Partners are bound to be just and faithful to each other.
 Example 02:
Saleem, Naeem, Kareem and Raheem established a partnership for refining sugar. Raheem was
considered expert in the job of buying sugar. Thus he was entrusted with the duty of purchasing
sugar for the firm. Raheem himself was a wholesale dealer in sugar. He, unknown to his co-
SPOTLIGHT

partners, supplied to the firm, at the market price, with sugar previously bought by himself from
his own resources when the price was lower, and he so made considerable profit. Saleem, Naeem
and Kareem sued for the profits thus made by him. Yes Raheem is accountable to the firm for the
profit thus made by him because he had failed in his duty to observe utmost good faith towards
other partners and to make fullest disclosure of all facts to them.

1.1.3 Duty to render true accounts [Section 9]


Partners are bound to render true accounts of the firm’s transactions to any partner or his legal representative.
 Example 03:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
STICKY NOTES

Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. Aftab must render true
accounts of the firm to Badal and Chand.

1.1.4 Duty to provide full information [Section 9]


Partners are bound to render full information of all things affecting the firm to any partner or his legal
representative.
 Example 04:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. Aftab must provide full
information of all things affecting the firm to Badal and Chand.

180 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

1.1.5 Duty to indemnify for loss caused by fraud [Section 10]


Every partner shall indemnify (compensate) the firm for any loss caused to it by his fraud in the conduct of the
business of the firm.
 Example 05:
Habib, Arslan and Adeel are partners in a firm. Habib sold an item to third party by fraud without
consent of Arslan and Adeel. The firm had to pay the compensation and bear the loss. Habib must
indemnify Arslan and Adeel for loss so caused to them.

1.2 Rights and Duties by Contract [Section 11]


Other than compulsory rights and duties specified by the Act, the mutual rights and duties of the partners of a
firm may be determined by contract between the parties.

AT A GLANCE
Such contract may be:
a) Express; or
b) Implied by a course of dealings.

Variation in Partnership Contract


The partnership contract may be varied by consent of all the partners, and such consent may be express or may
be implied by a course of dealings.
 Example 06:
Badar, Nazar and Zafar agreed to form a partnership. The partnership deed, inter-alia, provided
that all the three shall share the profits equally. Afterwards they carried on the partnership

SPOTLIGHT
business for many years, Badar receiving one-half of the net profits and the other half being
equally divided between Nazar and Zafar, to which Nazar and Zafar never objected. Later, the
partnership developed some differences and as such Nazar and Zafar file a suit for their share of
profits for the past years on the basis of the partnership deed. Nazar and Zafar’s suit is not
maintainable because by accepting profits for past many years in a ratio different from the agreed
ratio they have impliedly consented to the variation in the contract (i.e. partnership deed).

Agreement in Restraint of Trade


The Contract Act, 1872 declares agreements in restraint of trade to be void. However, the Partnership Act, 1932
creates an exception to it i.e. partnership contracts may provide that a partner shall not carry on any business
other than that of the firm while he is a partner.

STICKY NOTES
1.3 Rights and Duties relating to the Conduct of the Business [Section 12]
These rights and duties are subject to contract between the partners i.e. these can be changed by contract
amongst the partners:

1.3.1 Right to take part in the conduct of the business


Every partner has a right to take part in the conduct of the business.
 Example 07:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. The right to take part in
management is available to all of them, it is just that Badal and Chand agreed not to participate
and become silent partners.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 181


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.3.2 Duty to attend diligently to his duties


Every partner is bound to attend diligently to his duties in the conduct of the business.
 Example 08:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. Aftab must attend diligently
to his duties. This duty does not apply to Badal and Chand as they are silent partners according
to agreement.

1.3.3 Decision Making / Right to be consulted


Every partner has the right to be consulted before any matter is decided. Any difference arising as to ordinary
AT A GLANCE

matters connected with the business may be decided by a majority of the partners in good faith but no change
may be made in the nature of the business without the consent of all the partners.
 Example 09:
Azam, Babar, Yasir and Zahid are active partners in a partnership. Azam wants to open a bank
account in ABC Bank for partnership business. However, Zahid is of the opinion that they should
have an account in XYZ Bank. The matter must be decided by the decision of majority of the
partners.
 Example 10:
Azam, Babar, Yasir and Zahid are active partners in a partnership. Babar, Yasir and Zahid want
to change the nature of business from retailer of yarn to manufacturer of sugar but Azam does
not agree. Unless all the partners agree, nature of business cannot be changed.
SPOTLIGHT

1.3.4 Right to have access to the books


Every partner has a right to have access to and to inspect and copy any of the books of the firm.
 Example 11:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. Badal and Chand (and also
Aftab) have right to access and inspect books of accounts of the firm.

1.4 Mutual Rights and Liabilities [Section 13]


STICKY NOTES

These rights and liabilities are mutual and are also subject to contract between the partners i.e. these can be
changed by contract amongst the partners:

1.4.1 Remuneration
A partner is not entitled to receive remuneration for taking part in the conduct of the business. It is, however,
usual to allow some remuneration to the working partners provided there is a specific agreement to that effect.
 Example 12:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only
and Badal and Chand will not take any active part in management. Aftab is not entitled to
remuneration for his work unless specifically agreed by the partners.

182 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

1.4.2 Sharing Profits and Losses


In the absence of a contract to the contrary every partner has a right to share profits equally earned by the firm.
The partners are bound to contribute to the losses sustained by the firm. An agreement to share profits may
imply an agreement to share losses also.
 Example 13:
Adeel and Kashif started a partnership business by contributing Rs. 5 million and Rs. 7 million
respectively. However, they did not decide the profit sharing ratio. They will share profit equally.
 Example 14:
Adeel and Kashif are partners in a firm. The terms of agreement are that they will share profit in
the ratio of 3:2 but there is no express provision regarding sharing of loss. The agreement implies

AT A GLANCE
that they will share losses in the ratio of 3:2 as well.

1.4.3 Interest on Capital


No partner is allowed to receive any interest on capital as a general rule because a partner is not a creditor of the
firm. Interest on capital is allowed only when agreed among the partners.
Where a partner is entitled to interest on the capital subscribed investment by him such interest will be payable
out of the profits, earned by the firm.
 Example 15:
Adeel and Kashif started a partnership business by contributing Rs. 5 million and Rs. 7 million
respectively and agreed to share profits in the ratio of 3:2. They did not decide anything
regarding interest on their respective capital. Kashif demands 10% interest should be given by

SPOTLIGHT
the firm to both the partners. In absence of specific agreement, there shall be no interest on
capital.

1.4.4 Interest on Advance (Loan) from Partner


Where a partner makes for the purpose of the business, any payment or advance beyond the amount of capital
he has agreed to subscribe, he is entitled to interest on it at the rate of 6% per annum or as agreed upon.
 Example 16:
Adeel and Kashif started a partnership business by contributing Rs. 5 million and Rs. 7 million
respectively and Adeel also advance Rs. 1 million to the firm as loan. They did not decide anything
regarding interest on this loan. Adeel demands 10% interest should be given by the firm to him

STICKY NOTES
on this loan. In absence of specific agreement, interest @6% shall be paid to Adeel on his loan to
the firm.

1.4.5 Right to be indemnified


Every partner has a right to claim indemnity from the firm in respect of payments made or liabilities incurred by
him:
a) In the ordinary and proper conduct of the business; and
b) In doing such act, in an emergency, for the purpose of protecting the firm from loss, as would be done by
a person of ordinary prudence, in his own case, under similar circumstances.
 Example 17:
Saima and Naima are partners in a firm. Saima paid insurance premium from her own pocket in
order to protect firm’s inventory when there was chance of damage by rain water. She also paid
for shelves to keep the inventory safe. She is entitled to be reimbursed by the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 183


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.4.6 Duty to indemnify for wilful neglect


Every partner is under a duty to indemnify the firm for any loss caused to it by his wilful neglect (i.e. failure to
perform a duty or to do something which the partner should have done) in the conduct of the business of the
firm.
 Example 18:
Habib and Tanveer are partners in a firm. Habib was entrusted with monitoring inventory levels
to avoid stock shortages on weekly basis. Habib neglected the work for many months due to
which the firm suffered the loss. Habib must compensate the firm for loss caused due to his
neglect.
1.5 Personal Profits earned by Partners [Section 16]
1.5.1 Duty to account for personal profits derived
AT A GLANCE

A partner must ‘account to the firm’ for any benefit obtained, without the consent of the other partners, from any
transaction involving the partnership, the partnership property, the partnership name or the partnership’s
business connection. In other words, if a partner uses the partnership property, name or business connections
to make a secret profit (a personal profit that the other partners do not know about), the other partners can claim
those profits for the partnership.
 Example 19:
Tom and Jerry are in partnership. The partnership purchased an item of equipment costing
Rs.30,000. It was discovered later that the equipment had actually been purchased by Tom for
Rs.18,000, and Tom had re-sold it to the partnership without revealing that he was the owner of
the property.
In this case, since the other partner did not know that Tom had made a personal profit from the
SPOTLIGHT

transaction with the partnership, he can claim successfully that Tom should hand over to the
partnership the Rs.12,000 profit that he made.
If Tom had informed Jerry in advance that he was the owner of the equipment and intended to
keep the profit himself, and if Jerry agreed to this, Tom would have been able to keep all the profit
for himself.

1.5.2 Duty not to compete with the business of the firm


Similarly, if a partner competes in business (as in the case of personal profit) with the partnership, without the
consent of the other partners, he is liable to account to the partnership for all the profits that he earns from the
competing business.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 20:
Azam, Babar, Yasir and Zahid are in partnership. Without informing the other partners, Zahid
sets up a sole trader’s business in competition with the partnership, and makes a profit of Rs.
50,000 by either, using firm name or property or connections of the firm. When the other
partners find out what Zahid has been doing, they can require Zahid to account to the partnership
for the profits he has made while operating in competition (and hand over the Rs. 50,000 to the
partnership).
1.6 Rights and Duties of Partners after a change in firm [Section 17]
Subject to contract between the partners, the mutual rights and duties of the partners remain the same as they
were immediately before the change in following situations:
a) Where a change occurs in the constitution of a firm e.g. introduction of new partner or retirement of a
partner.
b) Where a firm constituted for a fixed term continues to carry on business after expiry of that term.
c) Where a firm constituted to carry out one or more adventures or undertakings carries out additional
adventures or undertakings.

184 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

 Example 21:
Azam, Babar, Yasir and Zahid are partners in a partnership sharing profit and losses equally.
Zahid retired and others continued the business. In reconstituted firm, Azam, Babar and Yasir
shall share the profit and losses equally too, unless otherwise agreed.
 Practice Question 01:
Rafiq, Bari and Furqan have decided to establish a partnership business for trading in medical
equipment. In the absence of any express contract, advise them of their mutual rights and
liabilities under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932.
 Solution:
In the absence of any express contract:

AT A GLANCE
i. every partner has a right to take part in the conduct of the business;
ii. every partner shall have the right to express his opinion before a matter is decided. Any
difference arising as to ordinary matters connected with the business may be decided
by a majority of the partners, but no change may be made in the nature of the business
without the consent of all the partners;
iii. every partner has a right to have access to and to inspect and copy any of the books of
the firm;
iv. a partner is not entitled to receive remuneration for taking part in the conduct of the
business;
v. the partners are entitled to share equally in the profits earned and shall contribute
equally to the losses sustained by the firm;

SPOTLIGHT
vi. where a partner is entitled to interest on the capital subscribed by him such interest
shall be payable only out of the profits;
vii. a partner making, for the purposes of the business, any payment or advance beyond the
amount of capital he has agreed to subscribe, is entitled to interest thereon at the rate of
six percent per annum;
viii. the firm shall indemnify a partner in respect of payments made and liabilities incurred
by him:
 in the ordinary and proper conduct of the business, and
 in doing such act, in an emergency, for the purpose of protecting the firm from loss,

STICKY NOTES
as would be done by a person of ordinary prudence, in his own case, under similar
circumstances; and
ix. a partner shall indemnify the firm for any loss caused to it by his wilful neglect in the
conduct of the business of the firm.
 Practice Question 02:
On 1 July 2016 Abid, Rizwan and Salman started a partnership business and contributed Rs.
200,000 each towards the firm’s capital. They also agreed to share profits in equal proportion.
Abid, in addition to his capital contribution, paid Rs. 100,000 to one of the suppliers as a security
deposit. All the partners are entitled to interest at the rate of 8% on their capital. However, during
the year, the firm incurred a loss of Rs. 80,000.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 state the amount of interest, if any, payable to
each partner.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 185


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
Where a partner is entitled to interest on capital such interest is required to be paid only out of
profits of the firm. During the year, since the firm has incurred a loss, all the partners are not
entitled to receive any interest on their capital. However, any partner making any payment, for
the purpose of the business, beyond the amount of his capital contribution, is entitled to interest
thereon at the rate of 6% per annum. Therefore, Abid is entitled to receive Rs. 6,000 on the
amount paid as a security deposit.
 Practice Question 03:
Sohail, Talha, Umair & Co., a partnership concern is engaged in trading of cloth. The firm bought
a plot of land from Shining Star Limited. After some time Talha and Umair on their own account
bought three more plots of land in the same locality and made good profits. Sohail on becoming
aware of such profits sued Talha and Umair for his share.
AT A GLANCE

Under the provisions of Partnership Act 1932, explain whether Talha and Umair are liable to
share such profits with Sohail.
 Solution:
No, Talha and Umair are not liable to share such profits with Sohail as this transaction was not
within the scope of the partnership.
Subject to the contract between the partners, the partner shall account for that profit and pay it
to the firm, which:
a) he derives for himself, from any transaction of the firm, or from the use of the property
or business connection of the firm or the firm’s name; or
b) he made for himself, from carrying on any business of the same nature as and
SPOTLIGHT

competing with that of the firm.


 Practice Question 04:
Gul, Raza and Sami are partners in GRS Garments. Raza discovered that a supplier MP offers
reasonable rates for consumables stores and put forth a resolution that MP should be included
in the firm’s list of suppliers. MP is owned by Gul and managed by his brother but Gul did not
disclose this fact. When Raza and Sami became aware of the fact, they asked Gul to share with
them the profits earned by MP on transactions with GRS. Under the provisions of the Partnership
Act, 1932 discuss whether Gul is bound to share the profits as demanded by Raza and Sami.
 Solution:
Subject to contract between the partners, if Gul had derived any profit for himself from any
STICKY NOTES

transactions with the firm then Gul shall account for that profit and pay it to the firm. A partner
has duty to give full information to the other partners, in relation to everything affecting the
partnership.
 Practice Question 05:
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 state the mandatory duties of partners which
cannot be modified by an agreement amongst them.
 Solution:
Following are the mandatory duties of a partner that cannot be changed by an agreement
amongst the partners:
 Duty to be just and faithful.
 Duty to carry on business to the greatest common advantage.
 Duty to render true accounts.
 Duty to provide full information.
 Duty to indemnify for loss caused by fraud.

186 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

 Practice Question 06:


Aftab, Rehan and Bali were partners in a law firm. The partnership deed, among other things,
provided that the profits or losses of the firm would be shared equally among the partners. The
firm continued its business for many years with Aftab receiving fifty percent share in the net
profit and Rehan and Bali each sharing twenty-five percent of the net profit. Rehan and Bali never
objected to this arrangement. Later on, partners developed some differences and Rehan and Bali
filed a suit against Aftab for the recovery of their share in profits on the basis of partnership deed.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 discuss whether Aftab would succeed in
defending the suit filed against him by Rehan and Bali.
 Solution:
The contract between the partners may be varied by consent of all the partners, and such consent
may be expressed or may be implied by a course of dealing.

AT A GLANCE
In view of above, the suit filed by Rehan and Bali against Aftab is not maintainable because by
accepting profits for the past many years in a ratio different from the agreed ratio they have
impliedly consented to the variation in the contract. i.e. partnership deed.
 Practice Question 07:
Asghar, Babar and Careem are carrying on agricultural business in partnership. They have agreed
to share the profits in the ratio of 4:3:2 respectively. Careem is not liable for the losses of the firm.
Asghar, who is responsible for procurement, has suggested to buy seeds and pesticides from
Zubair Enterprises, a supplier of crop products, as the seeds and pesticides offered by him are of
good quality and at a very reasonable price. However, Babar is not in agreement with Asghar.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 analyse and comment.

SPOTLIGHT
 Solution:
Subject to contract between the partners, a partner can bind the firm by his actions. However, in
case of differences, decision should be made by majority of the partners. Asghar cannot take
decision without consultation with other partners. Every partner has a right to express his
opinion before the matter is decided.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 187


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. THE PROPERTY OF THE FIRM


2.1 Partnership Property [Section 14]
Subject to contract between the partners, the property of the firm includes:
a) All property originally brought into the common stock of the firm
b) All rights or interest in the property originally so brought
c) All property acquired, by purchase or otherwise, by or for the firm and all rights and interest in any
property so acquired and
d) Goodwill of the business of the firm
Unless any contrary intention appears any property purchased with partnership money without other partners’
AT A GLANCE

consent will be deemed to be partnership property.

What is Goodwill?
Goodwill is an accounting concept meaning the value of an intangible asset which has a quantifiable value in a
business. An example would be the reputation the firm enjoys with its customers. This reputation enables the
firm to earn more than the normal profits earned by the business as a whole.
Goodwill can be thought of as the value of the business as a whole less aggregate value of identifiable net assets.
 Example 22:
Azam, Babar and Careem are partners in a business. They buy a property in the name of fictitious
person with the money of the partnership. The property is a partnership property.
SPOTLIGHT

 Example 23:
Noman and Usman are partners. Noman buys shares from stock exchange in his own name with
the monies and on account of the firm. The value of shares subsequently increases by
considerable amount. Noman claims that shares are his personal property. The shares are
partnership property.
 Example 24:
Sadia and Rabia are partners. Sadia buys land with partnership money, for her sole benefit.
Thereafter, Sadia debits herself in the firm books and becomes a debtor to the firm for the amount
of the purchase money. The value of land increases subsequently by a considerable amount.
Rabia claims that the said land is property of the firm. The land is not partnership property,
STICKY NOTES

because there was clearly a contrary intention.


 Example 25:
Arslan, a partner in a firm, buys shares of a company in his own name, without the authority of
the other partners, but with the money and on account of the firm. The shares are deemed to be
partnership property.

2.2 Application of the property of the firm [Section 15]


Subject to contract between the partners, it is the duty of every partner to use the property of the firm exclusively
for the purposes of the business. No partner should use partnership property for his personal benefit.
 Example 26:
Abid and Sajid are partners in a firm. Abid took the firm’s printer and laptop to his home for the
use of his family members till they were not useable anymore. Abid must not have used
partnership property for his personal benefit and must compensate the firm.

188 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

 Practice Question 08:


Kashif, Irfan and Shujaat are partners in a firm. Irfan bought a shop in his own name. He issued a
cheque from the partnership account and debited his account with the purchase price. He rented
out the shop and credited the receipts of rent in his capital account. Kashif has objected to this
practice and asked Irfan to register the shop in the firm’s name contending that the shop is
partnership’s property. Irfan disagrees.
Explain what constitutes partnership property under the Partnership Act, 1932 and whether the
shop is partnership property or not.
 Solution:
Subject to the contract between the partners, the property of the firm includes:
 all property and rights and interests in property originally brought into the stock of the

AT A GLANCE
firm or
 all property acquired by purchase or otherwise, by or for the firm or for the purposes
and in the course of the business of the firm.
 the goodwill of the business.
 property and rights and interests in property acquired with money belonging to the firm
unless the contrary intention appears.
The shop is not property of the firm as Irfan has bought it with the firm’s money and by debiting
it in his account, he showed his intention of taking the money as loan.
 Practice Question 09:
In a partnership business, Rufi intends to acquire a plot of land for the firm with his own money.
However, he is not certain whether the plot would be considered as partnership property. Under

SPOTLIGHT
the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 advise Rufi as what is considered to be included in
the partnership property and how it is to be applied.
 Solution:
Subject to contract between the partners, the property of the firm includes:
 All property originally brought into the common stock of the firm;
 All rights or interest in the property originally so brought;
 All property acquired, by purchase or otherwise, by the firm or for the firm and all rights
and interest in any property so acquired; and
 Goodwill of the business of the firm;

STICKY NOTES
 Unless any contrary intention appears any property purchased with partnership money
with or without other partners consent will be deemed to be partnership property.
Therefore, the plot of land which Rufi intends to acquire for the firm with his own money shall
become firm’s property only if partners intend to make it so.
Application of the property of the firm:
Subject to contract between the partners, the property of the firm shall be held and used by the
partners exclusively for the purposes of the business.
 Practice Question 10:
Bader and Yaseen established a distribution agency for supplying low cost medicines to hospitals.
Yaseen, by way of a verbal agreement, allowed the agency to use his ancestral land for the
business of the agency. Bader purchased a delivery van in his own name with partnership money.
Bader wants to repay the amount to the partnership and therefore a receivable has been
recorded in the partnership books.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 describe whether the above assets would be
considered to be the partnership property.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 189


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
Land provided by Yaseen:
Subject to contract between the partners, the land would not be treated as the partnership
property. It will become the partnership property only if the partners show an intention to make
it so.
But since Yaseen, by way of an agreement, brought the property only for the use of the
partnership, the mere use of such land by the partnership would not make the land part of the
partnership property.
Delivery van:
In this case, van does not constitute partnership property because recording of receivable in
partnership books shows that the van was not acquired for the partnership.
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

190 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Choose the INCORRECT statement:
In the absence of a contract to the contrary,
(a) a partner is not entitled to receive remuneration for taking part in the conduct of the business
(b) the partners are entitled to share profits equally
(c) the partners are entitled to interest on capital subscribed by them
(d) a partner shall indemnify the firm for any loss caused to it by his wilful neglect

02. Subject to contract between the partners, a change may be made in the nature of business of the firm:

AT A GLANCE
(a) with the consent of active partners managing the business
(b) with the consent of majority of partners
(c) with the consent of all the partners
(d) with the consent of all the partners and Registrar of Firms

03. Mr. A, a partner in the firm, buys shares of a company in his own name. Without the authority of the other
partners, but with the money and on account of the firm. State the legal position.
(a) The shares are the property of Mr. A
(b) The shares are the property of active partners of the firm

SPOTLIGHT
(c) The shares are the property of the legal representatives of Mr. A
(d) The shares are the property of the partnership firm

04. The property of the firm must be used


(a) For the exclusive benefit of the active partner
(b) For personal benefits of the all the partner
(c) For the purpose of business of the firm
(d) (a) & (b)

STICKY NOTES
05. Partner giving advances to the firm is entitled:
(a) Not to claim any such interest on that amount
(b) To claim interest @ 6% or as agreed upon
(c) To claim interest @ 12% per annum
(d) To claim interest as decided by the third party

06. In the absence of any such agreement, express or implied, the property of the firm is deemed to include:
(a) All property, rights and interests which have been brought into the common stock for the purposes
of the partnership by individual partners, whether at the commencement of business or
subsequently added to it.
(b) Those acquired in the course of business with the money belonging to the firm
(c) The goodwill of the business
(d) All of the above

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 191


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

07. ________________ has a right to take part in the conduct and management of the business?
(a) Every partner
(b) Sub-partner
(c) Partner by holding out
(d) Substituted partner

08. Every partner, whether active or dormant, has a right of free access to:
(a) All accounts of the firm only.
(b) Full information of all things affecting the firm.
AT A GLANCE

(c) Both of above.


(d) None of above.

09. A partner can claim interest on capital:


(a) If there is loss
(b) If there is profit
(c) If there is profit and there is an agreement to pay it
(d) None of the above
SPOTLIGHT

10. Which of the following is not a right of partner(s)?


(a) Every partner has right to continue in the partnership and not to be expelled from it.
(b) A partner has power to act in an emergency for protecting the firm from loss.
(c) Every partner is entitled to share in the profits equally.
(d) Every partner is entitled to introduction of new partner into the firm without consent of other
partners.
STICKY NOTES

192 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

ANSWERS
01. (c) The partners are entitled to interest on capital only if there is provision thereof in the
partnership contract.
02. (c) The nature of business can only be changed unanimously by all the partners.
03. (d) The shares are deemed to be partnership property. Any property purchased with
partnership money without other partners consent will be deemed to be partnership
property.
04. (c) It is the duty of every partner to use the property of the firm exclusively for the purposes of
the business of the firm.
05. (b) Where a partner makes for the purpose of the business, any payment or advance, he is

AT A GLANCE
entitled to interest on it @ 6% per annum or as agreed upon.
06. (d) All of the above are property of the firm.
07. (a) Every partner.
08. (c) The partners have both rights.
09. (c) If there is profit and there is an agreement to pay it
10. (d) Consent of all partners is required.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 193


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

General duties of the partners (not subject to contract)


1. Duty to carry on business to the the greatest common advantage
2. Duty to be just and faithful
3. Duty to render true accounts
4. Duty to provide full information
5. Duty to indemnify for loss caused by fraud
AT A GLANCE

Additionally, mutual rights and duties may be determined by contract between the
partners, either expressly or impliedly, including the agreement in restraint of
trade.

Right and duties relating to the conduct of the business (subject to contract)
1. Right to take part in the conduct of the business
2. Duty to attend diligently to his duties
SPOTLIGHT

3. Decision Making / Right to be consulted (Majority / Unanimous)


4. Right to have access to the books

Mutual rights and obligations (in absence of contract)


1. No remuneration
2. Equal sharing in profits (and losses)
STICKY NOTES

3. No interst on capital (even if agreed, interst on capital is to be paid only out


of profits)
4. Interst @6% on loan from partner to the firm
5. Right to be indemnified for lawful and proper expenses incurred
6. Duty to indemnify the firm for wilful neglect

194 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER

Duty to account for and pay personal profits to firm (subjet to contract)
1. Dervied from any transaction using firm name or connection of the firm
2. Derived from competing business (without consent of other partners)
Rights of partners remain same after any change in firm unless otherwise agreed.
l rights and obligations (in absence of contract)

Property of the frim (unless there is contrary intention) includes:

AT A GLANCE
1. All property originally brought into the common stock of the firm
2. All rights or interest in the property originally so brought
3. All property acquired, by purchase or otherwise, by or for the firm and all
rights and interest in any property so acquired; and
4. Goodwill of the business of the firm.
Subject to contract between the partners, it is the duty of every partner to use the
property of the firm exclusively for the purposes of the business.
obligations (in absence of contract)

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 195


CHAPTER 12: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO ONE ANOTHER CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

196 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 13

RELATIONS OF PARTNERS
TO THIRD PARTIES

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER: A partner is agent of all the other partners for the purpose of
business of the firm and, therefore, a partner is liable jointly and
AT A GLANCE severally for the debts of the firm.
SPOTLIGHT A partner may have actual authority or implied authority to
enter into contracts on behalf of the firm. Implied authority
1. Authority and Liabilities of a arises only in relation to ordinary business of the firm. The
Partner and the Firm Partnership Act, 1932 specifies certain acts which are not
included in the implied authority of a partner unless there is any
2. Holding out usage or custom of trade otherwise. The partners may extend or
restrict the implied authority of one or more partners by
3. Rights of Transferee of a partnership contract. A partner also has authority to do all such

SPOTLIGHT
Partner’s Interest acts for protecting the firm from loss as would be done by
person of ordinary care, in case of emergency.
4. Minors Admitted to the An admission or representation made by any partner in the
Benefits of Partnership ordinary course of business and relating to the affairs of the firm
is evidence against the firm. Similarly, a notice to acting partner
5. Objective Based Q&A relating to the affairs of the firm operates as a notice to all the
partners. The firm is liable to third parties for wrongful acts of a
STICKY NOTES partner or for misapplication of money or property by the
partner subject to certain conditions.
A person who expressly or impliedly represents himself, or
knowingly permits himself to be so represented to third party

STICKY NOTES
that he is a partner in a firm shall be liable to third parties as if
he is partner in the firm. Such person is called partner by holding
out.
A partner may transfer his interest in the firm to another person.
Such transferee is entitled to share of profits and share of assets
on dissolution. However, such transferee does not have status
and rights of a partner in the firm.
Similarly, a minor may be admitted to benefits of partnership i.e.
he would not be personally liable and only his share is liable for
acts of the firm. He does not have status and all rights of a
partner in the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 197


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. AUTHORITY AND LIABILITIES OF A PARTNER AND THE FIRM


1.1 Partner to be Agent of the Firm [Section 18]
A partner is the agent of the firm for the purpose of the business of the firm.
 Example 01:
Ali, Bilal and Chand are partners in a business. Dawood an outsider deals with the firm through
Ali. As between Ali and Dawood, Ali is the principal. But as between Ali, Bilal and Chand, Ali is
also the agent of Bilal and Chand. As such Ali, Bilal and Chand can all sue Dawood. Dawood can
also sue Ali, Bilal and Chand. Furthermore Ali is accountable to Bilal and Chand because he is an
agent of Bilal and Chand.
Mutual agency relationship in case of a firm of Ali, Bilal and Chand
AT A GLANCE

An act by: Ali Bilal Chand


Who is an agent Ali Bilal Chand
The contract is binding on: Ali, Bilal and Chand

1.2 Authority of Partners


The authority of a partner means the capacity of a partner to bind the firm by his act. Since the partnership is not
a legal person, a partner acts as an agent for the other partners. The authority of a partner may be actual or
implied.

1.2.1 Actual Authority


SPOTLIGHT

The authority of each partner to take decisions for the business, and enter into transactions with other parties,
may be specified in the partnership agreement. Since the partnership agreement is a contract, its terms are the
terms of a contractual agreement between the partners.
 Example 02:
Aftab, Badal and Chand started a business of trading in light bulbs together under the name Solar
Traders. They decided to share profits equally and the business will be managed by Aftab only.
On first day, on behalf of Solar Traders, Aftab ordered 100 light bulbs on credit from Tanveer, a
wholesaler of electric products. Aftab had actual authority to enter into contract with Tanveer.

1.2.2 Implied authority [Section 19]


STICKY NOTES

The act of a partner which is done to carry on, in the usual way, business of the kind carried on by the firm, binds
the firm. This authority of partner to bind the firm is called ‘implied authority’.
Implied authority arises only in relation to ordinary business of the firm, therefore, every partner within the
scope of his implied authority may bind the firm by the following acts:
 Buying and selling good, on behalf of the firm and giving valid receipts for them
 Receiving payments of the debts due to the firm and giving valid receipts or discharge for them
 Contracting debts and paying debts on behalf of the firm
 Settling accounts with persons dealing with the firm
 Employing servants for the partnership of the firm
 Drawing cheques, accepting or endorsing bills of exchange and promissory notes in the name of the firm
 Pledging movable property of the firm
 Suing on behalf of the firm and defending suits in the name of the firm

198 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

 Example 03:
Jazib and Ghalib are partners in a firm. The partnership deed restricts the implied authority of
Jazib to borrow money in the name of firm. Jazib borrows money from Sahar Bank Limited (SBL).
The firm of Jazib and Ghalib is liable to SBL as SBL did not know of restriction.
 Example 04:
Azam and Babar are partners. Azam with the intention to bind the firm, goes to a shop and
purchases certain articles on behalf of the firm which are generally used in the partnership
business. Here firm will be liable for the price of the goods because Azam acted within his
authority.
 Example 05:
Naima and Raima are partners in a cash business. Naima orders in firm’s name and on the firm’s

AT A GLANCE
letter-head to be supplied with two bags of wheat at her residence. The firm is not liable to pay
because Naima’s act in question is beyond the scope of her implied authority for which the firm
cannot be bound.
 Example 06:
Imran and Kamran are working in partnership as chartered accountants. Sajid gives Rs 90,000
to Imran for investment in some good security. Imran does not tell anything to his co-partner
Kamran about it and misappropriates the money. Sajid files a suit on the firm for the recovery of
his Rs 90,000. Sajid will not succeed. The firm cannot be made liable because it is no part of the
ordinary business of chartered accountants to receive money to be invested at their direction. Of
course an action will lie against Imran individually.
 Example 07:

SPOTLIGHT
Adeel, a partner in the firm of chartered accountants, borrows money and executes a promissory
note in the name of the firm. The other partners won’t be liable on the note because it is not part
of the ordinary business of chartered accountants to draw, accept or indorse a promissory note.

1.2.3 Statutory restrictions on the implied authority of a partner [Section 19]


The restrictions imposed by law are statutory restrictions and is applicable against the whole world whether a
particular person dealing with the firm has knowledge of it or not e.g. about the name of the firm, etc.
The following acts are not included in the implied authority of a partner unless there is any usage or custom of
trade:

STICKY NOTES
 Arbitration: Submit a dispute relating to the business of the firm to arbitration
 Bank account: Open a banking account on behalf of the firm in his own name
 Compromise: Compromise or relinquish any claim or portion of a claim by the firm
 Withdrawal of suit: Withdraw a suit or proceeding filed on behalf of the firm
 Acceptance of liability: Admit any liability in a suit or proceeding against the firm
 Acquisition: Acquire immovable property on behalf of the firm
 Transfer: Transfer immovable property belonging to the firm
 Partnership: Enter into partnership on behalf of the firm.
 Example 08:
Amjad, Babar and Zahid are partners. Zahid an active partner signed a land transfer deed on
behalf of firm (without authorisation from other partners) to improve cash flows of the firm. Such
transfer is not valid, a partner does not have implied authority to transfer immovable property
belonging to firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 199


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.2.4 Restriction of Implied Authority by Contract [ Section 20]


The partners in a firm may, by contract between partners, restrict the implied authority of any partner. Such
restriction shall be effective only if third party knows of the restriction or does not know or believe that partner
to be a partner.
 Example 09:
The partnership deed of a trading firm placed a restriction on the authority of the partners to sell
the goods. One of the partners sells the good. If the third party did not know of the restriction the
firm is liable toward such third party and if the third party know of the restriction the firm will
not be liable.

1.2.5 Extension of Implied Authority by Contract [ Section 20]


AT A GLANCE

The partners in a firm may, by contract between partners, restrict the implied authority of any partner. When a
partner exceeds his authority, that is act outside his actual authority, the other partners may ratify such
unauthorized act and thus partners can remove any questions about whether implied authority existed or
whether the other party knew that the partner did not have the actual authority to make the contract.
 Example 10:
Sajid, Majid and Wajid are partner in a firm. By an agreement, they decided that no partner would
have authority to sell goods of the firm above the value of Rs. 50,000/- without the consent of
other partners. Sajid sold goods worth Rs. 70,000/- on credit without consulting other partners.
The customer defaulted. Sajid has to compensate the firm for loss caused due to him exceeding
his authority. However, Majid and Wajid may ratify his act and in that case the firm shall bear the
loss.
SPOTLIGHT

1.2.6 Partner’s Authority in an Emergency [ Section 21]


A partner has authority, in an emergency, to do all such acts for the purpose of protecting the firm from loss as
would be done by a person of ordinary care, in his own case acting under similar circumstances.
 Example 11:
Wajid, Yasir and Zahid are partner in a firm. By an agreement, they decided that no partner would
have authority to sell goods of the firm above the value of Rs. 50,000/- without the consent of
other partners. Owing to a sudden slump in the market, the prices crashed. Yasir, in order to save
the firm from loss, sold all the stock worth Rs. 5,000,000 without consulting any other partner.
Such act would bind the firm.
STICKY NOTES

1.2.7 Mode of Exercising Authority [ Section 22]


In order to bind a firm, an act done or instrument executed by a partner or other person on behalf of firm shall
be done or executed in the firm name, or in the manner implying an intention to bind the firm.

1.3 Liability of Partner and Firm

1.3.1 Effect of admissions by a partner [Section 23]


Any admission or representation made by a partner is evidence against the firm if the following two conditions
are fulfilled:
 Such admission or representation must relate to the affairs of the firm; and
 Such admission or representation must be made in the ordinary course of business.
 Example 12:
One of the partner of XYZ firm admitted in court that the firm has been involved in tax evasion.
Such admission by one partner is evidence against the firm.

200 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

1.3.2 Effect of notice to an active partner [Section 24]


Any notice to a partner operates as a notice to the firm if the following conditions are fulfilled:
 Such notice must relate to the affairs of the firm
 Such notice must be given to an acting partner and not to a sleeping partner
 There must not be any fraud committed by the partner receiving the notice.
 Example 13:
Sajid, Abid and Majid are partners in a firm. Abid and Sajid are active partners and Majid is
sleeping partner. A legal notice was served by one of their customer to Sajid. Sajid did not tell
other partners. When the customer takes further legal action, Abid and Majid cannot plead
ignorance of the notice as it was served on one of active partners.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 14:
Sajid, Abid and Majid are partners in a firm. Abid and Sajid are active partners and Majid is
sleeping partner. A legal notice was served by one of their customer to Abid for alleging that Abid
committed the fraud with the customer in ordinary course of business. The notice is not enough.
The notice must be served to partner who did not commit the fraud.

1.3.3 Joint and Several Liability [Section 25]


In order to make a partner liable for any act of the firm, the same must have been done while he was a partner.
The liability of the partner is both joint and several, so that the creditor may compel any one or more of the
partners to discharge the whole of the debts of the firm.
 Example 15:

SPOTLIGHT
Babar, Saleem and Dawood are in partnership. Babar purchases equipment for the partnership
business. The equipment itself cost Rs. 20,000 and the installation costs were Rs. 15,000. There
is a dispute with the supplier, and the firm refuses to pay the installation costs. The supplier
decides to sue for the unpaid Rs. 15,000.
If the supplier succeeds in his action, all the partners will be liable jointly for the Rs. 15,000
liability.
If the dispute goes to court, the supplier can either:
 sue all three partners jointly, or
 he can sue any individual partner, Babar, Saleem or Dawood. If he chooses to sue Babar

STICKY NOTES
personally, and succeeds with his claim, Babar will be required to pay the supplier. It
will then be for Babar to obtain from his partners Saleem and Dawood their share of the
liability that they now owe.

1.3.4 Liability of the firm for wrongful acts of a partner [Section 26]
Where by the wrongful act or omission of a partner acting in the ordinary course of the business of a firm, loss
or injury is caused to any third party or any penalty is incurred the firm is liable to the same extent as the partner.
In case of fraud, although the firm is liable to the third party for loss caused to the third party by fraud committed
by a partner but as between partners same must be borne by the partner committing the fraud and cannot be
shared among all the partners.
 Example 16:
SBMQ is a partnership firm in which Shabbir, Bashir, Muneer and Qadeer are partners. Shabbir,
the only active partner, knowing the goods were stolen ones, purchased and sold them in the
name of the firm. All the partners (including sleeping partners) are liable to the owner of goods
for the ‘tort of conversion’.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 201


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.3.5 Liability for Misapplication by Partners [Section 27]


The firm is liable to make good the loss where:
 a partner acting within his apparent authority receives money or property from a third party and
misapplies it; or
 a firm in the course of its business receives money or property from a third party, and the same is
misapplied by any of the partners while it is in the custody of the firm.
 Example 17:
Arif, Basit and Qasim are partners in an instalment sales business. Arif asked one of the customer
to deposit a security worth Rs. 100,000 in order to purchase goods on instalments. Subsequently,
Arif misappropriated the security and absconded. The other partners will be liable for the
misappropriation as security was given to Arif while he was acting within his scope of his
AT A GLANCE

apparent authority.
 Practice Question 01:
Saima, Ahsan and Bari are partners in a law firm. Bari received an advance of Rs. 150,000 from
one of firm’s clients for defending a law suit. Bari, without proceeding on client’s request and
informing other partners about the receipt of the amount, utilised the money for personal use.
Discuss the rights and liabilities of partners and that of the firm with regard to Bari’s act.
 Solution:
Bari has clearly exceeded his authority. However, Saima and Ahsan cannot repudiate Bari’s
transaction with the client. Bari’s act of receiving Rs. 150,000 from the client, for defending them
against a law suit, was done to carry on, in the usual way, business of the kind carried on by the
SPOTLIGHT

firm and such act binds the firm.


Further, where a partner acting within his apparent authority receives money from a third party
and misapplies it, the firm is liable to make good the loss. As a result, each of the partners is jointly
and severally liable to the client for all the acts of the firm done while they are the partners.
Similarly, where by the wrongful act or omission of Bari (not defending the client against the law
suit), a loss or injury is caused to the client or any penalty is incurred, the firm is liable to the
same extent as the partners are liable.
However, Bari would be personally liable to the other partners for Rs. 150,000 and shall
indemnify the firm for any loss caused to it by his wilful neglect in the conduct of the business of
the firm.
STICKY NOTES

 Practice Question 02:


The authority of a partner to bind the firm is called “Implied Authority.” List the acts which cannot
be exercised by a partner as his implied authority.
 Solution:
In the absence of any usage or custom of trade to the contrary, the implied authority of a partner
does not empower him to:
a) submit a dispute relating to the business of the firm to arbitration,
b) open a banking account on behalf of the firm in his own name,
c) compromise or relinquish any claim or portion of a claim by the firm,
d) withdraw a suit or proceeding filed on behalf of the firm,
e) admit any liability in a suit or proceeding against the firm,
f) acquire immovable property on behalf of the firm,
g) transfer immovable property belonging to the firm, or
h) enter into partnership on behalf of the firm.

202 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

 Practice Question 03:


Describe the liabilities of:
a) a partner for the acts of the firm.
b) the firm for wrongful acts of a partner.
c) the firm for misapplication of money or property by a partner.
 Solution:
Part (a) Liability of a partner for acts of the firm
Every partner is liable jointly with all the other partners and also severally for all acts of the firm
done while he is a partner.

AT A GLANCE
Part (b) Liability of the firm for wrongful acts of a partner
Where, by the wrongful act or omission of a partner acting in the ordinary course of the business
of a firm, or with the authority of his partners, loss or injury is caused to any third party, or any
penalty is incurred, the firm is liable to the same extent as the partner.
Although the firm is liable to the third party for the loss caused to him (third party) by fraud
committed by a partner, but, as between the partners, the same must be borne by the partner
committing the fraud and cannot be shared among all the partners.
Part (c) Liability of firm for misapplication of money or property by a partner
The firm is liable to make good the loss where:
 A partner acting within his apparent authority receives money or property from a third

SPOTLIGHT
party and misapplies it, or
 A firm in the course of its business receives money or property from a third party, and
the money or property is misapplied by any of the partners while it is in the custody of
the firm.
 Practice Question 04:
Asghar, Babar and Careem are carrying on agricultural business in partnership. They have agreed
to share the profits in the ratio of 4:3:2 respectively. Careem is not liable for the losses of the firm.
In February 2017, the partnership incurred substantial losses due to heavy floods in the area and
the partnership assets are not sufficient to meet the firm’s liabilities. A number of creditors have
filed a suit for recovery of the amount from Careem. Under the provisions of the Partnership Act,

STICKY NOTES
1932 analyse and comment.
 Solution:
Every partner is liable jointly with all the other partners and also severally to third parties for all
acts of the firm done while he is a partner. A partner may not share in the business losses, yet his
liability towards outsiders shall be unlimited. If the partnership assets are insufficient to meet
the firm’s liabilities, Careem would have to repay the amount personally. However, Careem can
recover the amount which he is called upon to pay to the creditors from Asghar and Babar.
 Practice Question 05:
In 2014, Majid and Ebad started a business of sale and repair of vehicles under the name of ME
Motors (MEM). Majid sold one of the vehicles which came for repair to Zahid for Rs.10 million.
Zahid on finding out that Majid did not have the legal title of the car sued MEM. Under the
provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 discuss who would be liable for damages in the above
situation.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 203


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Solution:
The act of a partner which is done to carry on, in the usual way, business of the kind carried on
by the firm, binds the firm. Further, in case a loss is sustained by a third party ME Motors (MEM)
would be liable even for the wrongful acts of Majid. Therefore, Zahid can recover the amount
from MEM or any of the partners.
However, Majid shall indemnify MEM or Ebad for any loss caused to them by his fraud in the
conduct of the firm.
 Practice Question 06:
Taqi, Saqib and Abrar are partners in a trading firm. By an agreement among themselves they
decided that no partner shall have the authority to buy or sell goods beyond the limit of Rs.
20,000 without the consent of other partners. Ignorant of this restriction, Wajid sold goods worth
AT A GLANCE

Rs. 45,000 to Saqib who did not consult with the other partners. In view of the provisions of the
Partnership Act, 1932 explain whether the firm and its partners are liable to Wajid under the
above circumstances.
 Solution:
Any act done by a partner on behalf of the firm which falls within his implied authority binds the
firm unless, the person with whom he is dealing knows about the restriction.
Under the given scenario, the firm and all the partners are jointly and severally liable to pay the
entire amount to Wajid as he was unaware of any such restriction on partners’ authority.
 Practice Question 07:
Sahir and Sarim are lawyers who have entered into a partnership namely SS Associates. Noreen
SPOTLIGHT

approached SS Associates for a property dispute case. However, after seeing Sarim’s capabilities,
Noreen gave Rs. 250,000 to Sarim for investment in stocks and bonds at his discretion on her
behalf. Sarim hid the said fact from Sahir and used the money to meet his personal needs.
Subsequently, Noreen filed a suit on the firm for the recovery of Rs. 250,000. Reason out the
validity of suit filed by Noreen.
 Solution:
The firm cannot be made liable since the receiving of money by Sarim for investment purposes
is not in ordinary course of a lawyer’s business and accordingly, is beyond the scope of his
implied authority as a partner.
 Practice Question 08:
STICKY NOTES

Faizan and Mehran are partners in a trading firm and have decided that no partner shall have the
right to buy or sell goods beyond the value of Rs. 100,000 without consent of the other partner.
Due to a sudden crisis in the market, prices of a product started falling sharply. Faizan without
consulting Mehran sold all the perishable stock worth Rs. 950,000 in order to restrict the firm’s
loss. Can Mehran hold Faizan responsible for misconduct?
 Solution:
A partner has authority, in an emergency, to do all such acts for the purpose of protecting the
firm from loss as would be done by a person of ordinary prudence, in his own case, acting under
similar circumstances, and such acts bind the firm. Hence, Faizan cannot be held responsible for
misconduct.
 Practice Question 09:
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 list down any four restrictions imposed on the
implied authority of a partner.

204 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

 Solution:
In the absence of any usage or custom of trade to the contrary, the implied authority of a partner
does not empower him to:
i. submit a dispute relating to the business of the firm to arbitration
ii. open a banking account on behalf of the firm in his own name
iii. compromise or relinquish any claim or portion of a claim by the firm
iv. withdraw a suit or proceeding filed on behalf of the firm
 Practice Question 10:
Nomi, Sultan and Behram have decided to establish a partnership business to run a departmental
store. The partnership business was started in January 2015. In March 2015 Behram received an

AT A GLANCE
overdraft of Rs. 100,000 from the partnership’s bank. He informed the bank that the money
would be used to construct a new cash counter in the departmental store. However, he used the
money to pay for his wife’s Dubai trip. Advise Nomi, Sultan and Behram about their rights and
liabilities and that of the firm in relation to the above transaction.
 Solution:
Behram has clearly exceeded his authority. However, Nomi and Sultan cannot repudiate
Behram’s transaction with the bank. As a trading partnership, all the partners have the implied
authority to borrow money on the credit of the firm and the bank is under no obligation to find
out the purpose for which the loan has actually been used.
Further, where a partner acting within his apparent authority receives money from a third party
and misapplies it, the firm is liable to make good the loss. As a result, each of the partners is jointly

SPOTLIGHT
and severally liable to the bank for repayment.
However, Behram would be personally liable to the other partners for Rs. 100,000 and shall
indemnify the firm for any loss caused to it by his wilful neglect in the conduct of the business of
the firm.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 205


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. HOLDING OUT
2.1 Partner by Holding Out [Section 28]
A person who expressly or impliedly represents himself, or knowingly permits himself to be so represented to
third party that he is a partner in a firm, is called partner by holding out. If third party gives credit to the firm on
the faith of such representation, the ‘partner by holding out’ shall be liable as if he is partner in the firm.

2.2 Direct and Indirect Representation [Section 28]


It is immaterial that ‘partner by holding out’ does or does not know that the representation has reached the
person so giving credit. It means that representation may be direct or indirect.

2.2.1 Direct Representation


AT A GLANCE

A partner by holding out may have by words spoken or written or by his conduct represented himself to be a
partner.
 Example 18:
Paras represents to Rizwan that he is a partner in the firm of Arslan, Noman and Ali, while
actually he is not a partner. On the faith of this representation Rizwan gives credit to the firm.
The firm becomes insolvent subsequently. Rizwan can make Paras liable on the basis of holding
out and Paras is estopped from denying that he is a partner in the firm.

2.2.2 Indirect Representation


A partner by holding out may have knowingly permitted himself to be represented as a partner to the other
SPOTLIGHT

person.
 Example 19:
Aamir and Baqir are partners in a firm. Zahid informs Yasir that he is also a partner in the firm of
Aamir and Baqir. Yasir conveys this information to his friend Kamran. Kamran, believing Zahid
to be a partner of the firm of Aamir and Baqir, supplies goods on credit to the firm. Can Kamran
makes Zahid liable for the payment of the price of the goods remaining unpaid?
Yes, Kamran can make Zahid liable for the payment of the price under the doctrine of ‘holding
out’ because Kamran has acted on the faith of the representation while giving credit to the firm.
For making the doctrine of ‘holding out’ applicable it is not necessary that the representation
must be made directly to the person so giving credit.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 20:
Tom, Anthony and Bred are partners in a firm. Leonardo, who is generally seen in the company
of Tom, Anthony and Bred, tells Kevin that he is also a partner in the firm. Richard, who overhears
this talk of Leonardo to Kevin and thinking Leonardo to be a partner of the firm, gives credit to
the firm. Richard can make Leonardo liable for the credit given to the firm on the basis of holding
out because for taking advantage of the doctrine of holding out. It is not necessary that the
representation must be made directly to the person so giving credit.

2.2.3 Silence as Representation


Silence may also constitute holding out representation.
 Example 21:
Anwar introduces Nadir to Zafar as his partner, when in fact he is not so, and Nadir keeps silence.
On the faith of representation Zafar gives credit to Anwar. Subsequently, Anwar becomes
insolvent. Zafar can make Nadir liable on the basis of holding out.

206 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

2.3 Knowledge of the Third Party [Section 28]


While apply the principle of holding out, the other person must have acted on the faith of such representation
and gives credit to the firm. It does not matter whether the person representing himself or represented to be a
partner does or does not know that the representation has reached the other person giving credit.
 Example 22:
Amir tells Bilal (supplier) within the hearing of Qasim (partner) that he (Amir) is a partner in
partnership firm of Qasim. Qasim does not object to this statement of Amir. Later Bilal supplies
certain goods to Amir who pretends to act as partner with Qasim. Qasim will be liable to pay the
price. Qasim by keeping quiet had led Bilal to believe that Amir is a partner.
 Example 23:
Zamir, who is not a partner in the firm consisting of Rehman and Salman, represents to Anwar

AT A GLANCE
that he is also a partner in the firm. Babar, who does not know of the representation, gives credit
to the firm of Rehman and Salman. Babar cannot make Zamir liable for the credit given to the
firm on the basis of holding out because he has not actually acted on the faith of the
representation while giving credit to the firm.

2.4 Application of Holding Out on Outgoing Partners [Section 28]


The principle of holding out also applies in case of retiring partner; however, it does not apply in case of deceased
or insolvent partner.
 Example 24:
A partnership firm consists of Salman, Noman, Zeeshan and Rehman. Rehman retires from the
firm, but fails to give public notice and his name continues to be used on letter heads. Is Rehman

SPOTLIGHT
liable to debts contracted subsequent to his retirement? Rehman is liable as a partner by holding
out to creditors who have lent on the faith of his being partner.
 Example 25:
Rizwan, Ahmad, Ashraf and Tanveer are partners. An order is placed with Habib for supplying a
certain quality of goods to the firm on credit. Before Habib could supply the goods Tanveer died.
Habib supplied the goods after Tanveer’s death, being totally ignorant about the fact of the death.
Rizwan, Ahmad and Ashraf subsequently become insolvent. Habib cannot make Tanveer’s estate
liable for his debt. The debt accrues after the delivery of goods which has been made after
Tanveer’s death, and the estate of a deceased partner is not liable for debts of the firm contracted
after his death irrespective of no public notice of death.

STICKY NOTES
 Practice Question 11:
Explain the concept of “Holding out” as described in the Partnership Act, 1932.
 Solution:
If a person represents to the outside world by words spoken or written or by his conduct or by
lending his name, that he is a partner in a certain partnership firm, he becomes liable as a partner
in that firm to anyone who has on the faith of such representation granted credit to the firm,
whether the person representing himself or allowing himself to be so represented does or does
not know that the representation has reached the person so giving credit.
The doctrine of holding out or estoppel does not extend to where after a partner’s death the
business is continued in the old firm name the continued use of that name or of the deceased
partner’s name as a part thereof shall not of itself make his legal representative or his estate
liable for any act of the firm done after his death.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 207


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 12:


Amjad enjoys a very good credit standing in the market. Kashif, owner of Kashif Electronics,
represents Amjad as his partner. Kalim on the faith of such representation supplied laptops to
Kashif Electronics on credit. Kashif defaulted and Kalim filed a suit for the recovery of the amount
against both Amjad and Kashif.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 analyse the above situation and explain
whether Amjad would be liable to pay the outstanding amount to Kalim.
 Solution:
Amjad would be regarded as partner by estoppel or holding out if:
 he knowingly permitted himself to be represented as a partner in the firm by Kashif.
AT A GLANCE

 Kalim on the faith of such representation extended credit to the firm. It does not matter
whether Amjad does or does not know that the representation has reached Kalim.
Therefore, in such case, Amjad would be liable for the outstanding amount to Kalim.
However, Amjad would not be considered as holding out partner if he has denied Kashif’s
representation in public holding him as a partner in the firm or if he has no knowledge of Kashif’s
representation.
 Practice Question 13:
Meher, Abid, Rani and Azra were partners in Abid Associates, a firm of town planners and
consultants. Bari Builders supply goods to Abid Associates on credit. Abid died on 5 January
2015. Meher, Rani and Azra decided to continue the business in the old firm’s name. However,
neither the surviving partners nor the representative of Abid gave public notice to this effect.
SPOTLIGHT

Due to insolvency of a major client, Abid Associates was facing difficulty in making payment to
Bari Builders. When Bari Builders investigated the matter, they came to know about the death of
Abid. They have now filed suits for the recovery of outstanding balance, severally against Abid’s
estate and Meher, as the credit was extended on the faith of Abid and Meher.
In view of the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 explain whether Bari Builders are justified
in filing the above suits and would they succeed in recovering the outstanding amount under the
above circumstances.
 Solution:
Where after a partner’s death, the business is continued in the old firm name, the continued use
of that name or of the deceased partner’s name as a part thereof shall not of itself make his legal
STICKY NOTES

representative or his estate liable for any act of the firm done after his death. Bari Builders cannot
sue Abid’s estate for the recovery of the outstanding amount of the credit which was extended
after Abid’s death.
However, Bari Builders can recover the outstanding amount from Abid’s estate only if the credit
was extended to the firm before Abid’s death.
Moreover, since every partner is liable, jointly with all the other partners and also severally, for
all acts of the firm done while he is a partner, Bari Builders may file a suit against Meher for the
recovery of outstanding balance and succeed, provided Meher was a partner in the firm at the
time when credit was extended to the firm.

208 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

3. RIGHTS OF TRANSFEREE OF A PARTNER’S INTEREST


3.1 Transfer of Interest [Section 29]
A partner may transfer his interest in the firm by sale, mortgage or charge fully or partially with the consent of
all the partners.

3.2 Right of Transferee to Share of Profits [Section 29]


The transferee of a partner’s interest is entitled to receive the share of the profits of the transferring partner.

3.3 Rights of Transferee on Dissolution [Section 29]


On the dissolution of the firm or on retirement of the transferring partner, the transferee is entitled to receive:

AT A GLANCE
 the share of the assets of the firm to which the transferring partner is entitled.
 an account from the date of the dissolution for the purpose of ascertaining the share.

3.4 Restrictions on Transferee [Section 29]


The transferee of a partner’s interest is not entitled to:
 status of a partner.
 interfere in the conduct of the business during the continuance of the firm
 require accounts.
 inspect the books of the firm.
 challenge the accounts of profits agreed to by the partners.

SPOTLIGHT
 sue for dissolution of the firm.
 Example 26:
Tehram, Rahil and Zain are partners in TRZ Associates. Zain, after obtaining mutual consent of
all the partners, transferred his share of interest to Hatim. Hatim now wants to discuss the future
business strategy of the firm with Tehram and Rahil. In this regard, he has asked the partners to
provide him the firm’s cash flow forecast so that he can determine firm’s growth potential for the
next five years. Comment on Hatim’s entitlement to do the same.
A transfer by a partner of his interest in the firm does not entitle Hatim to interfere in the conduct
of the business, or to require accounts, or to inspect the books of the firm, but entitles Hatim only
to receive the share of profits of Zain, and Hatim shall accept the account of profits agreed to by

STICKY NOTES
the partners.
 Practice Question 14:
Sameer, Fauzia and Sualat are partners in a firm. Fauzia transferred her interest in the firm
absolutely to her son Adil. In the light of the provisions of Partnership Act, 1932 would Adil be
considered a new partner in the firm? Also describe the rights and restrictions on Adil in view of
such transfer.
 Solution:
Rights of transferee of a partner’s interest
Where a partner’s interest is transferred, the transferee does not become a partner and similarly
the transferor does not cease to be a partner. Therefore, Adil would not be considered as a
partner in the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 209


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Rights of Adil:
Adil would be entitled only to receive the share of the profits of the firm to which Fauzia is
entitled. He would be bound to accept the account of profits agreed to by the partners.
Upon dissolution of the firm or, in case, if Fauzia ceases to be a partner, Adil would be entitled, as
against the remaining partners, to receive the share of the assets of the firm, to which Fauzia was
entitled and for the purpose of ascertaining that share he would be entitled to ask for the
accounts as from the date of the dissolution.
Restrictions on Adil:
Adil would not be entitled, during the continuance of the partnership:
 to interfere in the conduct of the business; or
AT A GLANCE

 to require accounts; or
to inspect the books of the firm.
 Practice Question 15:
Maqbool, Rufi and Sham are the partners in Zeeshan Builders (ZB), a firm engaged in the business
of constructing industrial and residential projects in Balochistan.
Sham is also the owner of a cottage industry in Quetta. Sham has obtained a long term loan for
his cottage industry from Dostana Bank Limited by transferring his interest in ZB to the bank by
way of a mortgage.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 describe the rights and disabilities, if any, of
Dostana Bank Limited in the above circumstances.
SPOTLIGHT

 Solution:
Rights of Dostana Bank Limited:
Following rights are available to the bank:
i. entitlement to receive the share of the profits of Sham (the transferring partner).
ii. On the dissolution of the firm or on retirement of Sham the bank is entitled to receive:
 the share of the assets of the firm to which Sham is entitled.
 an account from the date of the dissolution for the purpose of ascertaining the
share.
STICKY NOTES

Disabilities of Dostana Bank Limited:


The bank shall not be treated as a partner in the firm and during the continuance of the
partnership, shall not be entitled, to:
 interfere in the conduct of the business of the firm.
 require accounts.
 inspect the books of the firm.
 challenge the accounts of profits agreed to by the partners.
 sue for dissolution of the firm.

210 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

4. MINOR ADMITTED TO THE BENEFITS OF PARTNERSHIP


4.1 Introduction [Section 30]
Since a minor is not capable of entering into a contract, a contract by or with a minor is void ab-initio i.e. from
the beginning. Since partnership is formed by a contract, a minor cannot enter into a partnership agreement but
with the consent of all the partners for the time being a minor may be admitted to the benefits of existing
partnership.
The benefits of partnership include benefits, which the minor would enjoy if he was a major.
 Example 27:
Musharaf enters into a partnership with Karzai, a minor, for the benefit of Karzai. The
partnership is not valid. There must be a partnership in existence before a minor can be admitted

AT A GLANCE
to its benefits.

4.2 Position of a minor before attaining majority [Section 30]

4.2.1 Rights
The minor admitted to benefits of partnership has right:
 to such share of property and profits of the firm as agreed with the partners
 to have access to and inspect and copy any of the accounts (but not books of accounts) of the firm.

4.2.2 Limited liability


The minor admitted to benefits of partnership is not personally liable for the acts of firm, only his share in the

SPOTLIGHT
firm is liable for such acts i.e. limited liability.

4.2.3 Disabilities
The minor admitted to benefits of partnership:
 does not have status of a partner.
 may not sue partners for profit and property except after disconnecting his relation with the firm.
 is not entitled to have access to books other than accounts.

4.3 Position of a minor on attaining majority [Section 30]

STICKY NOTES
4.3.1 Decision to Continue or Leave
On attaining majority, the minor partner has to decide within six months whether he shall continue in the firm
or leave it.
These six months are counted from the date (whichever is later):
 of his attaining majority; or
 when he first comes to know that he had been admitted to the benefits of partnership.
The burden of proving the fact that such minor had no knowledge of such admission until a particular date after
the expiry of six months of his attaining majority shall lie on such minor.
Within this period, he should give a public notice of his choice:
 to become; or
 not to become a partner in the firm.
If he fails to give a public notice, he is deemed to have become a partner in the firm on the expiry
of the six months after obtaining majority.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 211


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 28:
Celina, a minor, was admitted to the benefits of a firm consisting of Angelina, Jennifer and Julia,
three adult partners. Within six months after attaining majority, Celina gives public notice that
she has become a regular partner. But Julia and Jennifer refuse to take her. Their refusal is not
justified. Celina becomes a full-fledged partner as she has elected to become a partner within six
months of her attaining majority, and other partners cannot refuse to take her as a partner.
 Example 29:
A, B and C, partners of a firm, admitted D, a minor to the benefits of the firm. D attained majority
on 6th March 2007. He became aware of the fact that he has been admitted to the benefits of the
firm on 16th August 2007. Being undecided about the situation he preferred to wait for some
time before announcing his decision about joining the firm.
AT A GLANCE

On 27th February 2008, the firm suffered heavy losses due to an unforeseen event. A, B and C
informed D that on account of such losses, his capital in the firm has been reduced by 40%.
Discuss the rights and liabilities of D in the above situation.
D becomes a partner in the firm after 6 months of the date on which he became aware of the fact
that he was entitled to the benefits in the firm i.e. on 16th February 2008. Therefore, he shall be
liable to share the losses of the firm, incurred thereafter. His failure to announce his decision will
have no bearing on the situation.

4.3.2 Elected to become a partner


Such minor, who decided to become a partner, shall be:
 Personally liable to third parties for all acts of the firm done since he was admitted to the benefits of
SPOTLIGHT

partnership.
 Entitled to same share in the property and profits of the firm to which he was entitled as a minor.

4.3.3 Elected not to become a partner


Where such minor elects not to become a partner:
 His rights and liabilities as minor shall continue to the date of public notice.
 His share shall not be liable for any acts of the firm done after the date of public notice.
 He has right to sue the partners for his share of the property and profits in the firm.
 Practice Question 16:
STICKY NOTES

Rustum, Mahmood and Wali are partners in a firm. Wali wants to admit his sixteen-year-old son
Raghib as a new partner.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 can Raghib be admitted to the partnership
business? State the rights, liabilities and limitations of Raghib, if he is admitted to the partnership
business.
 Solution:
Partnership is created by a valid contract. Since a minor is not capable of entering into a contract,
a contract by or with a minor is void ab-initio. Accordingly, a minor cannot be a partner in the
firm.
However, a minor can be admitted to the benefits of partnership with the consent of all the
partners for the time being. i.e. before admission of a minor there must be an existence of
partnership.

212 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

Rights, liabilities/limitations of Raghib (minor):


The rights, liabilities and limitations of Raghib who has been admitted to the benefits of
partnership are governed by the following rules:
Rights:
i. Right to share property and profits of the firm as agreed by the partners.
ii. Right of inspecting and taking copies of accounts of the firms ONLY.
iii. Right not to be adjudged insolvent.
Liabilities:
i. Personally not liable to third parties for the debts of the firm i.e. limited liability.

AT A GLANCE
ii. His share is liable for the acts of the firm.
Limitations:
i. No status of partner. The minor is not entitled to take part in the conduct of the business
of the firm.
ii. No suit against partners for profit and property except after disconnecting his relation
with the firm.
iii. Not entitled to have access to books other than accounts.
 Practice Question 17:
Wasim, Ahmed and Salman are partners in a firm. Salman died in a plane crash. Wasim and
Ahmed agreed to admit Salman’s minor son, Noman, to the benefits of the Partnership. Noman

SPOTLIGHT
attained majority on 6 June 2016. He became aware of the fact that he had been admitted to the
benefits of the Partnership on 16 July 2016.
Being undecided about joining the firm as a partner, he preferred to wait for some time.
On 10 January 2017, the firm suffered heavy losses due to a fire in one of its factories. Wasim and
Ahmed informed Noman that on account of losses, his entire capital has been wiped off and he is
required to contribute Rs. 100,000 to enable the firm to settle its liabilities.
Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 analyse the above situation and advise
whether Noman would be regarded as a partner in the firm. Also state his liabilities towards the
losses, if any.

STICKY NOTES
 Solution:
Noman would only be considered a partner in the firm when either he gives public notice of
becoming a partner, at any time within six months of the later of following dates:
 the date of his attaining majority; or
 the date of his obtaining knowledge that he had been admitted to the benefits of
partnership; or
If Noman fails to give such notice he shall become a partner on the expiry of the above six months.
i.e. 15 January 2017 in the given case. Since up to 10 January 2017, when the firm suffered heavy
losses, Noman’s status in the firm had not been determined, i.e. whether he is or is not a partner
in the firm, Noman would not be liable to pay additional Rs. 100,000 and would only be liable up
to the extent of his share in the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 213


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 18:


Masoom, Rahul and Naila are partners in a trading firm. In 2016, they borrowed Rs. 500,000 from
Ishtiaq for purchasing a shop in Multan. The loan was agreed to be repaid in two years’ time.
However, due to financial crises the loan could not be re-paid in time. For the purpose of settling
the loan, Ishtiaq has offered Naila to admit his seventeen-year-old son Muneer to the partnership
business. Under the provisions of the Partnership Act, 1932 discuss whether Muneer can be
admitted to the partnership business. State Muneer’s rights and liabilities if he is so admitted.
 Solution:
Partnership is created by a valid contract. Since a minor is not capable of entering into a contract,
a contract by or with a minor is void ab-initio. Accordingly, Muneer cannot be a partner in the
firm. However, Muneer can be admitted to the benefits of partnership with the consent of all the
partners and not only by Naila alone.
AT A GLANCE

Rights and liabilities of Muneer (minor):


The rights and liabilities of Muneer, who has been admitted to the benefits of partnership are
governed by the following rules:
 Right to share property and profits of the firm as agreed by the partners.
 Right of inspecting and taking copies of accounts of the firms ONLY.
 Right not to be adjudged insolvent.
 Personally not liable to third parties for the debts of the firm i.e. limited liability. His
share is liable for the acts of the firm.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

214 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

5. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. The implied authority of a partner does NOT empower him to:
(a) submit a business dispute to arbitration
(b) withdraw a suit filed on behalf of the firm
(c) open a banking account on behalf of the firm
(d) all the above

02. A firm is liable to make good the loss of third party if:
(a) one of the partners acting within his apparent authority misapplies the money or property received

AT A GLANCE
from a third party
(b) one of the partners misapplies the money or property received from a third party by the firm in the
course of its business while it is in the custody of the firm
(c) by the wrongful act or omission of a partner acting in the ordinary course of the business of a firm,
loss or injury is caused to any third party
(d) all of the above

03. Emmad and Faraz are partners in cloth trading business. In the presence of Faraz, his friend Ghalib
boasted that he is also a partner in the business, in front of Haroon, a customer. Haroon gave this
information to Ismail and on this belief, Ismail supplied cloth on credit to the firm. Can Ismail make Ghalib
liable for the unpaid amount in this transaction?

SPOTLIGHT
(a) No, as Ghalib did not present himself as a partner, in front of Ismail
(b) Yes, as Ismail gave credit to the firm on the faith of Ghalib’s representation
(c) No, as Ghalib is not a partner in the firm
(d) Yes, as Ghalib did it intentionally to deceive others

04. Hamid and Ismail are partners and work as legal advisors. Jehangir, an old client of theirs, gave a sum of
money to Hamid while he was in the firm’s premises for investment in some good security which Hamid
misappropriated without knowledge of Ismail. Jehangir filed a suit against the firm for recovery of his
money. Can Jehangir succeed?

STICKY NOTES
(a) Yes, as money was given to Hamid in firm’s premises
(b) No, as this transaction is not the ordinary business of legal advisors
(c) Yes, as Hamid had previously carried out similar transactions with the knowledge of Ismail
(d) Both (b) and (c)

05. Select the false statement.


(a) On the death of a partner his heir becomes a partner.
(b) Minor partner has no right to see secret books/records of the partnership.
(c) A partner has no authority to submit a dispute relating to the business of the firm to arbitration.
(d) A partner has no authority to enter into partnership with other firm on behalf of the firm.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 215


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

06. Partner is
(a) Only an agent of the firm
(b) Only principal to other partners
(c) An agent as well as principal
(d) None of these

07. Mr. X, Mr. Y and Mr. Z are partners in a firm. By an agreement, they decided that no partner would have
authority to sell goods of the firm above the value of Rs. 50,000/- without the consent of other partners.
Owing to the sudden slump in the market, the prices crashed. One partner sold all the stock worth Rs.
500,000/- without consulting other partners. Is the partner liable for this breach of partnership
agreement?
AT A GLANCE

(a) The partner is liable as he is in breach of agreement


(b) The partner is liable because he is acting without the consent of other partners
(c) The partner is not liable as he is acting in order to save the firm from loss
(d) The partner is not liable as he has express authority to do so

08. For the debts of the firm, partners are liable


(a) Jointly
(b) Jointly and severally
(c) Severally
SPOTLIGHT

(d) Individually

09. A minor
(a) Can be a partner in the firm
(b) Can be held personally liable when he is admitted in the partnership
(c) Cannot be admitted to the benefits of the firm with the consent of all partners
(d) Can be admitted to the benefits of the firm with the consent of all partners.
STICKY NOTES

10. A minor admitted to the benefits of the firm, towards third party
(a) He is personally liable
(b) He is liable for half of the loss
(c) He is liable only up to his share in the firm
(d) He has no liability at all

11. Mr. A, Mr. B and Mr. C are partners in an instalment sales business. Mr. A asked one of the customers to
deposit a security worth Rs. 100,000/- in order to purchase goods on instalments. Subsequently, Mr. A
misappropriated the security and absconded. Who will be liable for such loss?
(a) Mr. A and Mr. B will be liable to compensate the loss
(b) No one is liable to compensate the loss
(c) Mr. A is liable only to compensate the loss
(d) All the partners are liable to compensate the loss

216 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

12. Restrictions on the partner by partnership deed is binding on third party provided
(a) Such restrictions are valid
(b) Are according to the provisions of the partnership Act
(c) Such restrictions have been imposed by mutual agreement.
(d) Such restrictions are in the knowledge of third party

13. Mr. A tells Mr. B (Supplier) within the hearing of Mr. C (Partner) that he (Mr. A) is a partner in the
partnership firm of Mr. C. Mr. C does not object to this statement of Mr. A. Later Mr. B supplies certain
goods to Mr. A who pretends to act as partner with Mr. C. State the legal position
(a) Mr. C will not be held liable to pay the price

AT A GLANCE
(b) Mr. A will be held liable personally to pay the price
(c) Mr. B cannot claim the price from Mr. C
(d) Mr. C will be liable to pay the price.

14. On attaining majority, the minor partner has to decide within six months whether he shall continue in
the firm or leave it. Where such minor elects to become a partner, he will be personally liable
(a) From the date when he attained majority
(b) From the date when he gives public notice
(c) Since the date of admission to the benefits of the firm

SPOTLIGHT
(d) After the lapse of six months

15. Under the implied authority the partner may not


(a) Employ servants for the business of the firm
(b) Pledge movable property of the firm
(c) Buy movable property of the firm
(d) Transfer immovable property of the firm

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 217


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (d) Implied authority of a partner does not empower him to all of the acts mentioned.
02. (d) A partner will be liable to third party in all of the situations mentioned.
03. (b) A person may be considered partner by holding out in case of indirect representation.
04. (b) No, as this transaction is not the ordinary business of legal advisors
05. (a) Partnership is created by contract and not status or inheritance.
06. (c) There must exist a mutual agency relationship among partners. Mutual agency relationship
means that each partner is both an agent and a principal.
07. (c) It is the duty of the partner to do all such acts for the purpose of protecting their firm from loss
AT A GLANCE

as would be done by a person of ordinary prudence, in his own case.


08. (b) The liability of all the partners is not only joint and several but is also unlimited.
09. (d) With the consent of all the partners for the time being a minor may be admitted to the benefits
of partnership but cannot become a partner
10. (c) A minor’s share is liable for the acts of the firm. But the minor is not personally liable for any
such act as his liability is limited.
11. (d) The firm is liable to make good the loss means all the partners will be liable for the
misappropriation as security was given to Mr. A while he was acting within the scope of his
apparent authority.
12. (d) A restriction in partnership deed is effective only against the person dealing with the firm
SPOTLIGHT

having knowledge of it.


13. (d) Mr. C will be liable to pay the price. Mr. C by keeping quiet had led Mr. B to believe that Mr. A is
a partner.
14. (c) When minor elects to become a partner, he is personally liable since the date of admission to
the benefits of the firm.
15. (d) It is the restriction on the implied authority of the partner that a partner cannot transfer
immovable property of the firm without the express authority from the other partners.
STICKY NOTES

218 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES

STICKY NOTES

A partner is the agent of the firm (i.e. all the partners) for the purpose of the business
of the firm. The authority of the partner as agent may be expressed or implied.

Statutory Restrictions on implied authority


1. Arbitration 5. Aceeptance of liability

AT A GLANCE
2. Bank account 6. Acquisition of immovable property
3. Compromise 7. Transfer of immovable property
4. Withdrawal of suit 8. Entering into partnership

The authority of a partner may be extended or restricted by partnership contract.


Especially, a partner has authority in case of emergency to protect the firm from
loss.

Liability of Partner and Firm

SPOTLIGHT
Effect of admission It is evidence against the firm if made in ordinary course of
by a partner: business.
Effect of notice to It operates as notice to all the partners relating to affairs of
an active partner: the firm.
Joint and several A partner may be sued individually or jointly with other
liability: partners by third parites for the debts of the firm.
Liability of the The firm is liable to third parties for wrongful acts of a
firm for wrongful partner subject to certain conditions.
acts of a partner:
Liability for The firm is liable to third parties for wrongful acts of a

STICKY NOTES
Misapplication by partner for misapplication of money or property by the
Partners: partner subject to certain conditions.

A person who expressly or impliedly represents himself, or knowingly permits


himself to be so represented to third party that he is a partner in a firm, is
called partner by holding out. If third party gives credit to the firm on the faith
of such representation, the ‘partner by holding out’ shall be liable as if he is
partner in the firm. Such representation may be direct or indirect.
The principle of holding out also applies in case of retiring partner; however,
it does not apply in case of deceased or insolvent partner.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 219


CHAPTER 13: RELATIONS OF PARTNERS TO THIRD PARTIES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Transferee of Partner’s Interest


Rights Restrictions
1. Share of profit 1. No status of partner
2. Share of assets on dissolution 2. No interference in management
3. Receive an account from the date of 3. Cannot require accounts
dissolution for ascertaining his
4. Cannot inspect books
share
5. Cannot challenge profit amount
6. Cannot sue for dissolution
AT A GLANCE

Minor admitted to the benefits of partnership


Rights Disabilities
1. To share of property and profits 1. No status of partner
2. To access and inspect accounts 2. Not entitled to other books
3. To have limited liability 3. Cannot sue until disconnecting his
relationship with the firm

A minor has to decide to become or not to become partner within six months of
SPOTLIGHT

attaining the majority or first coming to knowledge of being admitted to the benefits
of partnership, whichever is later.

Elected to become Partner Elected not to become a partner


1. Personally liable for debts since 1. Rights and liabilties as minor to
his admission to partnership continue till public notice
2. Same share in property and 2. His share shall not be liable from
profits of the firm the date of public notice.
3. He has right to sue for his share of
property and profits.
STICKY NOTES

220 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 14

NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
The law relating to negotiable instruments is contained in the
Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881, which deals with promissory

AT A GLANCE
AT A GLANCE
notes, bill of exchange and cheque.
SPOTLIGHT The property in a negotiable instrument passes from one person
to another by a simple process, i.e. by mere delivery if it is
1. Introduction payable to bearer, and by indorsement and delivery if it is
payable to order. The holder in due course (one who acquires
2. Promissory Note the instrument in good faith and for consideration) gets it free
from all defects.
3. Bill of Exchange Payment in due course means payment in accordance with the
apparent tenor of the instrument in good faith and without
4. Types of Negotiable negligence to any person in possession thereof under
Instruments circumstances which do not afford a reasonable ground for

SPOTLIGHT
believing that he is not entitled to receive payment of the
5. Objective Based Q&A amount therein mentioned.

STICKY NOTES A “promissory note” is an instrument in writing (not being a


bank note or currency note) containing an unconditional
undertaking signed by the maker, to pay a certain sum of money
only to, or to the order of a certain person, or to the bearer of the
instrument. The person who makes the promissory note is
called the maker; the person to whom the payment is to be made
is called the payee.
A bill of exchange is an instrument in writing containing an
unconditional order, signed by the maker, directing a certain

STICKY NOTES
person to pay a certain sum of money only to, or to the order of
a certain person, or to the bearer of the instrument. The person
who makes the bill is called the drawer. The person who is
directed to pay is called the drawee. The person to whom the
payment is made is called the payee.
The negotiable instruments may be classified as bearer and
order instruments; inland and foreign instruments; and demand
and time instruments.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 221


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Short title, extent and commencement [Section 1 & 1A]
The law relating to negotiable instruments is the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 (the Act). It extends to the
whole of Pakistan and it is applicable since the first day of March 1882.
The Act does not affects the provisions of Section 24 and Section 35 of the State Bank of Pakistan Act, 1956.
Every negotiable instrument shall be governed by the Act regardless of any usage or custom that is different from
the provision of the Act.

1.2 Negotiable Instrument


In simple terms, negotiable means transferable by delivery and instrument means a written document by which
AT A GLANCE

a right is created in favour of some person. Thus negotiable instrument may mean a written document
transferable by delivery.
The term “delivery” means transfer of possession, actual or constructive, from one person to another. [Section
3(d)]

1.2.1 Definition of negotiable instrument [Section 13]


A negotiable instrument means a:
 Promissory note
 Bill of exchange or
 Cheque
SPOTLIGHT

payable either to order or to bearer.


The above definition reveals that when a promissory note, bill of exchange and cheque is issued it can be termed
as negotiable instruments.
The term “issue” means the first delivery of a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque complete in form to a
person who takes it as a holder. [Section 3(e)]

1.3 Characteristics of negotiable instrument

1.3.1 Either payable to order or bearer [Section 13]


A negotiable instrument may either be payable to or to the bearer.
STICKY NOTES

A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is payable to order which is expressed to be so payable or which
is expressed to be payable to a particular person, and does not contain words prohibiting transfer or indicating
an intention that it shall not be transferable is called payable to order.
 Example 01:
The following words on a negotiable instrument are indicating that the instrument is payable to
order:
 “Pay Azam….”
 “Pay Azam or order…..”
 “Pay Azam or Babar…..”
A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is payable to bearer which is expressed to be so payable or on
which the only or last indorsement is an indorsement in blank. If an instrument is payable to any person
whosoever bears it then it is called payable to bearer.

222 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

The term “bearer” means a person who by negotiation comes into possession of a negotiable instrument, which
is payable to bearer. [Section 3(c)]
 Example 02:
The following words on a negotiable instrument are indicating that the instrument is payable to
bearer:
 “Pay Azam or bearer….”
 “Pay bearer…..”
 “Pay to bearer of this instrument…..”
 Example 03:
A bill of exchange is payable to Aslam. Aslam indorses it merely by putting his signature on the

AT A GLANCE
back and delivers it to Babar with the intention of negotiating it (without making it payable to
Babar or Babar’s order). In the hands of Babar the bill is a bearer instrument.
A negotiable instrument may be made payable to two more payees jointly, or it may be made payable in the
alternative to one of two, or one or some of several payees. For example, “Azam or Babar…..”.
The section 35 of State Bank of Pakistan Act, 1956 prohibits any person, other than a Bank or Federal
Government, to issue:
a) A promissory note payable to bearer.
b) A bill of exchange payable to bearer on demand.
 Example 04:
The following bill of exchange is not valid: “Pay bearer Rs. 10,000 whenever he asks for.”

SPOTLIGHT
1.3.2 Easy transferability [Section 13]
They are transferable from one person to another by mere delivery if payable to bearer and by indorsement and
delivery if payable to order.
 Example 05:
Kamran bought goods from Dawood on 15th January and paid him by a bearer cheque dated 25th
January. Dawood gave the same cheque to Waqas for supply of raw materials. Waqas may encash
the cheque on or after 25th January.
 Example 06:

STICKY NOTES
Kamal bought goods from Jamal on 15th January and made a promissory note for the amount
payable to Jamal or order. Jamal signed and indorsed (transferred) this promissory note to Khalil
to settle his dues with him. On due date, Khalil can get payment from Kamal.

1.3.3 Title of holder in due course [Section 9]


It means that once an instrument is received in the hands of holder in due course (a holder in good faith) it
becomes free from all defects.
 Example 07:
Ajmal gave a promissory note to Bashir. Bashir lost the instrument and it was found by Habib.
Habib cannot recover the amount on the negotiable instrument as he is not the holder in due
course but if Habib transfer the instrument to Dawood and Dawood becomes holder in due
course, as he did not know that instrument was lost, he can recover the amount on the instrument
from Ajmal or all prior parties.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 223


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.4 Parties to negotiable instrument

1.4.1 Primary parties [Section 7 & 3(b)]

Maker The person who makes a promissory note.


Payee The person named in an instrument, to whom or to whose order money is to be paid.
Drawer The maker of a bill of exchange or cheque.
Drawee The person on whom bill of exchange or cheque is drawn and who is directed to pay the amount.
Acceptor A bill of exchange (other than a cheque) must be presented to the drawee for acceptance first, and
then presented for payment on due date. Drawee becomes acceptor when he accepts the bill duly
signing it.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 08:
Anum signed a promissory note worded as “One month after date, I promise to pay Maha or order
sum of Rupees ten thousand for value received.” Here, Anum is maker and Maha is payee.
 Example 09:
Maria drawn a bill of exchange on Zahra worded as “Two months after date, pay to Hussain or
order the sum of Rupees five thousand for value received.” Here, Maria is drawer, Zahra is drawee
and Hussain is payee. Once Zahra accepts this bill, she will be called acceptor.
 Example 10:
Saima drawn a cheque on ABC Bank, payable to Bilal or order. Here, Saima is drawer, ABC Bank
SPOTLIGHT

is drawee and Bilal is payee.

1.4.2 Holder [Section 8]


A person is called holder of a negotiable instrument if he satisfies the following two conditions:
 He must be entitled to the possession of the instrument in his own name (“holder” does not include a
beneficial owner claiming through a Benamidar); and
 He must be entitled to receive / recover the amount due on the instrument from the parties liable under
the instrument.
Thus a holder means the bearer of the bearer instrument and the indorsee or payee of the order instrument.
When the note, bill or cheque is lost and not found or is destroyed, the person in possession of it or the bearer at
STICKY NOTES

the time of loss or destruction shall be deemed to continue to be its holder.


 Example 11:
Kamran bought goods from Dawood on 15th January and paid him by a bearer cheque dated 25th
January. Dawood became holder of the cheque. Then, Dawood gave the same cheque to Waqas
for supply of raw materials. Now, Waqas became holder of the cheque.

1.4.3 Holder in due course [Section 9]


“Holder in due course” means any person who for consideration becomes the possessor of a promissory note,
bill of exchange or cheque if payable to bearer, or the payee or indorsee thereof, if payable to order, before it
became overdue, without notice that the title of the person from whom he derived his own title was defective.
The title of a person to a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is defective when he is not entitled to receive
the amount due thereon

224 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

A person becomes holder in due course when he fulfils the following conditions:

Holder He must be a holder i.e. He fulfils the essentials of a holder.


Holder for valuable There must be a lawful and adequate consideration.
consideration
Before maturity A person should receive the instrument before its maturity. In case of instrument
payable on demand, he must have taken the instrument within a reasonable time of
its issue.
Complete and regular It is the duty of every person who takes a negotiable instrument to examine its form
and contents thoroughly, for if it contains any material alteration which has not been
confirmed by the drawer through his signature or it is incomplete like drawer name
is missing or not properly stamped.

AT A GLANCE
Holder in good faith A person should take the instrument without any negligence on his part and in good
faith without having any reason to believe that any defect existed in the title of the
transferor. If there is any suspicion and he takes the instrument without making
proper inquiries he cannot be said to be acting in good faith.

The term “material alteration” in relation to a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque includes any alteration
of that date, the sum payable, the time of payment, the place of payment, and where any such instrument has been
accepted generally the addition of a place of payment without the acceptor’s assent. [Section 3(f)].
 Example 12:
Kamal transferred a bill of exchange to Jamal for goods purchased one day after its maturity.
Jamal is holder but not a holder in due course.

SPOTLIGHT
 Example 13:
Anum received a bill of exchange transferred to her by her brother as gift. She is holder but not
holder in due course as she became holder without valuable consideration.
 Example 14:
Kamal transferred a bill of exchange to Jamal for goods purchased a week before its maturity.
Jamal knew that the bill was stolen by Kamal. Jamal is not a holder in due course.
 Example 15:
Ajmal gave a promissory note to Bashir. Bashir lost the instrument and it was found by Habib.
Habib cannot recover the amount on the negotiable instrument as he is not the holder in due

STICKY NOTES
course but if Habib transfer the instrument to Dawood and Dawood becomes holder in due
course if he did not know that instrument was lost, he can recover the amount on the instrument
from Ajmal or all prior parties.

1.4.4 Difference between Holder and Holder in due course


The following are differences between holder and holder in due course:

Holder Holder in due course


Meaning
A holder is a person who legally obtains the negotiable A holder in due course is a person who acquires
instrument, with his name entitled on it, to receive the the negotiable instrument bona fide for some
payment from the parties liable. consideration, whose payment is still due.

Consideration
Not necessary. Necessary.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 225


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Holder Holder in due course


Right to sue
A holder may not sue all prior parties. A holder in due course can sue all prior parties.
Good faith
The instrument may or may not be obtained in good The instrument must be obtained in good faith.
faith.
Free from defects / Better title
A holder may not get title free from defects. A holder in due course gets a better title than that
of the transferor.
Maturity
A person can become holder, before or after the A person can become holder in due course, only
maturity of the negotiable instrument.
AT A GLANCE

before the maturity of negotiable instrument.

1.5 Transfer of Negotiable Instrument


1.5.1 Definition: Negotiation [Section 14]
"When a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is transferred to any person, so as to constitute that person
the holder of it, the instrument is said to be negotiated.
The analysis of the definition reveals that negotiation takes place when the negotiable instrument is transferred
from one person to another and the transfer is made in such a manner so as to make the transferee the holder of
the negotiable instrument and it must be transferred free from defects.

1.5.2 Definition: Indorsement [Section 15]


SPOTLIGHT

“When the maker or holder of a negotiable instrument signs the same, otherwise than as such maker, for the
purpose of negotiation on the back or face thereof or on a slip of paper annexed thereto, or so signs for the same
purpose a stamped paper intended to be completed as a negotiable instrument he is said to indorse the same,
and is called the ‘indorser’.”
The term indorsement may be defined as signing one’s name on the negotiable instrument for the purpose of
transferring it to another person.
The following are essentials of valid indorsement:
 It must be on instrument itself, if no space is left on the back of the indorsement, further indorsements
are signed on a slip of paper attached to the instrument called ‘allonge’.
 It must be signed by the indorser for the purpose of negotiation. Signature of the indorser on the
STICKY NOTES

instrument without any additional words is sufficient.


 No particular form of words is necessary for an indorsement
 It must be completed by the delivery of the instrument with the intention of passing the property in it.
 Negotiation by indorsement must be of the entire instrument. Indorsement for part of the amount is
invalid.
 Example 16:
A bill is payable to the order of Imran. Imran signs on the back of the bill and does not specify the
name of the indorsee and delivers it to Saleem. This is a valid indorsement in blank by Imran to
Saleem.
 Example 17:
A bill is payable to the order of Kamran. Kamran signs on the back of the bill with words “Pay to
Bilal or order” and delivers it to Bilal. This is valid indorsement by Kamran to Bilal and Bilal is
now entitled to receive the payment of the instrument and to further negotiate the instrument
by his indorsement.

226 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

1.6 Payment in due course [Section 10]


Payment in due course means payment in accordance with the apparent tenor of the instrument in good faith
and without negligence to any person in possession thereof under circumstances which do not afford a
reasonable ground for believing that he is not entitled to receive payment of the amount therein mentioned.
Apparent tenor means the period of time as expressed in the instrument, after which it is payable and payment
in due course results in discharge of a negotiable instrument.
 Example 18:
If a banker makes payment of a post-dated cheque before the date mentioned on the cheque, he
acts against the apparent tenor of the instrument. Hence the payment will not be treated as
payment in due course.
 Example 19:

AT A GLANCE
Bill of Exchange, if paid without enquiry as to the payee or cheque with forged signature of the
drawer, will amount to negligence on the part of the payer and the payment will not be treated
as payment in due course.
 Practice Question 01:
Sultan drew a bill of exchange on Amjad and made it payable to Bukhari or order. On maturity
another person of the same name wrongfully acquired possession of the bill and presented it to
Amjad for payment. Amjad after making due inquires and being satisfied that the presenter is
Bukhari, made payment on the bill.
Under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 discuss whether Amjad is
discharged from his liability.

SPOTLIGHT
 Solution:
Yes, Amjad is discharged from his liability on the bill.
Amjad made payment to the presenter, who was in possession of the bill, according to the
apparent tenor of the instrument, in good faith and without negligence, after making due inquiry
as to his identity.
It is therefore, a payment in due course and the acceptor is discharged.
 Practice Question 02:
A cheque is drawn payable to 'B or order'. It is stolen and B's indorsement is forged. The banker
pays the cheque in due course. Is the banker discharged from liability? Would it make any

STICKY NOTES
difference if the drawer's signature were forged?
 Solution:
Where a cheque payable to order purports to be indorsed by or on behalf of the payee, the drawee
is discharged by payment in due course. Therefore the banker is discharged from liability as a
banker is not expected to know the signatures of payees who are not the clients of the bank.
On the other hand, a banker paying a cheque on which the drawer's signature is forged is
responsible and should bear the loss.
 Practice Question 03:
Under the provisions of Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 define ‘Holder in due course’
 Solution:
Holder in due course - means any person who for consideration becomes the possessor (holder)
of a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque if payable to bearer, or the payee or indorsee
thereof, if payable to order, before it became overdue, without notice that the title of the person
from whom he derived his own title was defective.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 227


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 04:


What do you understand by the terms ‘Holder’, ‘Holder in due course’ and ‘Payment in due
course’ under the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881?
 Solution:
Holder
A person is called holder of a negotiable instrument if he satisfies the following two conditions:
 He must be entitled to the possession of the instrument in his own name; and
 He must be entitled to receive / recover the amount due on the instrument from the
parties liable under the instrument
Thus, a holder is a bearer of the bearer instrument and the indorsee or payee of the order
AT A GLANCE

instrument.
Explanation: Where the note, bill or cheque is lost and not found again, or is destroyed, the
person in possession of it or the bearer thereof at the time of such loss or destruction shall be
deemed to continue to be its holder.
Holder in due course:
Holder in due course means any person who for consideration becomes the possessor of a
promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque if payable to bearer, or the payee or indorsee thereof,
if payable to order, before it became overdue, without notice that the title of the person from
whom he derived his own title was defective.
Explanation: The title of a person to a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is defective
SPOTLIGHT

when he is not entitled to receive the amount due thereon.


Payment in due course:
Payment in due course means payment in accordance with the apparent tenor of the instrument
in good faith and without negligence to any person in possession thereof under circumstances
which do not afford a reasonable ground for believing that he is not entitled to receive payment
of the amount therein mentioned.
 Practice Question 05:
Under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 briefly describe the terms
‘Negotiation’ and ‘Indorsement’.
 Solution:
STICKY NOTES

Negotiation:
When a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is transferred to any person, so as to
constitute that person the holder of it, the instrument is said to be negotiated.
Indorsement:
When the maker or holder of a negotiable instrument signs the same, otherwise than as maker,
for the purpose of negotiation on the back or face of it or on a slip of paper annexed thereto, or
so signs for the same purpose a stamped paper intended to be completed as a negotiable
instrument he is said to indorse the same and is called the indorser.”

228 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

2. PROMISSORY NOTE
2.1 Definition of promissory note [Section 4]
A “promissory note” is an instrument in writing (not being a bank note or currency note) containing an
unconditional undertaking, signed by the maker, to pay on demand or at a fixed or determinable future time a
certain sum of money only to, or to the order of, a certain person, or to the bearer of the instrument.
The analysis of the definition shows that, a promissory note is a written and signed promise to pay a certain sum
of money to a specified person or his order.

2.2 Parties to a promissory note [Section 7]


Following are the two main parties in a promissory note:

AT A GLANCE
2.2.1 Maker
It is a person who makes the promissory note and promises to pay the money stated in it. The maker is liable to
pay according to tenor of the note and compensate any party to the note for loss sustained because of his default.

2.2.2 Payee
It is a person to whom the amount of promissory note is payable i.e. to whom the promise to pay is made.

2.3 Specimen of a promissory note

Date: September 15, 20XX


Rs. 10,000/- only

SPOTLIGHT
Three months after date I promise to pay Ashraf or to his order the sum of Rupees Ten Thousand, for value
received

To Sign: __________
Ashraf Zahid
Jail Road Saddar
Karachi Karachi

In the specimen Zahid is the maker and Ashraf is the payee

STICKY NOTES
2.4 Essential elements of a promissory note
These essential elements of a promissory note are discussed below:

2.4.1 In writing [Section 4]


A promissory note has to be in writing. An oral promise to pay does not become a promissory note. The writing
may be on any paper, on any book. The words used must impart a clear undertaking to pay, but it is not necessary
that the word promise should be used.
 Example 20:
a) Azam signs the instruments in the following terms: “I promise to pay Babar or order Rs.
500”. This is valid promissory note.
b) Asif signs the instruments in the following terms: “I acknowledge myself to be indebted
to Basit in Rs.1,000 to be paid on demand, for value received”. This is valid promissory
note.
c) Adeel promise to pay Behram a sum of Rs. 500 on telephone. This promise will not make
a promissory note because it is not in writing.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 229


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2.4.2 Promise to pay [Section 4]


There must be a promise or a clear undertaking to pay. A mere acknowledgement of indebtedness is not a
promissory note, although it is valid as an agreement and may be sued upon as such.
 Example 21:
a) Azam signs the instruments in following terms: “Mr. Bilal I owe you Rs. 1,000”. The
instrument is not promissory note as there is no clear undertaking or promise to pay.
There is only an acknowledgement of indebtedness.
b) Asif signs the instruments in following terms: “I am liable to pay to Baqir Rs. 500”. The
instrument is not promissory note as there is no clear undertaking or promise to pay.
There is only an acknowledgement of indebtedness.
c) Adeel signs the instruments in following terms: “I have taken from Behzad Rs.2,000 and
AT A GLANCE

I am accountable to him for the same with interest”. The instrument is not promissory
note as there is no clear undertaking or promise to pay. There is only an
acknowledgement of indebtedness.
d) Akmal signs instrument in following terms: “I acknowledge myself to be indebted to
Bano in Rs.1,000 to be paid on demand for value received.” This is a valid promissory
note.

2.4.3 Definite and unconditional [Section 4 & 5]


The promise must not depend upon the happening of some uncertain event. i.e. a contingency or the fulfilment
of a condition. If an instrument contains a conditional promise to pay, it is not a valid promissory note and will
not become valid and negotiable even after happening of the condition.
 Example 22:
SPOTLIGHT

a) Azam signs the instrument in the following terms: “I promise to pay Basit Rs.500 seven
days after my marriage with Shahzadi”. The instruments is not valid as the payment is
made dependent upon the happening of an uncertain event which may never happen
and as a result the sum may never become payable.
b) Amir signs the instrument in the following terms: “I promise to pay Bilal Rs. 500 on
Dawood’s death, provided Dawood leaves me enough to pay the sum”. The instruments
is not valid as the payment is made dependent upon the happening of an uncertain event
which may never happen and as a result the sum may never become payable.
c) Asif signs the instrument in the following terms: “I promise to pay Babar Rs. 500 as soon
as I can”. The instruments is not valid as the payment is made dependent upon the
STICKY NOTES

happening of an uncertain event which may never happen and as a result the sum may
never become payable.
But a promise to pay is not conditional if the amount is made payable
 at a particular place or
 after a specified time or
 on the happening of an event which must happen, although the time of its happening may be uncertain.
 Example 23:
Ajmal signs an instrument stating “I promise to Pay Babar Rs.500 seven days after Saleem’s
death”, the promissory note is valid because it is not considered to be conditional, for it is certain
that Saleem will die one day.

230 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

2.4.4 Signed by maker [Section 4]


It is imperative that the promissory note should be duly authenticated by the signature of the maker. If the maker
is illiterate he may place his thumb mark.
 Example 24:
Asif writes the instrument but does not sign thereon: “I promise to pay Bilal Rs. 5,000”. The note
is not valid promissory note.

2.4.5 Certain parties [Section 4 & 5]


The instrument points out with certainty as to who is the maker and who is the payee. Where the maker and the
payee cannot be identified with certainty, the instrument even if it contains an unconditional promise to pay is
not a promissory note.

AT A GLANCE
Where the person intended can reasonably be ascertained from the promissory note, he is a certain person
although he may be misnamed or designated by description only.
 Example 25:
A promissory note payable to the principal of a college is regarded as payable to a certain person.
The person can be identified specifically. Hence, it will be considered a valid promissory note.

2.4.6 Sum payable must be certain [Section 4 & 5]


It is essential that sum of money promised to be payable must be certain and definite. The amount payable must
not be capable of contingent addition or subtraction.
 Example 26:

SPOTLIGHT
a) Azam signs instrument in following terms: “I promise to pay Bilal Rs.500,000 and all
other sums which shall be due to him”. The instrument is invalid as promissory notes
because the amount is not certain.
b) Amir signs instrument in following terms: “I promise to pay Babar Rs.300,000 and all
fines according to rules”. The instrument is invalid as promissory notes because the
amount is not certain.
The sum payable is certain:
a) when it is payable with interest (or return in any other form).; or
b) When it is payable at an indicated or current rate of exchange; or

STICKY NOTES
c) When it is payable in instalments, with a provision that on default being made in payment, the balance
unpaid shall become due.
A promise to pay is not ‘conditional’ nor is the sum payable ‘uncertain’ by reason of the sum payable being subject
to adjustment for profit or loss, as the case may be, of the business of the maker.

2.4.7 Sum payable must be legal tender


A promise to pay a certain amount of foreign currency or to deliver a certain quantity of goods is not a promissory
note.
 Example 27:
An instrument signed by Asif, “I promise to pay Kamal Rs. 50,000 and to deliver him my black
horse” is not a valid promissory note.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 231


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 06:


Based on the provisions of Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 briefly explain whether the
following are promissory notes or not.
i. I promise to pay Rahat on demand Rs. 5,000 at my convenience.
ii. On demand, I promise to pay Sonu or order Rs. 5,000, for value received.
iii. I promise to pay Adil or order Rs. 5,000 and 500 shares of Sigma Limited.
iv. I promise to pay Mahi or order Rs. 5,000 with interest calculated at quarterly rests.
v. I promise to pay you or your successors on demand Rs. 10,000.
vi. I promise to pay Rafi or order Rs. 10,000 seven days after Salik’s death.
vii. I am liable to pay Ahmad Rs. 5,000.
AT A GLANCE

 Solution:
i. It is not a promissory note as promise to pay is not “unconditional”.
ii. It is a valid promissory note containing all the essential elements.
iii. It is not a promissory note as the payment is not in terms of money only.
iv. It is not a promissory note as the amount payable under it is not certain.
v. It is not a promissory note as the payee in the instrument is not certain.
vi. It is a valid promissory note. It is not considered to be conditional, for it is certain that
Salik will die, though the exact time of his death is uncertain.
vii. It is not a promissory note as it lacks unconditional undertaking. There is only an
acknowledgement of indebtedness.
SPOTLIGHT

 Practice Question 07:


Sarwat owes Rs. 500,000 to Zain. The amount is payable on 11 August 2016. Sarwat intends to
issue a negotiable instrument to Zain in satisfaction of her debt. Under the provisions of the
Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 advise Sarwat about the type of negotiable instrument which
may be issued to Zain, assuming that Sarwat does not want to involve a third party in making the
payment. Also prepare a draft of the said instrument. (You may make assumptions wherever you
consider necessary).
 Solution:
Sarwat would issue a promissory note to Zain.
Draft of the promissory note
STICKY NOTES

Date: March 12, 2016


Rs. 500,000/- only

Five months after date I promise to pay Zain or to his order the sum of Rupees Five Hundred
Thousand, for value received

To Sd/- __________
Zain Zahid
ABC Road New Town
Karachi Karachi

232 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

3. BILL OF EXCHANGE
3.1 Definition of bill of exchange [Section 5]
A “bill of exchange” is an instrument in writing containing an unconditional order, signed by the maker, directing
a certain person to pay on demand or at a fixed or determinable future time a certain sum of money only to, or
to the order of, a certain person or to the bearer of the instrument.
The analysis of the definition shows that, a bill of exchange is a written and signed order directing a person to
pay a certain sum of money to the bearer of the instrument or to a specified person or his order.
Generally, a bill of exchange is drawn by a creditor, who directs his debtor to pay the money to the person
specified in the instrument.

AT A GLANCE
3.2 Parties to a bill of exchange [Section 7]
Following are the three main parties in a bill of exchange:

3.2.1 Drawer
It is a person who draws a bill of exchange. The drawer is liable on a bill of exchange as principal debtor until the
drawee accepts the bill.

3.2.2 Drawee / Acceptor


It is a person who is ordered to pay the amount of the bill of exchange (on whom the bill is drawn). When drawee
accepts the bill of exchange (when he gives consent to make the payment) he is called the acceptor. The drawee
is not liable until acceptance. On acceptance he becomes liable as acceptor to pay holder on demand after

SPOTLIGHT
maturity.

3.2.3 Payee
It is a person to whom the amount of bill of exchange is payable.

3.3 Specimen of a bill of exchange

Date: September 15, 20XX


Rs. 10,000/- only

Three months after date pay to Yaseen or to his order the sum of Rupees Ten Thousand, for value received.

STICKY NOTES
Accepted
Aslam

To Sign: __________
Aslam Mohsin
Jail Road Saddar
Karachi Karachi

In the specimen Mohsin is the drawer, Aslam is the drawee and Yaseen is the payee.

3.4 Essential elements of a bill of exchange


The essential elements of a bill of exchange are shown below:

3.4.1 In writing [Section 5]


A bill of exchange is required to be in writing. Like promissory note, a bill of exchange also cannot be oral.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 233


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 28:
a) Azam signs the instruments in the following terms: “Pay Rs. 5,000 to Azam or order”. It
is a valid bill.
b) Asif orders to Behram to pay a sum of Rs. 500 on telephone. This order will not make a
bill of exchange because it is not in writing.

3.4.2 Order to pay [Section 5]


A bill of exchange contains an order to pay instead of a promise to pay like in promissory note. This feature
distinguishes it from promissory note. Further, a request to pay money is not considered to be a bill of exchange.
 Example 29:
a) The following instrument signed by Azam is valid bill of exchange as it contains an order
AT A GLANCE

to pay, though the language used is very polite: “Babar, please pay Rs. 50,000 to Ehsaan
or order.”
b) The following instrument signed by Adeel is valid bill of exchange as it contains an order
to pay, though the language used is very polite: “Bilal will much oblige me by paying to
Dawood Rs. 30,000.”
c) The following instrument signed by Akbar is not valid bill of exchange as it contains only
a request to pay and no order to pay: “Babar, please let Jazib have Rs. 50,000, and place
it to my account and oblige.”
d) The following instrument signed by Asif is not valid bill of exchange as it contains only a
request to pay and no order to pay: “Bushra, I shall be highly obliged if you make it
convenient to pay Rs.10,000 to Ghalib.”
SPOTLIGHT

3.4.3 Definite and unconditional [Section 5]


The order to pay should not depend upon a condition or upon the happening of an uncertain event.
 Example 30:
Asif draws a bill on Behram as “Pay Rs. 5,000 to Saleem as early as possible”. It is not a valid bill
of exchange on account of uncertainty.
But an order to pay is not conditional if the amount is made payable
 at a particular place or
 after a specified time or
STICKY NOTES

 on the happening of an event which must happen, although the time of its happening may be uncertain.

3.4.4 Signed by drawer and drawee [Section 5]


The instrument must be signed by the maker i.e. drawer and subsequently by drawee (for acceptance).
 Example 31:
Asif draws a bill on Behram as “Pay Rs. 10,000 to Saleem or order” but does not sign it. It is not a
valid bill of exchange.

3.4.5 Certain parties [Section 5]


All the parties must be certain i.e. indicated in a bill of exchange with reasonable certainty.
Where the person intended can reasonably be ascertained from the bill of exchange, he is a certain person
although he may be misnamed or designated by description only.

234 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

 Example 32:
Asif draws a bill as “Pay Rs. 10,000 to Jameel or order” but does not specify the name of drawee.
It is not a valid bill of exchange.
Where the payee is fictitious or non-existing person, the bill of exchange may be treated as payable to bearer.

3.4.6 Sum Payable must be certain [Section 5]


It is essential that sum of money ordered to be payable must be certain and definite. The amount payable must
not be capable of contingent addition or subtraction.
 Example 33:
Majeed draws a bill on Naveed as “Pay to Saeed Rs. 20,000 and all other sums due to him”. It is
not a valid bill.

AT A GLANCE
The sum payable is certain:
a) when it is payable with interest (or return in any other form).; or
b) When it is payable at an indicated or current rate of exchange; or
c) When it is payable in instalments, with a provision that on default being made in payment, the balance
unpaid shall become due.
An order to pay is not ‘conditional’ nor is the sum payable ‘uncertain’ by reason of the sum payable being subject
to adjustment for profit or loss, as the case may be, of the business of the maker.

3.4.7 Sum payable must be legal tender

SPOTLIGHT
If the instrument contains an order to pay something other than money or something in addition to money, it
will not be valid bill of exchange.
 Example 34:
Azam draws a bill on Babar as “Pay Rs. 50,000 and deliver 100 bags of wheat to Saleem”. It is not
a valid bill.

3.5 Difference between promissory note and bill of exchange


Following are the few differences between promissory note and bill of exchange:

Promissory note Bill of exchange

STICKY NOTES
Number of parties
There are two parties i.e. the maker and the payee. There are three parties i.e. the drawer, the
drawee and the payee.
The maker of the note cannot be payee
The maker of a promissory note cannot be the payee for the The drawer and the payee may be one and the
simple reason that the same person cannot be both the same person as where a bill is drawn as “Pay to
promisor and the promisee. me or my order”.
Promise and order
There is a promise to make the payment. There is an order for making the payment.
Acceptance
A promissory note requires no acceptance as it is signed A bill of exchange needs acceptance by the
by the person who is liable to pay. drawee before it is presented for payment.
Nature of liability The liability of a drawer of a bill of exchange is
secondary and conditional. It is only when the

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 235


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Promissory note Bill of exchange


The liability of the maker of a promissory note is primary acceptor does not honour the bill that the
and absolute. liability of the drawer arises as a surety.
Maker’s position The drawer of an accepted bill stands in
The maker of a promissory note stands in immediate immediate relation with the acceptor and not
relation with the payee. the payee.

Payable to bearer A bill of exchange can be so drawn provided


A promissory note cannot be drawn “payable to bearer”. that it is not drawn “payable to bearer on
demand”.
Notice of dishonour In case of dishonour of a bill of exchange, notice
of dishonour must be given by the “holder” to
AT A GLANCE

In case of dishonour of a promissory note, no notice of


dishonour is required to be given to the maker. all prior parties who are liable to pay (including
the drawer and indorser).

 Practice Question 08:


Specimen of a Negotiable Instrument
Date: September 12, 2015
Rs. 10,000/- only

Please pay on demand to Tauseef or to his order the sum of Rupees One Hundred Thousand
only, for value received.

Accepted
SPOTLIGHT

Laila

To Sd/- __________
Laila Laeeq
Busy Road Saddar
Karachi Karachi

Identify the type of above negotiable instrument and briefly describe its essential characteristics
under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881.
 Solution:
STICKY NOTES

Bill of Exchange:
The above negotiable instrument is a bill of exchange.
Essential characteristics of a bill of exchange:
Following are the essential characteristics of a bill of exchange:
i. In writing: A bill of exchange is required to be in writing.
ii. Order to pay: The drawer orders the drawee to pay money to the payee. Mere request
does not constitute an order.
iii. Definite and unconditional: The order to pay should not depend upon a condition or
upon the happening of an uncertain event.
iv. Signed by drawer: The instrument must be signed by the maker (drawer) and accepted
by the drawee.
v. Certain parties: All the parties must be certain i.e. indicated in a bill of exchange with
reasonable certainty.

236 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

vi. Sum payable must be legal tender: The order must be to pay money and money only.
vii. Sum Payable must be certain: It is essential that sum of money ordered to be payable
must be certain and definite. However, it may include future interest or return in any
other form or is payable at an indicated rate of exchange, or is payable at the current rate
of exchange or the sum payable being subject to adjustment for profit or loss of the
business of the maker.
viii. Time for payment: The time for payment may be on demand or at a fixed or
determinable future time.
ix. It must be delivered: A bill of exchange is incomplete until it is delivered to the payee.
 Practice Question 09:
In view of the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 comment on the type and

AT A GLANCE
validity of each of the following instruments signed by Rahul:
i. Nauman please pay to Mahreen Rs. 100,000.
ii. Nauman, I shall be highly obliged if you make it convenient to pay Rs. 100,000 to
Mahreen.
iii. I acknowledge myself to be indebted to Nauman in Rs. 100,000 to be paid on demand,
for value received.
iv. I promise to pay Mahreen or order Rs. 100,000 six days after Nauman’s death.
 Solution:
i. It is a valid bill of exchange as it contains an unconditional order to pay.
ii. It is in the nature of bill of exchange but it is not a valid bill of exchange as it contains

SPOTLIGHT
only request to pay and not an order to pay.
iii. It is a valid promissory note containing all the essential elements.
iv. It is a valid promissory note. It is not considered to be conditional, for it is certain that
Nauman will die, though the exact time of his death is uncertain.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 237


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

4. TYPES OF NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS


Negotiable instruments can be classified in following ways:
 Order instrument and bearer instrument
 Inland instrument and foreign instrument
 Demand instrument and time instrument

4.1 Order instrument [Section 13]


A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is payable to order if either of the following two conditions are
fulfilled:
 Which is expressed to be so payable or
AT A GLANCE

 Which is expressed to be payable to a particular person


and does not contain words:
 which prohibit transfer or
 indicate an intention that it shall not be transferable

Note: An order instrument can be transferred by an indorsement on it and then its delivery.
 Example 35:
The following words on a negotiable instrument are indicating that the instrument is an order
instrument:
SPOTLIGHT

 “Pay Azam….”
 “Pay Azam or order…..”
 “Pay Azam or Babar…..”

4.2 Bearer instrument [Section 13]


A promissory note of bill of exchange or cheque is payable to bearer if either of the following two conditions is
fulfilled:
 expressed to be so payable, or
 last indorsement must be an indorsement in blank.
Note: A bearer instrument can be transferred by mere delivery.
STICKY NOTES

 Example 36:
The following words on a negotiable instrument are indicating that the instrument is a bearer
instrument:
 “Pay Azam or bearer….”
 “Pay bearer…..”
 “Pay to bearer of this instrument…..”

4.3 Inland instrument [Section 11]


A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque which is:
 Made or drawn in Pakistan and also made payable in Pakistan, or
 Made or drawn in Pakistan upon any person resident in Pakistan, although it may be payable in a foreign
country.
is called an inland instrument.
Note: An inland instrument remains inland even if it has been indorsed in a foreign country.

238 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

 Example 37:
 A promissory note made in Multan and payable in Peshawar.
 A bill of exchange drawn in Lahore on a person resident in Sadiqabad payable in
Sadiqabad or in Dubai.
 A bill of exchange drawn in Sukkur on a person resident in Toba Tek Singh although it
may be payable in Afghanistan.

4.4 Foreign instrument [Section 12]


An instrument, which is not an inland instrument, is deemed to be a foreign instrument.
 Example 38:
 Promissory note made in Pakistan but payable in Myanmar.

AT A GLANCE
 A bill of exchange drawn in UK on a person residing in UK, and made payable in UK.
 A bill of exchange drawn in UK on a person residing in UK, and made payable in Pakistan.
 A bill of exchange drawn in Pakistan on a person residing in UK, and made payable in
UK.

4.5 Demand instrument [Section 19]


Instruments payable on demand means the instrument in which no time for payment is mentioned. A cheque is
always payable on demand. A promissory note or bill of exchange is payable on demand where:
 It is expressed to be so; or
 It is expressed to be payable “at sight” or “presentment” or “on demand”; or

SPOTLIGHT
 No time for payment is specified; or
 The bill or note accepted or indorsed after it is overdue, as regards to person accepting or indorsing it.

Note:
 'At sight' and presentment means on demand.
 An instrument on demand is payable immediately.
 Example 39:
Amjad drawn a bill on Sajid and no time of payment was specified in it. The bill is payable on
demand. On demand, Sajid has to make the payment immediately.

STICKY NOTES
4.6 Time instrument [Section 21B]
An instrument payable after a fixed time or on a specified date is called “time instrument”. A promissory note or
bill of exchange is a time instrument when it is expressed to be payable.
 After a specified period
 On a specific day
 Certain date after sight
 On the happening of event which is certain to happen e.g. death.

Note: There can be a “time bill”, “time note” but not a “time cheque” because the cheque cannot be expressed to
be payable otherwise than on demand.
 Example 40:
Adeel signed a bill of exchange with following words: “Three months after date pay to Raheel or
order the sum of Rupees ten thousands only, for value received.” It is a time instrument.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 239


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

5. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. A promissory note is a document in writing containing
(a) A conditional promise to pay
(b) A conditional order to pay
(c) An unconditional promise to pay
(d) An unconditional order to pay

02. If a document contains an order directing a person to pay, it is


(a) A promissory note
AT A GLANCE

(b) Not a promissory note


(c) A bill of exchange
(d) A conditional promissory note

03. A promise to pay is conditional if


(a) It depends upon certain event i.e. death
(b) The promise is to pay on X’s death if he leaves the maker enough to pay
(c) It is to pay on demand
(d) It is to pay after a certain period
SPOTLIGHT

04. In promissory note, there are


(a) Two parties
(b) Three parties
(c) Four parties
(d) Five parties

05. A holder in due course gets an instrument


STICKY NOTES

(a) Subject to defects


(b) Free from defects
(c) Subject to certain rights
(d) Which cannot be further negotiated

06. A promissory note, cheque or bill of exchange is an inland instrument if it is


(a) Drawn in Pakistan and payable outside
(b) Drawn upon any person resident in Pakistan
(c) Drawn and payable in Pakistan
(d) Drawn and payable outside Pakistan

240 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

07. The maker of a bill of exchange is called:


(a) Drawee
(b) Drawer
(c) Acceptor
(d) Payee

08. Which of the following is not applicable to negotiable instruments?


(a) It must be in writing.
(b) It must be transferable.

AT A GLANCE
(c) It must be registered.
(d) It must be signed.

09. Bearer instrument means an instrument:


(a) Which is expressed to be payable to bearer.
(b) On which the last indorsement is in blank.
(c) Either (a) or (b)
(d) Which is payable after certain days of making the instrument.

SPOTLIGHT
10. Which of the following may be presented at any time for payment?
(a) Bearer instrument payable on specified time.
(b) Order instrument payable on specified time
(c) Order instrument payable on demand.
(d) None of the above

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 241


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (c) A promissory note is a written and signed unconditional undertaking to pay a certain sum of
money to a specified person or his order.

02. (c) A bill of exchange is a written and signed order directing a person to pay a certain sum of money
to the bearer of the instrument or to a specified person or his order.

03. (b) The promise must not depend upon the happening of some uncertain event.

04. (a) There are two parties in a promissory note i.e. Maker and Payee

05. (b) It means that once an instrument is received in the hands of the holder in due course it becomes
AT A GLANCE

free from all defects.

06. (c) An inland instrument is made or drawn in Pakistan and also made payable in Pakistan.

07. (b) Drawer

08. (c) A negotiable instrument is not required to be registered.

09. (c) (a) and (b) both are bearer instruments.

10. (c) A demand instrument may be presented for payment at any time.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

242 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS

STICKY NOTES

Parties to the negotiable instruments


Maker The person who makes a promissory note.
Payee The person named in the instrument, to whom or to whose order
the money is by the instrument directed to be paid, is called the
“payee.”
Drawer The maker of a bill of exchange or cheque is called the “drawer”.
Drawee The person on whom bill of exchange or cheque is drawn and who

AT A GLANCE
is directed to pay the amount.
Acceptor After the drawee of a bill has signed his assent upon the bill, or, if
there are more parts thereof than one, upon one of such parts, and
delivered the same, or given notice of such signing to the holder or
to some person on his behalf, he is called the “ acceptor."
Holder The “holder” of a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque
means the payee or indorsee who is in possession of it or the bearer
thereof but does not include a beneficial owner claim ing through a
benamidar.
Holder in “Holder in due course” means any person who for consideration
due course becomes the possessor of a promissory note, bill of exchange or
cheque if payable to bearer, or the payee or indorsee thereof, if

SPOTLIGHT
payable to order, before it became overdue, without notice that the
title of the person from whom he derived his own title was
defective.

Important definitions
Negotiation When a promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is
transferred to any person, so as to constitute that person the hol
der thereof, the instrument is said to be negotiated.

STICKY NOTES
Indorsement When the maker or holder of a negotiable instrument signs the
same, otherwise than as such maker, for the purpose of
negotiation, on the back or face thereof or on a slip of paper an
nexed thereto, or so signs for the same purpose a stamped paper
intended to be completed as a negotiable instrument, he is said
to indorse the same, and is called the ”indorser.”
Payment in “Payment in due course” means payment in accordance with the
due course apparent tenor of the instrument in good faith and with out
negligence to any person in possession thereof under circum
stances which do not afford a reasonable ground for believing
that he is not entitled to receive payment of the amount therein
mentioned.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 243


CHAPTER 14: NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

Essential elements of promissory note


1. It must be in writing
2. There must be promise to pay
3. The promise must be definite and unconditional
4. It must be signed by maker
5. The parties should be certain
6. Sum payable must be certain
7. Sum payable must be legal tender
AT A GLANCE

Essential elements of bill of exchange


1. It must be in writing
2. There must be order to pay
3. The order must be definite and unconditional
4. It must be signed by drawer and drawee
5. The parties should be certain
6. Sum payable must be certain
7. Sum payable must be legal tender
SPOTLIGHT

Types of negotiable instruments


Order A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is payable to order
instrumnet which is expressed to be so payable or which is expressed to be
payable to a particular person, and does not contain words
prohibiting transfer or indicating an intention that it shall not be
transferable.
Bearer A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque is payable to bearer
instrument which is expressed to be so payable or on which the only or last
indorsement is an indorsement in blank.
Inland A promissory note, bill of exchange or cheque drawn or made in
STICKY NOTES

instrument Pakistan, and made payable in, or drawn upon any person resident
in, Pakistan shall be deemed to be an inland instrument.
Foreign Any such instrument not drawn, made or made payable as inland
insturment instrument shall be deemed to be a foreign instrument.
Demand A promissory note or bill of exchange is payable on demand, where
instrument it is expressed to be so, or to be payable at sight or on presentment;
or where no time for payment is specified in it ; or where the note
or bill accepted or indorsed after it is overdue, as regards the
person accepting or indorsing it.
Time A promissory note or bill of exchange is payable at a determinable
instrument future time within the meaning of this Act if it is expressed to be
payable at a fixed time after date or sight; or on or at a fixed time
after the occurrence of a specified event which is certain to
happen, though the time of its happening may be uncertain.

244 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 15

PROVISIONS RELATING
TO CHEQUES

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
A cheque is a bill of exchange drawn on specified banker and
payable on demand.
AT A GLANCE
When a cheque bears across its face two parallel transverse
SPOTLIGHT lines, the cheque is said to be crossed. The payment of a crossed
cheque can be obtained only through another banker. The
1. Cheque crossing may be general, special, or restrictive and in case of
‘non-negotiable crossing, the title of transferee cannot be better
2. Crossing of Cheque than that of the transferor.
The law also specifies the liability and protection of liability of
3. Payment of Cheque
paying banker and collecting banker in case of crossed cheques.

SPOTLIGHT
4. Objective Based Q&A In general, when a banker acts in good faith and without
negligence it does not incur liability for payment or collection of
STICKY NOTES payment on behalf of the customer.
The banker must refuse payment when customer stops the
payment or when banker receives information regarding death
of customer or adjudication of customer as an insolvent.
The rules apply to bank draft in the same way as they apply to
cheques.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 245


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. CHEQUE
1.1 Definition of cheque [Section 6]
Cheque is a bill of exchange drawn on a specified banker and not expressed to be payable otherwise than on
demand.
The analysis of the above definition reveals that a cheque is a bill of exchange but is different in following two
characteristics:
 Drawee will always be a banker
 Always payable on demand

1.2 Parties to a cheque [Section 7 & 3(b)]


AT A GLANCE

Following are the three main parties in a cheque:

1.2.1 Drawer
It is a person who draws a cheque i.e. the customer/ account-holder of a bank.

1.2.2 Drawee
It is a banker who is ordered to pay the amount of the cheque.
“Banker” means a person transacting the business of accepting, for the purpose of lending or investment, or
deposits of money from the public, repayable on demand or otherwise and withdrawable by cheque, draft, order
or otherwise, and includes any Post Office Savings Bank.
SPOTLIGHT

1.2.3 Payee
It is a person to whom the amount of cheque is payable.

1.3 Specimen of a cheque

ABC Bank Limited Date: September 15, 20XX


Main Branch, Karachi Cheque no:______

Pay _____________________________________________________ OR BEARER


STICKY NOTES

Rupees _______________________________________

Account no: _____________


Title of account

1.4
DoEssential
not writeelements
below thisofline
a cheque [Section 5 & 6]
The essential elements of a cheque are as below:
 It must be in writing
 There must be an express order to pay and not a request to pay
 The order must be definite and unconditional
 It must be signed by the drawer
 The three parties (drawer, drawee and payee) must be certain.
 The order must be to pay a certain sum

246 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

 The order must be to pay money only


 It must always be drawn upon a specified banker
 It must always be payable on demand
 Example 01:
Adeel draws a bearer cheque on 1st July 2020. It is valid for six months. The holder of cheque
may get cash by demanding payment over the counter of the banker on whom the cheque is
drawn during this time.

1.5 Cheque not operating as assignment of funds [Section 131C]


A cheque, of itself, does not operate as an assignment of any part of the funds to the credit of the drawer with the
banker.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 02:
Adeel draws a cheque of Rs. 5 million in favour of Kashif on 1st July 2021. Kashif does not become
entitled to Rs. 5 million that are in the account of Adeel at bank on just receiving this cheque. He
must deposit the cheque in his account and when bank transfers the amount to his credit, he will
become entitled to those Rs. 5 million.

1.6 Difference between cheque and bill of exchange


Following are the few differences between cheque and bill of exchange:

Cheque Bill of exchange


Drawee

SPOTLIGHT
A bill may be drawn on any person, including a
A cheque is always drawn on a banker. banker.
Payable on demand
A cheque can only be drawn payable on demand. A bill may be drawn payable on demand or on the
expiry of a certain period after date or sight.
Payable to bearer on demand
A cheque drawn “payable to bearer on demand” is A bill drawn “payable to bearer on demand” is
valid. absolutely void (though can be made payable to
the bearer later by indorsement in blank).
Acceptance

STICKY NOTES
A cheque does not require any acceptance by the A bill requires acceptance by the drawee before
drawee before payment can be demanded. he can be made liable upon it.
Stamp
A cheque does not require any stamp. A bill of exchange must be properly stamped.
Crossing
A cheque may be crossed for the purpose of safety. A bill of exchange cannot be crossed.
Stopping the payment
The payment of a cheque may be countermanded by The payment of a bill cannot be countermanded
the drawer. by the drawer.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 247


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. CROSSING OF CHEQUE
2.1 Purpose of crossing
A cheque is said to be crossed when it bears across its face two parallel transverse lines which are usually drawn
on the left hand top corner of the cheque. It is an instance of an alteration which is authorised by the Act. A
crossing is a direction to the paying banker not to pay across the counter.
The purpose of crossing is to direct the drawee (banker) to pay the amount of the cheque only to a banker so that
the party who receives the payment can easily be traced.

2.2 Types of crossing

2.2.1 General crossing [Section 123]


AT A GLANCE

A cheque is said to be crossed generally where it bears across its face an addition of the words “and company” or
any abbreviation of it between two parallel transverse lines, or of two parallel transverse lines simply.
 Example 03:

Effect of general crossing [Section 126]


When a cheque is crossed generally the banker on whom it is drawn shall not pay it otherwise than to a banker.
SPOTLIGHT

2.2.2 Special crossing [Section 124]


A cheque is said to be crossed especially where it bears across its face an addition of:
 Name of the banker
 Parallel lines are not necessary.
 Example 04:
STICKY NOTES

Effect of special crossing [Section 126]


When a cheque is crossed specifically the banker on whom it is drawn shall not pay it otherwise than to a banker
to whom it is crossed or his agent for collection.

2.2.3 Restrictive crossing [Section 123A]


Restrictive crossing may be added with general crossing by adding the words “A/c Payee” or “A/c Payee only”.
 Example 05:

248 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

Effect of restrictive crossing


Where a cheque is crossed as “account payee”, it shall cease to be negotiable. Strictly speaking, the amount
collected on the cheque must be credited only to the account of payee named in the cheque.
 Example 06:
Kamran provided some services to Ikram. Ikram paid him by cheque drawn on ABC Bank with
“Account payee only” crossing. Kamran has only one bank account in XYZ Bank. Kamran will
deposit the cheque in his account with XYZ Bank. XYZ Bank (as collecting banker) shall get
clearing of cheque from ABC Bank (paying banker). XYZ Bank shall credit the amount in account
of Kamran from where Kamran may transfer or withdraw the amount.

2.2.4 ‘Not negotiable’ crossing [Section 130]

AT A GLANCE
The addition of the words not negotiable does not restrict the further transferability of the cheque. It only takes
away the main feature of negotiability, which is transferability free from defects.
 Example 07:

Effect of ‘not negotiable’ crossing

SPOTLIGHT
The effect of the words ‘not negotiable’ on a crossed cheque is that the title of the transferee of such a cheque
cannot be better than that of its transferor.
Therefore, a holder with a defective title cannot give a good title to a subsequent holder. The object of crossing a
cheque not negotiable is to afford protection to the drawer or holder of the cheque against miscarriage or
dishonesty in the course of transit by making it difficult for the cheque so crossed cashed, until it reaches its
destination.

2.3 Crossing of a cheque after issue [Section 125 & 125A]


A crossing authorised by the Act is a material part of the cheque. It means that it is unlawful for any person to
obliterate, add or alter the crossing except as authorised under the Act.

STICKY NOTES
A cheque may be crossed after its issue in the following manner:

Case Right to cross

Where a cheque is uncrossed The holder may cross it generally or specially.

Where a cheque is crossed generally The holder may cross it specially by adding the name of
the banker.

Where a cheque is crossed generally or specially The holder may add the word “Not negotiable”.

Where a cheque is crossed specially The banker to whom it is crossed may again cross it
especially to another banker (his agent) for collection.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 249


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Practice Question 01:


Under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 discuss the effect(s) of the words
‘Not negotiable’ on a cheque crossed specially.
 Solution:
The effect of the words “not negotiable” on a crossed cheque is that the title of the transferee of
such a cheque cannot be better than that of its transferor. The addition of the words not
negotiable does not restrict the further transferability of the cheque. It only takes away the main
feature of negotiability, which is transferability free from defects.
 Practice Question 02:
Under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 identify the person(s) who may
cross the cheque after its issue and the manner in which it may be crossed.
AT A GLANCE

 Solution:
 Where a cheque is uncrossed, the holder may cross it generally or specially.
 Where a cheque is crossed generally, the holder may cross it specially.
 Where a cheque is crossed generally or specially, the holder may add the words “not
negotiable”.
 Where a cheque is crossed specially, the banker to whom it is crossed may again cross it
specially to another banker, his agent, for collection.
 When an uncrossed cheque, or a cheque crossed generally, is sent to a banker for
collection, he may cross it specially to himself.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

250 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

3. PAYMENT OF CHEQUE
3.1 Payment of cheque crossed specially more than once [Section 127]
Where the cheque is crossed specially to more than one banker, except when crossed to an agent for collection,
the banker to whom it is drawn shall refuse payment thereof.
 Example 08:
Azam drawn a cheque on ABC Bank in favour of Babar. Azam had crossed cheque specially twice
mentioning the name of XYZ Bank and KLM Bank. ABC Bank must refuse the payment of such
cheque.
 Example 09:

AT A GLANCE
Jazib drawn a cheque on ABC Bank in favour of Ghalib. He crossed cheque specially mentioning
the name of XYZ Bank. XYZ Bank crossed it specially again in favour of KLM Bank, who shall
collect the amount from ABC Bank as agent of XYZ Bank. ABC Bank shall not refuse payment of
the cheque.

3.2 Payment of crossed chque in due course [Section 128]


Where the banker, on whom a cross cheque is drawn, makes a payment in due course, the paying banker and the
drawer are entitled to be positioned as if the cheque had been paid to and received by the true owner thereof.
 Example 10:
Kashif gave a cheque drawn on ABC Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Munawar with ‘account payee’ crossing.
Another person named Munawar (having account in XYZ Bank) stole the cheque and presented

SPOTLIGHT
for credit to his account. ABC Bank paid the amount in due course to XYZ Bank. XYZ Bank credited
the amount to the credit of (fake) Munawar, who then withdrew the amount from his account.
ABC Bank (as paying banker) and Kashif shall be entitled to be positioned as if the cheque had
been paid to true owner (the real Munawar).

3.3 Payment of crossed cheque out of due course [Section 129]


Where the banker, on whom a cross cheque is drawn, makes a payment out of due course, the paying banker
shall be liable to the true owner of the cheque for any loss he may sustain owing to the cheque having been so
paid.
 Example 11:

STICKY NOTES
Adeel gave a cheque drawn on KLM Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Kumail with general crossing. The
cheque was stolen by Kamil and he presented the cheque on counter of KLM Bank for payment.
KLM Bank paid the amount over the counter. This is payment out of due course as the cheque
was not payable to bearer. KLM Bank is liable to Kumail for the loss.
However, a paying banker shall not be responsible if it pays the cheque in good faith and without negligence
where a cheque is presented for payment which does not appear to be crossed or have had crossing which has
been obliterated or altered.
 Example 12:
Adeel gave a cheque drawn on KLM Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Kumail with “account payee” crossing.
The cheque was stolen by Kamil who concealed the crossing in such a way that the cheque
appeared to have never been crossed. Kamil presented the cheque on counter of KLM Bank for
payment. KLM Bank paid the amount over the counter. KLM Bank is not liable in this case.

3.4 Protection to the banker in case of defective title [Section 131]


A collecting/receiving banker is one who receives the payment of a crossed cheque on behalf of his customer.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 251


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

If the collecting banker has collected a cheque on behalf of a person whose title to the cheque was defective, the
collecting banker would be protected and would not be held liable in conversion to the true owner, provided it
proves that it acted in good faith and without negligence.
 Example 13:
Kashif gave a cheque drawn on ABC Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Munawar with ‘account payee’ crossing.
Another person named Munawar (having account in XYZ Bank) stole the cheque and presented
for credit to his account. Then, XYZ Bank sent the cheque for collection to ABC Bank. ABC Bank
paid the amount in due course to XYZ Bank. XYZ Bank credited the amount to the credit of (fake)
Munawar in good faith and without negligence, who then withdrew the amount from his account.
XYZ Bank shall be protected and would not be held liable to true owner (the real Munawar).
This protection to the receiving banker is available even if it credits customer’s account with the amount of the
cheque before receiving payment thereof.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 14:
Kashif gave a cheque drawn on ABC Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Munawar with ‘account payee’ crossing.
Another person named Munawar (having account in XYZ Bank) stole the cheque and presented
for credit to his account. XYZ Bank credited the amount to the credit of (fake) Munawar in good
faith and without negligence, who then withdrew the amount from his account. Then, XYZ Bank
sent the cheque for collection to ABC Bank. ABC Bank paid the amount in due course to XYZ Bank.
XYZ Bank shall be protected and would not be held liable to true owner (the real Munawar).

3.5 Protection to the banker crediting cheque crossed ‘account payee’ [Section 131B]
Similarly, if the collecting banker has collected a cheque which does not at the time of delivery appear to be
crossed “account payee” or to have had a crossing “account payee” which has been obliterated or altered, the
SPOTLIGHT

banker, in good faith and without negligence collecting payment of the cheque and crediting proceeds thereof to
a customer, shall not incur any liability by reason of the cheque having been so crossed.
 Example 15:
Adeel gave a cheque drawn on KLM Bank of Rs. 10,000 to Kumail with “account payee” crossing.
The cheque was stolen by Kamil who concealed the “account payee” crossing in such a way that
the cheque appeared to have crossed generally only. Kamil presented the cheque for credit to his
account at XYZ Bank. XYZ Bank collected payment from KLM Bank and (in good faith and without
negligence) credited to Kamil’s account who then withdrew the amount. XYZ Bank shall not incur
any liability.
STICKY NOTES

3.6 Revocation of banker’s authority [Section 122A]


The duty and authority of a banker to pay a cheque drawn on him by his customer are determined by:
 Countermand of payment;
 Notice of customer’s death;
 Notice of adjudication of the customer as an insolvent.
 Example 16:
Anum drawn a bearer cheque on her banker but lost it before encashment. She informed the
banker immediately the cheque number and details. Someone found that bearer cheque and is
demanding the payment. The banker must refuse.
 Example 17:
A customer died on 16th March. His legal representative informed the banker of his death on
26th March day-end. The banker must refuse to honour cheques from 27th March. However, the
banker is not liable if any payment of cheque was made from 16th March to 26th March.

252 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

 Example 18:
Abid had account in PQR Bank. Abid was adjudicated as insolvent on 9 th February and it was
communicated to PQR Bank on 10 th February. PQR bank must refuse the payment of cheques
from account of Abid from 10th February.

3.7 Rules applicable to bank draft [Section 131A]


The rules relating to payment of cheque are also relevant to bank draft as if the draft were a cheque.
A bank draft is an order issued by one bank on another bank or on its own branch instructing it to pay a specified
sum of money to a specified person or his order. A bank draft is an instrument similar to cheque with following
distinctions:
 It can be drawn only by a bank on another bank or on its own branch and not by an individual as in the

AT A GLANCE
case of a cheque.
 It cannot be made payable to bearer.
 Its payment cannot be stopped as easily as that of a cheque.
 Example 19:
Adeel made a deal to buy a plot of land, the seller required payment by bank draft. Adeel went to
his banker and applied for a bank draft and provided details. The banker transferred the relevant
amount from Adeel’s account and transferred it to Bank’s name and issued the bank draft to
Adeel in the name of seller and particulars of Adeel were also mentioned on it. Adeel gave this
bank draft to seller in consideration of transfer of plot in his name. The seller will deposit the
bank draft in his account and his account will be credited with the amount. The payment is more
secure for seller because bank draft cannot be dishonoured like a cheque due to insufficient fund
in the account.

SPOTLIGHT
 Practice Question 03:
Under the provisions of the Negotiable Instruments Act, 1881 describe the purpose of crossing a
cheque. Also state whether a cheque can be crossed specially more than once.
 Solution:
Purpose of crossing a cheque:
The purpose of crossing a cheque is to direct the drawee (banker) to pay the amount of the
cheque only to a banker so that the party who receives the payment can easily be traced.
Crossing of cheque specially more than once:

STICKY NOTES
Yes, it is allowed when a banker in whose favour a crossing is made, once again crosses it
specially in favour of his agent (another banker) for collection.
 Practice Question 04:
A cheque is drawn payable to 'Bilal or order'. It is stolen and Bilal's indorsement is forged. The
banker pays the cheque in due course. Is the banker discharged from liability? Would it make any
difference if the drawer's signature were forged?
 Solution:
Where a cheque payable to order purports to be indorsed by or on behalf of the payee (i.e. Bilal),
the drawee (i.e. the collecting banker) is discharged by payment in due course. Therefore the
banker is discharged from liability as a banker is not expected to know the signatures of payees
who are not the clients of the bank.
On the other hand, a banker paying a cheque on which the drawer's signature is forged is
responsible and should bear the loss.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 253


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

4. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Which instrument is immediately payable on demand?
(a) Cheque
(b) Promissory Note
(c) Bill of exchange
(d) All of these

02. Addition of the words “non-negotiable” to the crossing


(a) Restricts transferability of cheque
AT A GLANCE

(b) Makes no difference


(c) Does not restrict further transferability of cheque
(d) Makes the cheque invalid

03. Where a cheque bears across its face the name of the banker, the crossing is
(a) General crossing
(b) Special crossing
(c) Not-negotiable crossing
(d) Restrictive crossing
SPOTLIGHT

04. A bill of exchange, other than a cheque, cannot be


(a) Indorsed
(b) Crossed
(c) Accepted
(d) Negotiated

05. Where a cheque bears across its face the words “A/c Payee” or “A/c Payee Only”, the crossing is
STICKY NOTES

(a) Special Crossing


(b) Not-negotiable crossing
(c) General Crossing
(d) Restrictive Crossing

06. Mr. A sign the instruments in the following terms


1. “I promise to pay Mr. B or order Rs. 500/-“
2. “I acknowledged myself to be indebted to Mr. B in Rs. 1000/- to be paid on demand, for value
received”.
3. Mr. A promise to pay Mr. B sum of Rs. 500/- on telephone.
4. “I am liable to pay to Mr. B Rs. 500/-“

254 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

Identify the correct one:


(a) 1&2
(b) 1&3
(c) 3&4
(d) 2&4

07. Identify the following type of crossing on a cheque:

AT A GLANCE
(a) General crossing
(b) Ordinary crossing
(c) Particular crossing
(d) Special crossing

SPOTLIGHT
08. Identify the following type of crossing on a cheque:

(a) Negotiable crossing

STICKY NOTES
(b) Non-negotiable crossing
(c) Special crossing
(d) General crossing

09. Choose the incorrect statement in relation to crossing and payment of cheques:
(a) A collecting/receiving banker is one who receives the payment of a crossed cheque on behalf of
his customer.
(b) The protection to the collecting banker is not available even if it credits customer’s account with
the amount of the cheque before receiving payment thereof.
(c) Where the cheque is crossed specially to more than one banker, except when crossed to an agent
for collection, the banker to whom it is drawn shall refuse payment thereof.
(d) The addition of the words not negotiable does not restrict the further transferability of the
cheque.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 255


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

10. The duty and authority of a banker to pay a cheque drawn on him by his customer are determined by:
(a) Countermand of payment.
(b) Notice of customer’s death.
(c) Notice of adjudication of the customer as an insolvent.
(d) All of above
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

256 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES

ANSWERS
01. (a) Cheque is bill of exchange drawn on a specified banker and not expressed to be payable
otherwise than on demand.

02. (c) The addition of the words not negotiable does not restrict the further transferability of the
cheque. It only takes away the main feature of negotiability i.e. free from defects

03. (b) The cheque is said to be crossed specially where it bears across its face an addition of name
of the banker and parallel lines are not necessary.

04. (b) Only a cheque can be crossed when it bears across its face two parallel transverse lines.

AT A GLANCE
05. (d) The effect of restrictive crossing is that the amount collected on the cheque must be credited
only to the account of payee.

06. (a) I and II are valid promissory notes because they fulfil all the essential elements of the
promissory note.

07. (a) A cheque is said to be crossed generally where it bears across its face an addition of the
words “and company” or any abbreviation of it between two parallel transfers lines.

08. (c) The cheque is said to be crossed specially where it bears across its face an addition of name
of the banker and parallel lines are not necessary.

SPOTLIGHT
09. (b) The protection to the collecting banker is available even in that case.

10. (d) All of above

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 257


CHAPTER 15: PROVISIONS RELATING TO CHEQUES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

Cheque
Cheque is a bill of exchange but is different in following two characteristics:
1. Darwee will always be a banker
2. Always payable on demand
Parties to a cheque include drawer, drawee and payee.
A cheque, of itself, does not operate as an assignment of any part of the funds to the
credit of the drawer with the banker.
AT A GLANCE

Crossing of cheque and effect thereof


Crossing Effect
1. General Payable to another banker
2. Special Payable to specified banker
3. Restrictive Credited only to the account of payee named in the cheque
4. Not-negotiable The title of transferee cannot be better than that of its
transfereor.
SPOTLIGHT

Payment of cheque – Summary of Rules


1. Payment of cheque crossed specially more than once shall be refused by the
banker except when crossed to an agent for collection.
2. Paying banker is protected in case of payment of cross cheque in due course.
3. Paying banker is liable in case of payment of cross cheque out of due course
except when acted in good faith and without negligence in certain
circumstances.
STICKY NOTES

4. Collecting banker is protected in case of defective title of customer provided


that it acted in good faith and without negligence.
5. Collecting banker is protected in case of account payee crossing when acted
in good faith and without negligence.
6. The duty and authority of paying banker is determined by countermand of
payment and notice of death/insolvency of customer.
7. The same rules also apply to bank draft.

258 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 16

ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND


ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
Money Laundering is a process whereby the proceeds of
AT A GLANCE criminal activity are converted into assets appearing to have a
legitimate origin.
SPOTLIGHT Anti-Money Laundering laws seeks to deter criminals by making
it harder for them to hide ill-gotten money by prescribing the
1. Anti-Money Laundering wider scope for the offence and strict punishment thereof.
A payment system is any system used to settle financial
2. Electronic Payments
transactions through the transfer of monetary value. This
includes the institutions, instruments, people, rules, procedures,
3. Objective Based Q&A
standards, and technologies that make its exchange possible.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES Electronic Fund Transfer is the electronic transfer of money
from one bank account to another, either within a single
financial institution or across multiple institutions, via
computer-based systems, without the direct intervention of
bank staff.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 259


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING
1.1 Introduction
Money laundering is the illegal process of making amounts of money generated by a criminal activity, such as
drug trafficking, terrorist funding or tax evasion, appear to have come from a legitimate source. The money from
the criminal activity is considered dirty, and the process "launders" it to make it look clean.
 Example 01:
A person is involved in money laundering if he has Rs. 5 million from smuggling and sale of illegal
drugs and he represents this money as being earned from his legitimate business of trading in
used cars.
Anti-money laundering (AML) laws are the rules for businesses, institutions, and even countries to eliminate
AT A GLANCE

money laundering and terrorist financing activities. Initially, AML laws were implemented only on financial
institutions to control drug trafficking.
Since then, AML and counter financing of terrorism (CFT) have become global concerns. International authorities
such as FATF and world bank are collaborating with national authorities and state banks to control money
laundering. Recently, the scope has been increased significantly and strict AML laws have been implemented.
In Pakistan, the relevant legislation is the Anti-Money Laundering Act, 2010.
AML laws seeks to deter criminals by making it harder for them to hide ill-gotten money. Among other
requirements, AML regulations require financial institutions to monitor customers' transactions and report on
suspicious financial activity.

1.2 Definition of Financial Institution [Section 2(xiv)]


SPOTLIGHT

It is important to understand the definition of “financial institution” since most of the requirements of Anti-
Money Laundering Act, 2010 are applicable to financial institutions.
“financial institution” includes any person carrying on any one or more of the following activities, namely:
a) acceptance of deposits and other repayable funds from the public;
b) lending in whatsoever form;
c) financial leasing;
d) money or value transfer;
e) issuing and managing means of payments including but not limited to credit and debit cards, cheques,
traveller’s cheques, money orders, bank drafts and electronic money;
f) financial guarantees and commitments; and
STICKY NOTES

g) trading in:
i. money market instruments;
ii. foreign exchange;
iii. exchange, interest rate and index instruments;
iv. transferable securities;
v. commodity futures trading;
vi. participation in shares issues and the provision of services related to such issues;
vii. individual and collective portfolio management;
viii. safekeeping and administration of cash or liquid securities on behalf of other persons;
ix. investing, administering or managing funds or money on behalf of other persons;
x. insurance business transactions;
xi. money and currency changing; and
xii. carrying out business as intermediary.
Notice that the definition is not limited to banks only, but also includes various entities involved in financial
transactions.

260 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

 Example 02:
JazzCash (money or value transfer), EasyPaisa (money or value transfer), Mastercard (debit &
credit cards) and Western Union (money transfer and currency changing) are also financial
institutions.

1.3 Offence of Money Laundering [Section 3]


The following are considered offences of money laundering:

1.3.1 Acquisition, Conversion or Possession of Criminal Property


If a person acquires, converts, possesses, uses or transfers property, knowing or having reason to believe that
such property is proceeds of crime, the person shall be guilty of offence of money laundering.

AT A GLANCE
 Example 03:
A government official received bribes for official work and bought a house using the proceeds.
He has committed offence of money laundering.

1.3.2 Concealment of Criminal Property


If a person conceals or disguises the true nature, origin, location, disposition, movement or ownership of
property, knowing or having reason to believe that such property is proceeds of crime, the person shall be guilty
of offence of money laundering.
 Example 04:
A banker, knowing that the transactions in a client’s account represented proceeds of crime,
concealed it from law enforcement agencies, the banker has committed offence of money

SPOTLIGHT
laundering.

1.3.3 Possession of Criminal Property on behalf of others


If a person holds or possesses on behalf of any other person any property knowing or having reason to believe
that such property is proceeds of crime, the person shall be guilty of offence of money laundering.
 Example 05:
An employee holds Rs. 10 million on behalf of his employer, knowing that the amount was
proceeds of crime, he has committed offence of money laundering.

1.3.4 Participation in Money Laundering

STICKY NOTES
If a person participates in, associates, conspires to commit, attempts to commit, aids, abets, facilitates, or counsels
the commission of the acts specified above, the person shall be guilty of offence of money laundering.
 Example 06:
An accountant advised one of his client to conceal criminal property and facilitated for such
concealment, he has committed offence of money laundering.

1.4 Evidence of Offence of Money Laundering [Section 3]


The knowledge, intent or purpose required as an element of an offence of money laundering may be inferred
from factual circumstances in accordance with the Qanun-e-Shahadat Order, 1984.
In order to prove an offence of money laundering the conviction of an accused for the respective predicate offence
shall not be required.
A predicate offence is a crime that is a component of a more serious crime. For example, producing unlawful
funds is the primary offence and money laundering is the predicate offence.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 261


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.5 Punishment for Money Laundering [Section 4]

1.5.1 General Provision


Whoever commits the offence of money laundering shall be:
a) punished with rigorous imprisonment for a term which shall not be less than one year but may extend
upto ten years; and
b) liable to fine which may extend upto Rs. 25 million; and
c) liable to forfeiture of property involved in money laundering or property of corresponding value.
 Example 07:
An individual (natural person) committed the offence of money laundering, he shall be punished
with rigorous imprisonment for a term which shall not be less than one year but may extend upto
AT A GLANCE

ten years, and also liable to fine which may extend upto Rs. 25 million, and also liable to forfeiture
of property involved in money laundering or property of corresponding value.

1.5.2 Special Provision as to Legal Persons


In case of a legal person (e.g. a company), the fine may extend upto Rs. 100 million.
Any director, officer or employee of such legal person who is found guilty shall also be punishable as provided in
general provision above.
 Example 08:
A company (legal person) committed the offence of money laundering and one of its directors
was found guilty.
SPOTLIGHT

The company shall be liable to fine which may extend upto Rs. 100 million.
The director shall be punished with rigorous imprisonment for a term which shall not be less
than one year but may extend upto ten years, and also liable to fine which may extend upto Rs.
25 million, and also liable to forfeiture of property involved in money laundering or property of
corresponding value.
STICKY NOTES

262 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

2. ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS
2.1 Introduction
Electronic payment systems and electronic fund transfer (EFT) have increasingly become preferred mode of
payment for businesses and consumers alike.
A payment system (PS) is any system used to settle financial transactions through the transfer of monetary value.
This includes the institutions, instruments, people, rules, procedures, standards, and technologies that make its
exchange possible.
EFT is the electronic transfer of money from one bank account to another, either within a single financial
institution or across multiple institutions, via computer-based systems, without the direct intervention of bank
staff.

AT A GLANCE
The relevant law in Pakistan is the Payment Systems and Electronic Fund Transfers Act, 2007.

2.2 Relevant Definitions

2.2.1 Electronic Fund or Electronic Money [Section 2(s)]


“Electronic Fund or Electronic Money” means money transferred through
 an Electronic Terminal,
 ATM,
 telephone instrument,
 computer,

SPOTLIGHT
 magnetic medium or
 any other electronic device
so as to order, instruct, or authorize
 a banking company,
 a Financial Institution or
 any other company or person
to debit or credit an account; and
 includes monetary value as represented by a claim on the issuer which is stored in an electronic device
or Payment Instrument, issued on receipt of funds of an amount not less in value than the monetary

STICKY NOTES
value issued, accepted as means of payment by undertakings other than the issuer and
 includes electronic store of monetary value on an electronic device that may be used for making
payments or
 as may be prescribed by the State Bank.
 Example 09:
Money transferred through debit card, credit card, ATM or mobile cash wallet is Electronic
Money.

2.2.2 Electronic Fund Transfer [Section 2(t)]


“Electronic Fund Transfer” means any transfer of funds, other than a transaction originated by cheque, draft or
similar paper instrument, which is initiated through an Electronic Terminal, telephonic instrument, point-of -
sale Terminal, stored value card Terminal, debit card, ATM, computer magnetic tape or any other electronic
device so as to order, instruct, or authorize a Financial Institution to debit or credit an Account.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 263


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 10:
A student paying his/her fee using internet banking or a customer paying by swiping his/her
debit card on point-of-sale terminal at a departmental store are examples of EFT.

2.2.3 Operator [Section 2 (za)]


“Operator” means any financial or other institution or any person, authorized by the State Bank to operate any
Designated Payment System (DPS).

2.3 Designation of Payment System [Section 4]


The State Bank may designate a PS as a DPS by a written order, if necessary in the public interest.
The State Bank may inspect the premises, equipment, machinery, apparatus, books or other documents, or
AT A GLANCE

accounts and transactions relating to the PS, in considering whether to designate it as DPS.

2.4 Revocation of Designation of Payment System [Section 5]


The State Bank may revoke the designation of a DPS if it is satisfied that:
a) the DPS has ceased to operate effectively as a PS;
b) the operator of the designated system has knowingly furnished information or documents to the State
Bank in connection with the designation of the PS which is or are false or misleading in any material
particular;
c) the operator or settlement institution of the DPS is in the course of being wound up or otherwise
dissolved, whether in Pakistan or elsewhere;
d) any of the terms and conditions of the designation or requirements of the Act has been contravened; or
SPOTLIGHT

e) the State Bank considers that it is in the public interest to revoke the designation.
The State Bank shall not revoke a designation without giving the operator of the DPS an opportunity to be heard.
However, the State Bank may suspend the designation of a PS without notice pending the final order, if an
immediate systemic risk is involved.

2.5 Operational Arrangements [Section 11]


An Operator of a DPS shall establish the following operational arrangements:
a) rules and procedures setting out the rights and liabilities of the operator and the participant and the
financial risks the participants may incur;
b) procedures, controls and measures for the management of credit, liquidity and settlement risk, including
STICKY NOTES

rules determining the time when a payment instruction and a settlement is final;
c) criteria for participation in the DPS; and
d) measures to ensure the safety, security and operational reliability of the DPS including contingency
arrangements.

264 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Under the provision of Anti-Money Laundering Act, 2010 which of the following is not a ‘financial
institution’?
(a) Lending business
(b) Financial leasing business
(c) Educational institute
(d) A business trading in transferable securities

02. If a person holds or possesses on behalf of any other person any property knowing or having reason to
believe that such property is _________________, he is guilty of offence of money laundering.

AT A GLANCE
(a) Illegally occupied
(b) Not owned by that other person
(c) Proceeds of crime
(d) Owned by government

03. In which of the following case(s) a person is deemed to have committed an offence of money laundering?
(a) If a person acquires, converts, possesses, uses or transfers property, knowing or having reason to
believe that such property is proceeds of crime.
(b) If a person conceals or disguises the true nature, origin, location, disposition, movement or

SPOTLIGHT
ownership of property, knowing or having reason to believe that such property is proceeds of
crime.
(c) If a person holds or possesses on behalf of any other person any property knowing or having
reason to believe that such property is proceeds of crime.
(d) All of above.

04. Habib is guilty of an offence of money laundering, the court may punish him with rigorous imprisonment
for a term:
(a) Which shall not be less than one year

STICKY NOTES
(b) which may extend upto ten years.
(c) which shall not be less than one year but may extend upto ten years.
(d) None of above.

05. Habib Limited is guilty of offence of money laundering, the court may punish it with rigorous
imprisonment for a term:
(a) Which shall not be less than one year
(b) which may extend upto ten years.
(c) which shall not be less than one year but may extend upto ten years.
(d) None of above.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 265


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

06. Abid is guilty of offence of money laundering, he shall be liable to fine which may extend upto:
(a) Rs. 10 million
(b) Rs. 25 million
(c) Rs. 100 million
(d) Rs. 250 million

07. Abid Limited is guilty of offence of money laundering, it shall be liable to fine which may extend upto:
(a) Rs. 10 million
(b) Rs. 25 million
AT A GLANCE

(c) Rs. 100 million


(d) Rs. 250 million

08. Abid, in connection with his directorship in Abid Limited, is guilty of offence of money laundering , he
shall be liable to fine which may extend upto:
(a) Rs. 10 million
(b) Rs. 25 million
(c) Rs. 100 million
(d) Rs. 250 million
SPOTLIGHT

09. Which of the following persons have been mentioned in the definition of “Electronic Money”
i) A banking company
ii) A financial institution
iii) Any other company or person
(a) (i) only
(b) (ii) only
(c) (i) and (ii) only
(d) (i), (ii) and (iii)
STICKY NOTES

10. Which of the following is not Electronic Fund Transfer?


(a) Transfer of fund initiated through stored value card Terminal
(b) Transfer of fund initiated through bank draft
(c) Transfer of fund initiated through ATM
(d) Transfer of fund initiated through debit card

11. The State Bank may designate a Payment System as a Designated Payment System by a written order:
(a) If necessary for generating tax revenue for the Government
(b) If there is no Designated Payment System in that particular city
(c) If necessary in the public interest
(d) If there are less than 100 bank branches in that particular city

266 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

12. Which of the following statement(s) is / are correct?


i) The State Bank may designate a Payment System as a Designated Payment System by a written
order, if necessary in the public interest.
ii) The State Bank may inspect the premises, equipment, machinery, apparatus, books or other
documents, or accounts and transactions relating to the Payment System, in considering whether
to designate it as Designated Payment System.
(a) (i) only
(b) (ii) only
(c) Both (i) and (ii)
(d) Neither (i) nor (ii)

AT A GLANCE
13. The State Bank may revoke the designation of a Designated Payment System if it is satisfied that:
(a) the Designated Payment System has ceased to operate effectively as a Payment System
(b) the operator or settlement institution of the Designated Payment System is in the course of being
wound up or otherwise dissolved, whether in Pakistan or elsewhere
(c) the State Bank considers that it is in the public interest to revoke the designation
(d) Any one or more of the above reason(s).

14. Which of the following statement(s) is / are correct?

SPOTLIGHT
(i) The State Bank shall not revoke a designation without giving the operator of the Designated
Payment System an opportunity to be heard.
(ii) The State Bank shall not suspend a designation without giving the operator of the Designated
Payment System an opportunity to be heard.
(a) (i) only
(b) (ii) only
(c) Both (i) and (ii)
(d) Neither (i) nor (ii)

STICKY NOTES
15. Which of the following operational arrangements, among other things, are required to be established by
an Operator of a Designated Payment System?
(a) rules and procedures setting out the rights and liabilities of the operator and the participant and
the financial risks the participants may incur
(b) criteria for participation in the Designated Payment System
(c) measures to ensure the safety, security and operational reliability of the Designated Payment
System including contingency arrangements
(d) All of above

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 267


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (c) An educational institute is not a financial institution.
02. (c) Proceeds of crime
03. (d) All the statements indicate offence of money laundering.
04. (c) Which shall not be less than one year but may extend upto ten years.
05. (d) A company is a legal person and legal person cannot be punished with imprisonment.
06. (b) Rs. 25 million
07. (c) Rs. 100 million
AT A GLANCE

08. (b) Rs. 25 million


09. (d) All three are mentioned in the definition
10. (b) Payment by bank draft is not electronic fund transfer
11. (c) If necessary in the public interest
12. (c) Both statements are correct
13. (d) Any of the reason(s).
14. (a) The designation may be suspended without notice if an immediate systematic risk is involved.
15. (d) All of the above.
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

268 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS

STICKY NOTES

Offence of money laundering includes – AML Act, 2010


1. Acquisition, conversion or possession of criminal property
2. Concealment of criminal property
3. Possesion of criminal property on behalf of others
4. Participation in money laundering

AT A GLANCE
Punishment for money laundering – AML Act, 2010
1. Imprisonment of at least one year and maximum ten years
2. Fine upto Rs. 25 million (for legal persons upto Rs. 100 million)
3. Forfeiture of property involved in money laundering(or property of
corresponding value)

Important definitions – PS&EFT Act, 2007


1. Electronic Fund or Electronic Money
2. Electronic Fund Transfer

SPOTLIGHT
3. Operator

Important points – PS&EFT Act, 2007


1. The State Bank may designate a payment system by written order.
2. The State Bank may inspect assets and records relating to payment system in
considering whether to designate it.
3. The State Bank may revoke desgnation of DPS in certain cases.
4. The operator of DPS is required to establish certain operational arrangements.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 269


CHAPTER 16: ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING AND ELECTRONIC PAYMENTS CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

270 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 17

DATA PROTECTION AND


ELECTRONIC CRIMES

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
The legislation on personal data protection in Pakistan is in draft
stage i.e. the Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020.
AT A GLANCE
The other laws containing significant provisions relating to data
SPOTLIGHT protection are:
 The Prevention of Electronics Crimes Act, 2016.
1. Data Protection
 The Payment Systems and Electronic Fund Transfers
2. Prevention of Electronic Act, 2007.
Crimes
 The Telecom Consumer Protection Regulations, 2009.
3. Objective Based Q&A Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016 specified the

SPOTLIGHT
following acts as offences and their respective punishment:
STICKY NOTES
 Unauthorized access to information system or data
 Unauthorized copying or transmission of data
 Interference with information system or data
 Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure
information system or data
 Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical
infrastructure data
 Interference with critical infrastructure information

STICKY NOTES
system or data
 Glorification of an offense
The punishment in each case differs ranging from 3 months to
7 years imprisonment and/or fine ranging from upto Rs. 50,000
to upto Rs. 10 million.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 271


CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. DATA PROTECTION
1.1 Introduction
The legislation on personal data protection in Pakistan is in draft stage and the Bill is yet to be passed by
Parliament. The consultation draft of the Bill is available at website of Ministry of Information Technology and
Telecommunication. The title of proposed Bill is the Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020.
The Bill proposes establishment of Personal Data Protection Authority of Pakistan to protect personal data from
any loss or misuse, to promote awareness of data protection and deal with complaints.
The Prevention of Electronics Crimes Act, 2016 also contains significant provisions about data protection.
The Payment Systems and Electronic Fund Transfers Act, 2007 provides for the secrecy of customer information
held by financial institutions, and violation is punishable with imprisonment and/or fine.
AT A GLANCE

The Telecom Consumer Protection Regulations, 2009 give the subscribers a right to lodge complaints for any
‘illegal practices’ by telecom operators. The complaint is lodged to the Pakistan Telecommunication Authority.
‘Illegal practices’ is a broad term which includes, among other things, illegal use of personal data of subscribers.

1.2 Important Definitions in Proposed Bill


“data subject” means a natural person who is the subject of the personal data.
“personal data” means any information that relates directly or indirectly to a data subject, who is identified or
identifiable from that information or from that and other information in the possession of a data controller,
including any sensitive personal data. Provided that anonymized, encrypted or pseudonymized data which is
incapable of identifying an individual is not personal data.
SPOTLIGHT

“sensitive personal data” means and includes data relating to access control (username and/or password),
financial information such as bank account, credit card, debit card, or other payment instruments, and, passports,
biometric data, and physical, psychological, and mental health conditions, medical records, and any detail
pertaining to an individual’s ethnicity, religious beliefs, or any other information for the purposes of this Act and
rules made thereunder.
”consent” of the data subject means any freely given, specific, informed and unambiguous indication of the data
subject’s wishes by which he or she, by a statement or by a clear affirmative action, signifies agreement to the
collecting, obtaining and processing of personal data relating to him or her.

1.3 Key Principles


The key principles applicable to personal data processing are:
STICKY NOTES

a) Lawfulness, fairness and transparency


b) Purpose limitation
c) Data minimisation (adequate, relevant and limited to what is necessary in relation to the purposes for
which they are processed)
d) Accuracy
e) Storage limitation
f) Integrity and confidentiality (security)
g) Accountability

272 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES

1.4 Individual rights


An individual has following rights in relation to processing of their personal data:
a) Right to be informed
b) Right of access to data (including right to get copies of data)
c) Right to rectification of errors
d) Right to be forgotten / Right of erasure
e) Right to object to processing and marketing
f) Right to restrict processing
g) Right to data portability
h) Right to withdraw consent

AT A GLANCE
i) Right to complain to the relevant data protection authority

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 273


CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

2. PREVENTION OF ELECTRONIC CRIMES


2.1 Introduction
In 2016, the National Assembly enacted the Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act (“PECA”) to provide a
comprehensive legal framework to define various kinds of electronic crimes, mechanisms for investigation,
prosecution and adjudication in relation to electronic crimes.

2.2 Relevant definitions

2.2.1 Unauthorised access [Section 2(xxxi)]


"unauthorized access" means access to an information system or data which is not available for access by general
public, without authorization or in violation of the terms and conditions of the authorization.
AT A GLANCE

2.2.2 Access to data [Section 2(ii)]


"access to data" means gaining control or ability to use, copy, modify or delete any data held in or generated by
any device or information system.

2.2.3 Access to information system [Section 2(iii)]


"access to information system" means gaining control or ability to use any part or whole of an information system
whether or not through infringing any security measure.

2.2.4 Data damage [Section 2(xiv)]


"data damage" means alteration, deletion, deterioration, erasure, relocation, suppression of data or making data
SPOTLIGHT

temporarily or permanently unavailable.

2.2.5 Critical infrastructure [Section 2(x)]


"critical infrastructure" means critical elements of infrastructure namely assets, facilities, systems, networks or
processes the loss or compromise of which could result in:
a) major detrimental impact on the availability, integrity or delivery of essential services including those
services, whose integrity, if compromised, could result in significant loss of life or casualties, taking into
account significant economic or social impacts; or
b) significant impact on national security, national defence, or the functioning of the state.
The Government may also designate any private or Government infrastructure in accordance with the above
STICKY NOTES

objectives, as critical infrastructure.

2.3 Offences and Punishments

2.3.1 Unauthorized access to information system or data [Section 3]

Offender Punishment
Whoever with dishonest intention gains unauthorized access to Imprisonment upto 3 months; and/or
any information system or data. Fine upto Rs. 50,000

2.3.2 Unauthorized copying or transmission of data [Section 4]

Offender Punishment
Whoever with dishonest intention and without authorization Imprisonment upto 6 months; and/or
copies or otherwise transmits or causes to be transmitted any data. Fine upto Rs. 100,000

274 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES

2.3.3 Interference with information system or data [Section 5]

Offender Punishment
Whoever with dishonest intention interferes with or damages or Imprisonment upto 2 years; and/or
causes to be interfered with or damages any part or whole of an Fine upto Rs. 500,000
information system or data.

2.3.4 Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data [Section 6]

Offender Punishment
Whoever with dishonest intention gains unauthorized access to Imprisonment upto 3 years; and/or
any critical infrastructure information system or data. Fine upto Rs. 1,000,000

AT A GLANCE
2.3.5 Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical infrastructure data [Section 7]

Offender Punishment
Whoever with dishonest intention and without authorization Imprisonment upto 5 years; and/or
copies or otherwise transmits or causes to be transmitted any Fine upto Rs. 5,000,000
critical infrastructure data.

2.3.6 Interference with critical infrastructure information system or data [Section 8]

Offender Punishment

SPOTLIGHT
Whoever with dishonest intention interferes with or damages, or Imprisonment upto 7 years; and/or
causes to be interfered with or damaged, any part or whole of a Fine upto Rs. 10,000,000
critical information system, or data.

2.3.7 Glorification of an offense [Section 9]

Offender Punishment
Whoever prepares or disseminates information, through any Imprisonment upto 7 years; and/or
information system or device, with the intent to glorify an offence Fine upto Rs. 10,000,000
relating to terrorism, or any person convicted of a crime relating to
terrorism, or activities of proscribed organizations or individuals

STICKY NOTES
or groups.
For the purposes of this section "glorification" includes depiction
of any form of praise or celebration in a desirable manner.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 275


CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Identify one of the following topics for which relevant legislation is not yet enforced.
(a) Prevention of Electronic Crimes
(b) Payment Systems and Electronic Fund Transfers
(c) Personal Data Protection
(d) Telecom Consumer Protection

02. In case of illegal use of personal data of subscriber of telecom operator, a complaint may be lodged to:
(a) Pakistan Electronic Media Regulatory Authority (PEMRA)
AT A GLANCE

(b) Pakistan Telecommunication Authority (PTA)


(c) Personal Data Protection Authority of Pakistan (PDPAP)
(d) Federal Investigation Agency (FIA)

03. Which of the following are “data subject” in accordance with the Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020?
(a) Only a natural person
(b) Only a legal person
(c) Only a natural person aged 18 or above
(d) A natural person or a legal person
SPOTLIGHT

04. Sensitive personal data includes, in accordance with the Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020:
(a) Username and/or password
(b) Financial information
(c) Physical, psychological and mental health condition
(d) All of above

05. Which of the following statement(s) is are correct?


i) One of the key principle of personal data processing is data minimisation.
STICKY NOTES

ii) One of the individual rights in relation to personal data processing is right to withdraw consent.
(a) (i) only
(b) (ii) only
(c) Both (i) and (ii)
(d) Neither (i) nor (ii)

06. Which of the following offence might result in longer imprisonment and/or higher fine under the
provisions of Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016?
(a) Glorification of an offense
(b) Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data
(c) Unauthorized copying or transmission of data
(d) Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical infrastructure data

276 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES

07. Which of the following offence might result in shorter imprisonment and/or lower fine as compared to
others under the provisions of Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016?
(a) Interference with information system or data
(b) Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data
(c) Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical infrastructure data
(d) Interference with critical infrastructure information system or data

08. Which of the following offence may result in imprisonment which may extend to ________ or fine which
may extend to _____________, or both under the provisions of Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016?
(a) Unauthorized copying or transmission of data

AT A GLANCE
(b) Interference with information system or data
(c) Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data
(d) Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical infrastructure data

09. Which of the following offence may result in imprisonment which may extend to 6 months or fine which
may extend to Rs. 100,000, or both under the provisions of Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016?
(a) Unauthorized access to information system or data
(b) Unauthorized copying or transmission of data
(c) Interference with information system or data

SPOTLIGHT
(d) Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data

10. Which of the following offence may result in imprisonment which may extend to seven years or fine
which may extend to Rs. 10 million, or both under the provisions of Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act,
2016?
(a) Unauthorized copying or transmission of critical infrastructure data
(b) Interference with critical infrastructure information system or data
(c) Glorification of an offense
(d) Both (b) and (c)

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 277


CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

ANSWERS
01. (c) Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020 is yet on draft stage.
02. (b) Pakistan Telecommunication Authority (PTA).
03. (a) Only a natural person.
04. (d) All of above.
05. (c) Both statements are correct
06. (a) Glorification of an offense
07. (a) Interference with information system or data
AT A GLANCE

08. (c) Unauthorized access to critical infrastructure information system or data


09. (b) Unauthorized copying or transmission of data
10. (d) Interference with critical infrastructure information system or data
Glorification of an offense
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

278 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES

STICKY NOTES

Data Protection – Relevant legislation


1. Personal Data Protection Bill, 2020 (proposed)
2. Prevention of Electronic Crimes Act, 2016
3. Payment Systems and Electronic Fund Transfer Act, 2007
4. Telecom Consumer Protection Regulations, 2009

AT A GLANCE
Summary of offences and punishments under PECA, 2016
1. Unauthorized access to Imprisonment upto 3 months; and/or
information system or data Fine upto Rs. 50,000
2. Unauthorized copying or Imprisonment upto 6 months; and/or
transmission of data Fine upto Rs. 100,000
3. Interference with information Imprisonment upto 2 years; and/or
system or data Fine upto Rs. 500,000
4. Unauthorized access to critical Imprisonment upto 3 years; and/or

SPOTLIGHT
infrastructure information Fine upto Rs. 1,000,000
system or data
5. Unauthorized copying or Imprisonment upto 5 years; and/or
transmission of critical Fine upto Rs. 5,000,000
infrastructure data
6. Interference with critical Imprisonment upto 7 years; and/or
infrastructure information Fine upto Rs. 10,000,000
system or data
7. Glorification of an offense Imprisonment upto 7 years; and/or

STICKY NOTES
Fine upto Rs. 10,000,000

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 279


CHAPTER 17: DATA PROTECTION AND ELECTRONIC CRIMES CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW
AT A GLANCE
SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

280 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CHAPTER 18

COMPETITION ACT AND


ARBITRATION ACT

AT A GLANCE

AT A GLANCE
IN THIS CHAPTER:
The Competition Act, 2010 prohibits the following:
AT A GLANCE a) Practices which abuse the dominant position;
b) Agreements by undertaking or association of
SPOTLIGHT
undertakings with the object or effect of preventing,
restricting, or reducing competition.
1. Competition Act, 2010
c) Deceptive marketing practices.
2. Arbitration Act, 1940
The Arbitration Act, 1940 is main alternative dispute
resolution mechanism in Pakistan. The law provides for rules,
3. Objective Based Q&A
inter alia, relating to:

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES a) Implied conditions in arbitration agreement;
b) Appointment of arbitrators by third party;
c) Authority of appointed arbitrator or umpire
irrevocable except by leave of Court;
d) Powers of arbitrator;
e) Out of court settlement by parties to a suit.

STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 281


CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1. COMPETITION ACT, 2010


1.1 Introduction
The preamble of Competition Act, 2010 states its objective “to ensure free competition in all spheres of
commercial and economic activity to enhance economic efficiency and to protect consumers from anti-
competitive behaviour and to provide for the establishment of the Competition Commission of Pakistan to
maintain and enhance competition.
The Act established the Competition Commission of Pakistan (CCP) which is an independent quasi-regulatory,
quasi-judicial body with the task to help ensure healthy competition between companies for the benefit of the
economy.

1.2 Relevant definitions


AT A GLANCE

1.2.1 Goods [Section 2(f)]


"goods" includes any item, raw material, product or by-product which is sold for consideration.

1.2.2 Retailer [Section 2(l)]


"retailer", in relation to the sale of any goods, means a person who sells the goods to any other person other than
for resale.

1.2.3 Wholesaler [Section 2(r)]


"wholesaler" in relation to the sale of any goods, means a person who purchases goods and sells them to any
other person for resale.
SPOTLIGHT

1.2.4 Relevant market [Section 2(k)]


"relevant market" means the market which shall be determined by CCP with reference to a product market and
a geographic market.
A product market comprises of all those products or services which are regarded as interchangeable or
substitutable by the consumers by reason of the products characteristics, prices and intended uses.
A geographic market comprises the area in which the undertakings concerned are involved in the supply of
products or services and in which the conditions of competition are sufficiently homogeneous and which can be
distinguished from neighbouring geographic areas because, in particular, the conditions of competition are
appreciably different in those areas.
STICKY NOTES

1.3 Prohibitions under the Competition Act

1.3.1 Abuse of dominant position [Section 3]


No person shall abuse dominant position.
An abuse of dominant position shall be deemed to have been brought about, maintained or continued if it consists
of practices which prevent, restrict, reduce, or distort competition in the relevant market.
The expression "practices" referred to as above shall include, but are not limited to:
a) limiting production, sales and unreasonable increases in price or other unfair trading conditions;
b) price discrimination by charging different prices for the same goods or services from different
customers in the absence of objective justifications that may justify different prices;
c) tie-ins, where the sale of goods or service is made conditional on the purchase of other goods or services;
d) making conclusion of contracts subject to acceptance by the other parties of supplementary obligations
which by their nature or according to commercial usage, have no connection with the subject of the
contracts;

282 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT

e) applying dissimilar conditions to equivalent transactions on other parties, placing them at a competitive
disadvantage;
f) predatory pricing driving competitors out of a market, prevent new entry, and monopolize the market;
g) boycotting or excluding any other undertaking from the production, distribution or sale of any goods or
the provision of any service; or
h) refusing to deal.
 Example 01:
XYZ Limited operates a chain of retail outlets selling essential materials used in construction in
all major cities across Pakistan having market share of 60%. The management team of XYZ
Limited has finalised a strategy to lower the prices significantly in some cities where recently
small competitors have emerged. An executive explained that XYZ Limited would have to bear

AT A GLANCE
loss in those cities for some time but this strategy is highly likely to force competitors to closure,
XYZ Limited will make profit subsequent to that by raising prices even higher than before. Such
practice is abuse of dominant position and would be in contravention of Competition Act, 2010.

1.3.2 Prohibited agreements [Section 4]


No undertaking or association of undertakings shall enter into any agreement or, in the case of an association of
undertakings, shall make a decision in respect of the production, supply, distribution, acquisition or control of
goods or the provision of services which have the object or effect of preventing, restricting, or reducing
competition within the relevant market unless exempted in accordance with the provision of the Act.
Any agreement entered into in contravention of the above provision shall be void.
Such agreements include but are not limited to:

SPOTLIGHT
a) fixing the purchase or selling price or imposing any other restrictive trading conditions with regard to
the sale or distribution of any goods or the provision of any service;
b) dividing or sharing of markets for the goods or services, whether by territories, by volume of sales or
purchases, by type of goods or services sold or by any other means;
c) fixing or setting the quantity of production, distribution or sale with regard to any goods or the manner
or means of providing any services;
d) limiting technical development or investment with regard to the production, distribution or sale of any
goods or the provision of any service; or
e) collusive tendering or bidding for sale, purchase or procurement of any goods or service.
f) applying dissimilar conditions to equivalent transactions with other trading parties, thereby placing

STICKY NOTES
them at a disadvantage; and
g) make the conclusion of contracts subject to acceptance by the other parties of supplementary obligations
which, by their nature or according to commercial usage, have no connection with the subject of such
contracts.
 Example 02:
Javed Limited and Saleem Limited are the leading manufacturers of textile products in Pakistan.
Both companies have recently signed an agreement under which they would restrict the supply
of their products to particular geographical areas. Under the Competition Act, 2010, no company
shall enter into any agreement in respect of the, supply/distribution, which have the object or
effect of restricting/reducing competition within the relevant market unless exemption has been
granted by CCP. Since the agreement between Javed Limited and Saleem Limited will restrict the
competition in the market, this agreement would be void.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 283


CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

1.3.3 Deceptive marketing practices [Section 10]


No undertaking shall enter into deceptive marketing practices.
The deceptive marketing practices shall be deemed to have been resorted to or continued of an Undertaking
resorts to:
a) the distribution of false or misleading information that is capable of harming the business interests of
another undertaking;
b) the distribution of false or misleading information to consumers, including the distribution of
information lacking a reasonable basis, related to the price, character, method or place of production,
properties, suitability for use, or quality of goods;
c) false or misleading comparison of goods in the process of advertising; or
d) fraudulent use of another's trademark, firm name, or product labelling or packaging.
AT A GLANCE

 Example 03:
Strong Industries Limited (SIL) is a listed company and is engaged in the manufacturing of SIL
cement. SIL’s market share is around 23%. SIL’s plans for the next year include launching a
vigorous advertisement campaign which would involve television advertisements highlighting
some of the unique features of SIL cement and how it is superior to the cement manufactured by
other competitors. Before launching the advertisement campaign, SIL shall ensure that its
marketing campaign shall not resort to:
a) the distribution of false or misleading information that is capable of harming the
business interests of another undertaking;
b) the distribution of false or misleading information to consumers, including information
lacking a reasonable basis, related to the price, character, method, or place of production,
SPOTLIGHT

properties, suitability for use, or quality of goods;


c) false or misleading comparison of goods in the process of advertisement.
STICKY NOTES

284 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT

2. ARBITRATION ACT, 1940


2.1 Introduction
Arbitration is a method, through which, parties resolve their disputes outside the court of law by avoiding
technicalities of procedural law. It is one of the modes of Alternate Dispute Resolution. There are limited rights
of review and appeal of arbitration awards.
Although the Arbitration Act 1940 is a very old enactment, it still serves as a clear and well settled piece of
legislation with consistent chain of judicial precedents backing the interpretational aspects particularly in trade
and commercial matters.

2.2 Relevant definitions [Section 2(a, d, e)]

AT A GLANCE
“arbitration agreement” means a written agreement to submit present or future differences to arbitration,
whether an arbitrator is named therein or not.
“legal representative” means a person who in law represents the estate of a deceased person, and includes any
person who intermeddles with the estate of the deceased, and, where a party acts in representative character,
the person on whom the estate devolves on the death of the party so acting.
“reference” means reference to arbitration.
Note: An umpire is a third-party appointed by the arbitrators to settle differences between the arbitrators.

2.3 Relevant provisions

2.3.1 Provisions implied in arbitration agreement [Section 3]

SPOTLIGHT
An arbitration agreement, unless a different intention is expressed therein, shall be deemed to include the
following provisions (set out in First Schedule of the Act):
a) Unless otherwise expressly provided, the reference shall be to a sole arbitrator.
b) If the reference is to an even number of arbitrators, the arbitrators shall appoint an umpire not later
than one month from the latest date of their respective appointments.
c) The arbitrators shall make their award within four months after entering on the reference or after
having been called upon to act by notice in writing from any party to the arbitration agreement or within
such extended time as the Court may allow.
d) If the arbitrators have allowed their time to expire without making an award or have delivered to any
party to the arbitration agreement or to the umpire a notice in writing stating that they cannot agree,

STICKY NOTES
the umpire shall forthwith enter on the reference in lieu of the arbitrators.
e) The umpire shall make his award within two months of entering on the reference or within such
extended time as the Court may allow.
f) The parties to the reference and all persons claiming under them shall subject to the provisions of any
law for the time being in force, submit to be examined by the arbitrators or umpire on oath or affirmation
in relation to the matters in difference and shall, subject as aforesaid, produce before the arbitrators or
umpire all books, deeds, papers, accounts writings and documents within their possession or power
respectively, which may be required or called for, and do all other things which, during the proceedings
on the reference, the arbitrators, or umpire may require.
g) The award shall be final and binding on the parties and persons claiming under them respectively.
h) The cost of the reference and award shall be in the discretion of the arbitrators or umpire who may
direct to, and by whom, and in what manner, such costs or any part thereof shall be paid, and may tax or
settle the amount of costs to be so paid or any part thereof and may award costs to be paid as between
legal practitioner and client.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 285


CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

 Example 04:
Arslan and Faisal made a contract and agreed to refer to arbitration in case of dispute, one
arbitrator to be appointed by either side. The dispute arisen and arbitrators appointed. In the
absence of contrary intention, the arbitrators shall appoint an umpire within a month of their
appointments.

2.3.2 Agreement that arbitrators be appointed by third party [Section 4]


The parties to an arbitration agreement may agree that any reference under the agreement shall be to an
arbitrator or arbitrators to be appointed by a person designated in the agreement either by name or as the holder
for the time being of any office or appointment.
 Example 05:
AT A GLANCE

Two businessmen agreed in a contract that in case of any dispute the matter shall be referred to
arbitration and for this purpose, the arbitrator shall be appointed by the Chairperson of the
Chamber of Commerce of the city.

2.3.3 Authority of appointed arbitrator or umpire irrevocable except by leave of Court [Section 5]
The authority of an appointed arbitrator or umpire shall not be revocable except with the leave of the Court
unless a contrary intention is expressed in the arbitration agreement.

2.3.4 Powers of arbitrator [Section 13]


The arbitrators or umpire shall, unless a different intention is expressed in the agreement, have power to:
a) administer oath to the parties and witnesses appearing;
SPOTLIGHT

b) state a special case for the opinion of the Court on any question of law involved, or state the award,
wholly or in part, in the form of a special case of such question for the opinion of the Court;
c) make the award conditional or in the alternative;
d) correct in an award any clerical mistake or error arising from any accidental slip or omission;
e) administer to any party to the arbitration such interrogatories as may, in the opinion of the arbitrators
or umpire, be necessary.

2.3.5 Parties to suit may apply for order or reference [Section 21]
Where in any suit all the parties interested agree that any matter in difference between them in the suit shall be
referred to arbitration, they may at any time before judgment is pronounced apply in writing to the Court for an
STICKY NOTES

order or reference.
 Example 06:
Naeem had filed a suit against Kareem in court for breach of contract. Kareem contacted Naeem
and requested out of court settlement. Naeem agreed and both of them signed and submitted a
written arbitration agreement to court before pronouncement of judgement. Such an agreement
is valid.

286 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT

3. OBJECTIVE BASED Q&A


01. Which of the following practices might be an abuse of dominant position?
(a) applying dissimilar conditions to equivalent transactions on other parties, placing them at a
competitive disadvantage.
(b) tie-ins, where the sale of goods or service is made conditional on the purchase of other goods or
services.
(c) making conclusion of contracts subject to acceptance by the other parties of supplementary
obligations which by their nature or according to commercial usage, have no connection with the
subject of the contracts.
(d) All of above.

AT A GLANCE
02. Which of the following is a deceptive marketing practice?
(a) refusing to deal while having a dominant position.
(b) false or misleading comparison of goods in the process of presenting the goods of the company.
(c) predatory pricing driving competitors out of a market, prevent new entry, and monopolize the
market.
(d) boycotting or excluding any other undertaking from the production, distribution or sale of any
goods or the provision of any service.

03. Which of the following is a deceptive marketing practice?

SPOTLIGHT
(a) fraudulent use of another's trademark, firm name, or product labelling or packaging.
(b) the distribution of false or misleading information to consumers, including the distribution of
information lacking a reasonable basis, related to the price, character, method or place of
production, properties, suitability for use, or quality of goods.
(c) false or misleading comparison of goods in the process of advertising.
(d) All of above.

04. Which of the following statement is incorrect in relation to Competition Act, 2010:

STICKY NOTES
(a) An agreement fixing the purchase or selling price or imposing any other restrictive trading
conditions with regard to the sale or distribution of any goods or the provision of any service is
not prohibited unless CCP expressly directs otherwise.
(b) Agreement for limiting technical development or investment with regard to the production,
distribution or sale of any goods or the provision of any service may not be void if exemption is
granted by CCP.
(c) Fraudulent use of another's trademark, firm name, or product labelling or packaging is deceptive
marketing practice.
(d) Tie-ins, where the sale of goods or service is made conditional on the purchase of other goods or
services might result in abuse of dominant position.

05. Which of the following agreements are likely to be void agreements by undertakings or association of
undertakings?
(a) Agreement for limiting technical development or investment with regard to the production,
distribution or sale of any goods or the provision of any service.

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 287


CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

(b) Agreement for collusive tendering or bidding for sale, purchase or procurement of any goods or
service.
(c) Agreement for applying dissimilar conditions to equivalent transactions with other trading
parties, thereby placing them at a disadvantage.
(d) All of above.

06. Reference to arbitration shall be, in absence of contrary intention expressed in arbitration agreement,
to:
(a) Sole arbitrator
(b) One arbitrator from each side
AT A GLANCE

(c) Even number (2 or more) of arbitrator from each side.


(d) None of above.

07. In absence of contrary intention expressed in arbitration agreement, the arbitrators shall make their
award within:
(a) One month
(b) Two months
(c) Three months
(d) Four months
SPOTLIGHT

08. In absence of contrary intention expressed in arbitration agreement, If the arbitrators have allowed their
time to expire without making an award:
(a) The matter shall be taken to the Court.
(b) The parties shall appoint other persons as arbitrators.
(c) The umpire shall forthwith enter on the reference in lieu of the arbitrators.
(d) None of above.

09. In absence of contrary intention expressed in arbitration agreement, the umpire shall make his award
STICKY NOTES

within:
(a) One month of entering on the reference
(b) Two months of entering on the reference
(c) Three months of entering on the reference
(d) Four months of entering on the reference

10. In absence of contrary intention expressed in arbitration agreement, the arbitrators or umpire shall have
power to:
(a) administer oath to the parties and witnesses appearing.
(b) correct in an award any clerical mistake or error arising from any accidental slip or omission.
(c) make the award conditional or in the alternative.
(d) All of above.

288 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN


CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT

ANSWERS
01. (d) All three practices are abuse of dominant position.

02. (b) false or misleading comparison of goods in the process of advertising

03. (d) All three are deceptive marketing practices.

04. (a) An agreement fixing the purchase or selling price or imposing any other restrictive trading
conditions with regard to the sale or distribution of any goods or the provision of any service
is prohibited.

05. (d) All three are void agreements.

AT A GLANCE
06. (a) One arbitrator

07. (d) Four months

08. (c) The umpire shall forthwith enter on the reference in lieu of the arbitrators.

09. (b) Two months of entering on the reference

10. (d) All three are implied powers of arbitrators or umpire.

SPOTLIGHT
STICKY NOTES

THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN 289


CHAPTER 18: COMPETITION ACT AND ARBITRATION ACT CAF 4: BUSINESS LAW

STICKY NOTES

Prohibitions under the Competition Act, 2010


1. Abuse of dominant position
An abuse of dominant position shall be deemed to have been brought about,
maintained or continued if it consists of practices which prevent, restrict,
reduce, or distort competition in the relevant market.
2. Prohibited agreements
No undertaking or association of undertakings shall enter into any
AT A GLANCE

agreement or, in the case of an association of undertakings, shall make a


decision in respect of the production, supply, distribution, acquisition or
control of goods or the provision of services which have the object or effect
of preventing, restricting, or reducing competition within the relevant
market unless exempted in accordance with the provision of the Act. Any
agreement entered into in contravention of the above provision shall be
void.
3. Deceptive marketing practices
No undertaking shall enter into deceptive marketing practices.
SPOTLIGHT

List of relevant rules – Arbitration Act, 1940


1. Provisions implied in arbitration agreement
2. Agreement that arbitrators be appointed by third party
3. Authority of appointed arbitrator or umpire irrevocable except by leave of
court
4. Powers of arbitrator (implied)
5. Parties to suit may apply for order or reference.
STICKY NOTES

290 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF PAKISTAN

You might also like